Indian Standard
Indian Standard
Indian Standard
3. Control of Operation
3.1
Control of food hazards
3.2
Key aspects of hygiene control
systems
3.3
Incoming material requirements
3.4
Packaging
3.5
Water
3.6
Management and supervision
3.7
Documentation and records
3.8
Recall procedures
6. Transportation
6.1
General
6.2
Requirements
6.3
Use and maintenance
1. SCOPE
This standard covers requirements for Good Hygiene Practices applicable throughout the
food chain (including primary production through to the final consumer), to achieve the
goal of ensuring that food is safe and suitable for human consumption.
2. REFERENCES
The following standards contain provision which through reference in this text, constitute
provision of this standard. At the time of publication, the editions indicated were valid.
All standards are subject to revision, and parties to agreements based on this standard are
encouraged to investigate the possibility of applying the most recent editions of the
standards indicated below:
IS No
Title
3103
3646
7688
10500:
14595
15000: 2005
3. TERMINOLOGY
For the purpose of this standard, the following definitions shall apply.
3.1 Cleaning - the removal of soil, food residue, dirt, grease or other objectionable matter
3.2Contaminant - any biological or chemical agent, foreign matter, or other substances
not intentionally added to food which may compromise food safety or suitability
3.3 Contamination - the introduction or occurrence of a contaminant in food or food
environment.
3.3 Disinfection - the reduction, by means of chemical agents and/or physical methods,
of the number of micro-organisms in the environment, to a level that does not
compromise food safety or suitability
3.4 Establishment - any building or area in which food is handled and the surroundings,
under the control of the same food business operator.
3.5 Food Business Operator- The person or persons responsible for ensuring that the
requirements of this standard are met within the food business under his/ their control.
3.6 Food handler - any person who directly handles packaged or un-packaged food, food
equipment and utensils, or food contact surfaces and is therefore expected to comply with
food hygiene requirements
3.7 Food Hygiene All conditions and measures necessary to ensure the safety and
suitability of food at all stages of the food chain.
3.8 Food safety - assurance that food will not cause harm to the consumer when it is
prepared and/or eaten according to its intended use
3.9 Food suitability- assurance that food is acceptable for human consumption according
to its intended use.
3.10 Hazard A biological, chemical or physical agent in, or condition of, food with the
potential to cause an adverse health effect.
3.11 HACCP A system which identifies, evaluates, and controls hazards which are
significant for food safety.
3.12 Primary production - those steps in the food chain up to and including, for
example, harvesting, slaughter, milking, fishing.
4. GENERAL REQUIREMENTS
4.1 Management responsibility
The food business operator is responsible for the safety and suitability of the produced
food. Therefore, the food business operator shall demonstrate his commitment and his
responsibility with respect to the supply of safe products. For, the hygiene system ensures
that all required activities are effectively defined, documented, implemented and
maintained.
The food business operator has ultimate responsibility for the hygiene policy of the
organisation.
The food business operator shall identify all statutory and regulatory provisions
applicable to various requirements of this standard. Personnel responsible for
implementation and compliance of applicable provisions shall also be identified.
4.1.1 Hygiene Policy
The food business operator shall define and document (in writing) the hygiene policy of
the organisation with regard to food safety. It will demonstrate the commitment of the
organisation to safe food. The food business operator has ultimate responsibility for the
policy of the organisation and shall document, support and communicate this policy.
Periodically, the Food business operator shall verify the implementation of the policy and
review the outcome.
The policy shall demonstrate that the organisation is fully aware of its position in the
food chain. It will reflect the farm-to-fork approach, starting with the purchase and
acceptance of raw materials.
The policy shall be focused on the safety of foodstuffs and shall respond to the
expectations and needs of its customers and consumers.
The policy shall be supported by concrete objectives (proposed actions) to ensure and
improve food safety for the period under consideration. The objectives shall be SMART
(Specific, Measurable, Acceptable, Realistic, Time bound).
The food business operator shall ensure that the hygiene policy is understood,
implemented and maintained at all levels in the organisation.
4.1.2
The food business operator shall define the extent (the scope) of the hygiene system. The
scope shall comprise that part of the food chain and those activities of the food business
for which the food operator is responsible and can be held liable.
Note 1-The part of the food chain for which the food business operator is responsible
begins where the responsibility of the suppliers of raw materials and ingredients ends; the
responsibility of the food business operator ends where another food business in the food
chain takes over the responsibility. The scope shall, therefore, conform with purchase and
sales contracts.
Note 2-All locations and process lines where food is processed and/or stored by the food
business operator shall be properly indicated in an organisation layout and be available
for assessment.
Note 3-All products which are supplied to the market by the food business, whether
processed or handled, shall be properly specified.
Note4- All subcontracted activities (out-sourced services, like packaging, storage,
transport) shall be properly dealt with.
Note 5- Key principle is that no part of the operation of the food business can be
excluded from the scope of the hygiene system; all activities must be available for
assessment.
4.1.3
The food business operator shall provide appropriate documentation with respect to the
tasks, responsibilities and authorities of food business operators employees who are in
positions with respect to hygiene of the food processing.
An organisation chart and the organisations reporting structure shall be documented.
4.1.4
Hygiene team
The food business operator shall constitute a hygiene team (or various hygiene teams if
so required).
The hygiene team shall develop, implement and maintain the hygiene system.
The organisation shall demonstrate that the members of the hygiene team have the
knowledge, expertise and different disciplines available which are required to develop,
implement and maintain a hygiene system covering the total scope of the hygiene system.
Minimum qualification criteria, including required expertise, shall be defined and
documented for all members of the hygiene team. In addition, the assignment (including
tasks, responsibilities and authorities) shall be documented for the team members.
Whenever more than one hygiene team has been constituted, a co-ordinator shall be
appointed to co-ordinate the development, implementation and maintenance of the
hygiene system.
4.1.5
Resources
The food business operator shall examine the requests and provide, in a timely manner,
all the resources needed by the hygiene team(s) to develop, implement and maintain the
hygiene system.
When corrective actions, verification procedures or customers indicate that operational
improvements are necessary, the food business operator shall examine the issues and
provide appropriate resources to ensure food safety.
4.1.6
Management Review
The food business operator shall review the hygiene system at planned intervals, of no
more than 12 months, to ensure continuing suitability, adequacy and effectiveness. The
review shall evaluate the need for changes to the system, including product safety, policy
and objectives.
The review shall provide evidence of the commitment to improve the hygiene system and
its performance.
The potential effects of primary production activities on the safety and suitability of food
shall be considered at all times. In particular, this includes identifying any specific points
in such activities where a high probability of contamination may exist and taking specific
measures to minimize that probability. The HACCP-based approach may assist in the
taking of such measures (see IS 15000-2005).
Producers shall implement measures as applicable to:
In particular, care shall be taken to manage wastes, and store harmful substances
appropriately.
Note- On-farm programmes which achieve specific food safety goals are becoming an
important part of primary production and shall be encouraged.
5.1.3 Handling, Storage and Transport
Procedures shall be in place to:
a) sort food and food ingredients to segregate the material which is evidently unfit
for human consumption;
b) dispose of any rejected material in a hygienic manner; and
c) protect food and food ingredients from contamination by pests, or by chemical,
physical or microbiological contaminants or other objectionable substances during
handling, storage and transport.
Care shall be taken to prevent, so far as reasonably practicable, deterioration and spoilage
through appropriate measures which may include controlling temperature, humidity,
and/or other controls.
5.1.4 Cleaning, Maintenance and Personnel Hygiene at Primary Production
Appropriate facilities and procedures shall be in place to ensure that:
a) Any necessary cleaning and maintenance is carried out effectively; and
b) An appropriate degree of personal hygiene is maintained.
5.2 Requirements Relating to Establishment: Design and Facilities
5.2.1
Location
5.2.1.1 Establishment
Potential sources of contamination need to be considered when deciding where to locate
food establishments, as well as the effectiveness of any reasonable measures that might
be taken to protect food.
Establishments shall not be located anywhere where, after considering such protective
measures, it is clear that there will remain a threat to food safety or suitability. In
particular, establishments shall normally be located away from:
g) Working surfaces that come into direct contact with food shall be in sound
condition, durable and easy to clean, maintain and disinfect. They shall be made
of smooth, non-absorbent materials, and inert to the food, to detergents and
disinfectants under normal operating conditions.
5.2.2.3 Temporary/Mobile Premises and Vending Machines
Premises and structures covered here include market stalls, mobile sales and street
vending vehicles, temporary premises in which food is handled such as tents and
marquees.
Such premises and structures shall be sited, designed and constructed to avoid, as far as
reasonably practicable, contaminating food and harbouring pests.
In applying these specific conditions and requirements, any food hygiene hazards
associated with such facilities shall be adequately controlled to ensure the safety and
suitability of food.
5.2.3
Equipment
5.2.3.1 General
Equipment and containers (other than once-only use containers and packaging) coming
into contact with food, shall be designed and constructed to ensure that, where necessary,
they can be adequately cleaned, disinfected and maintained to avoid the contamination of
food.
Equipment and containers shall be made of materials with no toxic effect in intended use.
Where necessary, equipment shall be durable and movable or capable of being
disassembled to allow for maintenance, cleaning, disinfection, monitoring and, for
example, to facilitate inspection for pests.
5.2.3.2 Food Control and Monitoring Equipment
In addition to the general requirements in paragraph 5.2.3.1, equipment used to cook, heat
treat, cool, store or freeze food shall be designed to achieve the required food
temperatures as rapidly as necessary in the interests of food safety and suitability, and
maintain them effectively. Such equipment shall also be designed to allow temperature
to be monitored and controlled.
Where necessary, such equipment shall have effective means of controlling and
monitoring humidity, air-flow and any other characteristic likely to have a detrimental
effect on the safety or suitability of food. These requirements are intended to ensure that:
FACILITIES
5.2.4.8 Storage
Where necessary, adequate facilities for the storage of food, ingredients and non-food
chemicals (e.g. cleaning material, lubricants, fuels) shall be provided.
Where appropriate, food storage facilities shall be designed and constructed to:
a)
b)
c)
d)
Note-The type of storage facilities required will depend on the nature of the food. Where
necessary, separate, secure storage facilities for cleaning materials and hazardous
substances shall be provided.
5.3 Requirements Relating to Control of Operation
5.3.1
Food business operators shall control food hazards through the use of systems such as
HACCP (see IS 15000: 2005). They shall:
a)
b)
c)
d)
identify any steps in their operations which are critical to the safety of food;
implement effective control procedures at those steps;
monitor control procedures to ensure their continuing effectiveness; and
review control procedures periodically, and whenever the operations change.
These systems shall be applied throughout the food chain to control food hygiene
throughout the shelf-life of the product through proper product and process design.
Control procedures may be simple, such as checking stock rotation, calibrating
equipment, or correctly loading refrigerated display units. In some cases a system based
on expert advice, and involving documentation, may be appropriate. A model of such a
food safety system is described in IS 15000: 2005.
5.3.2
chilling
thermal processing
irradiation
drying
chemical preservation
vacuum or modified atmospheric packaging.
Surfaces, utensils, equipment, fixtures and fittings shall be thoroughly cleaned and where
necessary disinfected after raw food, particularly meat and poultry, has been handled or
processed.
5.3.2.5 Physical and Chemical Contamination
Systems shall be in place to prevent contamination of foods by foreign bodies such as
glass or metal shards from machinery, dust, harmful fumes and unwanted chemicals. In
manufacturing and processing, suitable detection or screening devices shall be used
where necessary.
5.3.3
PACKAGING
Packaging design and materials shall provide adequate protection for products to
minimize contamination, prevent damage, and accommodate proper labeling.
Packaging materials or gases where used must be non-toxic and not pose a threat to the
safety and suitability of food under the specified conditions of storage and use.
Where appropriate, reusable packaging shall be suitably durable, easy to clean and, where
necessary, disinfect.
5.3.5
WATER
b) in certain food processes, e.g. chilling, and in food handling areas, provided this
does not constitute a hazard to the safety and suitability of food (e.g. the use of
clean sea water).
Water re-circulated for reuse shall be treated and maintained in such a condition that no
risk to the safety and suitability of food results from its use. The treatment process shall
be effectively monitored. Re-circulated water which has received no further treatment
and water recovered from processing of food by evaporation of drying may be used,
provided its use does not constitute a risk to the safety and suitability of food.
5.3.5.2 As an Ingredient
Potable water (see IS 10500: )
contamination.
The type of control and supervision needed will depend on the size of the business, the
nature of its activities and the types of food involved.
Managers and supervisors shall have enough knowledge of food hygiene principles and
practices to be able to judge potential risks, take appropriate preventive and corrective
action, and ensure that effective monitoring and supervision takes place.
5.3.7
RECALL PROCEDURES
It shall be ensured that effective procedures are in place to deal with any food safety
hazard and to enable the complete, rapid recall of any implicated lot of the finished food
from the market.
Where a product has been withdrawn because of an immediate health hazard, other
products which are produced under similar conditions, and which may present a similar
hazard to public health, shall be evaluated for safety and may need to be withdrawn.
The need for public warnings should be considered.
Recalled products shall be held under supervision until they are destroyed, used for
purposes other than human consumption, determined to be safe for human consumption,
or reprocessed in a manner to ensure their safety.
5.4 REQUIREMENT RELATING TO ESTABLISHEMENT: MAINTENANCE
AND SANITATION
5.4.1 MAINTENACE AND CLEANING
5.4.1.1 General
Establishments and equipment shall be kept in an appropriate state of repair and
condition to:
a) facilitate all sanitation procedures;
b) function as intended, particularly at critical steps (see paragraph 5.3.1);
c) prevent contamination of food, e.g. from metal shards, flaking plaster, debris and
chemicals.
Cleaning shall remove food residues and dirt which may be a source of contamination.
Note-The necessary cleaning methods and material will depend on the nature of the food
business. Disinfection may be necessary after cleaning.
Cleaning chemicals shall be handled and used carefully and in accordance with
manufacturers instructions and stored, where necessary, separated from food, in clearly
identified containers to avoid the risk of contaminating food.
5.4.1.2 Cleaning Procedures and Methods
Cleaning can be carried out by the separate or the combined use of physical methods,
such as heat, scrubbing, turbulent flow, vacuum cleaning or other methods that avoid the
use of water, and chemical methods using detergents, alkalis or acids.
Cleaning procedures will involve, where appropriate:
a) removing gross debris from surfaces;
b) b)applying a detergent solution to loosen soil and bacterial film and hold them in
solution or suspension;
c) rinsing with water which complies with section 5.2.4.1, to remove loosened soil
and residues of detergent;
d) dry cleaning or other appropriate methods for removing and collecting residues
and debris; and
e) where necessary, disinfection with subsequent ringing unless the manufacturers
instructions indicate on scientific basis that ringing is not required.
5.4.2
CLEANING PROGRAMMES
Cleaning and disinfection programmes shall ensure that all parts of the establishment are
appropriately clean and shall include the cleaning of cleaning equipment.
Where written cleaning programmes are used, they shall specify:
a)
b)
c)
d)
5.4.3.1 General
Pests pose a major threat to the safety and suitability of food. Pest infestations can occur
where there are breeding sites and a supply of food. Good hygiene practices shall be
employed to avoid creating an environment conducive to pests. Good sanitation,
inspection of incoming materials and good monitoring can minimize the likelihood of
infestation and thereby limit the need for pesticides.
5.4.3.2 Preventing Access
Buildings shall be kept in good repair and condition to prevent pest access and to
eliminate potential breeding sites. Holes, drains and other places where pests are likely to
gain access shall be kept sealed. Wire mesh screens, for example on open windows,
doors and ventilators, will reduce the problem of pest entry. Animals shall, wherever
possible, be excluded from the grounds of factories and food processing plants.
5.4.3.3 Harbourage and Infestation
The availability of food and water encourages pest harbourage and infestation. Potential
food sources shall be stored in pest-proof containers and/or stacked above the ground and
away from walls.
Areas both inside and outside food premises shall be kept clean. Where appropriate,
refuse shall be stored in covered, pest-proof containers.
5.4.3.4 Monitoring and Detection
Establishments and surrounding areas shall be regularly examined for evidence of
infestation.
5.4.3.5 Eradication
Pest infestations shall be dealt with immediately and without adversely affecting food
safety or suitability. Treatment with chemical, physical or biological agents shall be
carried out without posing a threat to the safety or suitability of food.
5.4.4
WASTE MANAGEMENT
Suitable provision must be made for the removal and storage of waste. Waste must not
be allowed to accumulate in food handling, food storage, and other working areas and the
adjoining environment except so far as is unavoidable for the proper functioning of the
business.
Waste stores must be kept appropriately clean.
5.4.5
MONITORING EFFECTIVENESS
RELATING
TO
ESTABLISHMENT:
PERSONAL
Conditions which shall be reported to management so that any need for medical
examination and/or possible exclusion from food handling can be considered, include:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f)
g)
5.5.3
jaundice
diarrhoea
vomiting
fever
sore throat with fever
visible infected skin lesions (boils, cuts, etc)
discharges from the ear, eye or nose.
PERSONAL CLEANLINESS
Food handlers shall maintain a high degree of personal cleanliness and, where
appropriate, wear suitable protective clothing, head covering, and footwear. Cuts and
wounds, where personnel are permitted to continue working, shall be covered by suitable
waterproof dressing.
Personnel shall always wash their hands, when personal cleanliness may affect food
safety, for example:
a) at the start of food handling activities;
b) immediately after using the toilet; and
c) after handling raw food or any contaminated material, where this could result in
contamination of other food items; they shall avoid handling ready-to-eat food,
where appropriate.
5.5.4
PERSONAL BEHAVIOUR
People engaged in food handling activities shall refrain from behaviour which could
result in contamination of food for example:
a)
b)
c)
d)
smoking
spitting
chewing or eating;
sneezing or coughing over unprotected food.
Personal effects such as jewellery, watches, pins or other items shall not be worn or
brought into food handling areas if they pose threat to the safety and suitability of food.
5.5.5
VISITORS
GENERAL
REQUIREMENTS
Where necessary, conveyances and bulk containers shall be designed and constructed so
that they:
a) do not contaminate foods or packaging;
b) can be effectively cleaned and, where necessary, disinfected;
c) permit effective separation of different foods or foods from non-food items where
necessary during transport;
d) provide effective protection from contamination, including dust and fumes;
e) can effectively maintain the temperature, humidity, atmosphere and other
conditions necessary to protect food from harmful or undesirable microbial
growth and deterioration likely to render it unsuitable for consumption; and
f) allow any necessary temperature, humidity and other conditions to be checked.
5.6.3
Conveyances and containers for transporting food shall be kept in an appropriate state of
cleanliness, repair and condition. Where the same conveyance or container is used for
transporting different foods, or non-foods, effective cleaning and, where necessary,
disinfection shall take place between loads.
Where appropriate, particularly in bulk transport, containers and conveyances shall be
designated and marked for food use only and be used only for that purpose.
5.7 REQUIREMENT RELATING TO PRODUCT INFORMATION AND
CONSUMER AWARENESS
5.7.1
LOT IDENTIFICATION
Lot identification is essential in product recall and also helps effective stock rotation.
Each container of food shall be permanently marked to identify the producer and the lot.
5.7.2
PRODUCT INFORMATION
All food products shall be accompanied by or bear adequate information to enable the
next person in the food chain to handle, display, store and prepare and use the product
safely and correctly.
5.7.3
LABELLING
Prepackaged foods shall be labeled with clear instructions to enable the next person in the
food chain to handle, display, store and use the product safely[ see IS 7688 (Part 1,2 and
3) and also product specific Standard].
5.7.4
CONSUMER EDUCATION
Health education programmes shall cover general food hygiene. Such programmes shall
enable consumers to understand the importance of any product information and to follow
any instructions accompanying products, and make informed choices. In particular
consumers shall be informed of the relationship between time/temperature control and
food borne illness.
5.8 REQUIREMENT RELATING TO TRAINING
5.8.1
Food hygiene training is fundamentally important. All personnel shall be aware of their
role and responsibility in protecting food from contamination or deterioration. Food
handlers shall have the necessary knowledge and skills to enable them to handle food
hygienically. Those who handle strong cleaning chemicals or other potentially hazardous
chemicals shall be instructed in safe handling techniques.
5.8.2
TRAINING PROGRAMMES
Factors to take into account in assessing the level of training required include:
a) the nature of the food, in particular its ability to sustain growth of pathogenic or
spoilage micro-organisms;
b) the manner in which the food is handled and packed, including the probability of
contamination;
c) the extend and nature of processing or further preparation before final
consumption;
d) the conditions under which the food will be stored; and
e) the expected length of time before consumption.
5.8.3
5.8.4
REFRESHER TRAINING
Training programmes shall be routinely reviewed and updated where necessary. Systems
shall be in place to ensure that food handlers remain aware of all procedures necessary to
maintain the safety and suitability of food.
ANNEX A
LIST OF STANDARDS RELATING TO SECTOR SPECIFIC HYGIENE CODE
IS
ANNEX B
CHECKLIST FOR FOOD HYGIENE PRACTICES
Basic Clauses
1.1 Environmental
hygiene
1.2
Hygienic
production of food
sources
Compliance
Yes No
infestations?>
Is the establishment located away from areas from which
wastes cannot be removed effectively?
2.1.2 Equipment
Are the equipment located to permit easy cleaning and
maintenance?
Do the equipment function in accordance to intended use?
Do equipment facilitate good hygiene practices?
2.2.1 Design and Do the internal design and layout of establishment permit
layout
good food hygiene practices including protection from crosscontamination?
2.2.2
Internal Is the structure of establishment built of durable materials
structures
and and easy to clean, maintain and where appropriate, disinfect?
fittings
Are surfaces of walls, partitions and floors made impervious
materials?
Do walls and partitions have smooth surface?
Are floors constructed to allow adequate cleaning and
drainage?
Are ceilings and overhead fixtures constructed and finished
to minimize build up of dirt, condensation and shedding of
particles?
Are windows easy to clean and constructed to minimize
build up of dirt?
Where necessary, are windows fitted with removable and
cleanable insect-proof screens?
Are doors smooth, non-absorbent and easy to clean and
disinfect?
Are working surfaces that come into direct contact with food
of sound condition, durable and easy to clean, maintain and
disinfect?
2.2.3 Temporary / Are temporary/mobile premises located, designed and
mobile premises; constructed to avoid contaminating food and harbouring
vending machines pests?
Are food hygiene hazards in such temporary premises
adequately identified and controlled?
General
a) Is the factory approved under Factory Act?
b) Any open drain blocked sewer or public lavatory nearby?
Is there adequate space for equipment, material and
movement of personnel and materials?
Is there any evidence of entry of insects, rodents & birds
Are lighting and ventilation adequate?
Are facilities for changing street clothes, footwear, washing
and toilets adequately and satisfactorily maintained?
3.6
Management
and Supervision
3.6.2 Knowledge Do Managers and supervisors have enough knowledge of
required
food hygiene principles and practices to be able to judge
potential risks, take appropriate preventive and corrective
action, and ensure that effective monitoring and supervision
takes place.
3.7 Documentation
and Records
3.7.1
Retain Are appropriate records of processing, production and
records
distribution kept and retained for a period that exceeds the
shelf life of the product?
3.7.2 Effectiveness Are QSP'
s available for the following
and credibility
- receipt of raw materials and other components?
- quarantine and storage?
- quality control system and approval / rejection?
- release to production?
- weighing and dispensing?
- processing and production operations?
- packaging and labelling?
- quality control?
- in-process testing & control?
- finished product?
- storage of finished products?
- distribution?
3.8
Recall
procedures
3.8.1
Effective Is there written procedure for product recall in case of
procedures
products known or suspected to be defective?
Is there a designated person responsible for execution and
coordination of product recalls?
3.8.2 Tracing & Are written procedures available for receipt and control of
tracking
return products?
If reasons for returning the product implicates other batches,
- Is an investigation made and report prepared?
3.8.3 Destroy or Are returned or salvaged products destroyed unless QC
reprocess
determines their reprocessing?
4 Establishment: Maintenance and sanitation
4.1
Maintenance
and cleaning
4.1.1 General
Are establishment and equipment kept in an appropriate state
of repair?
Are there necessary cleaning methods and materials?
Are cleaning chemicals handled and used carefully and in
accordance with manufacturers instructions?
Are cleaning chemicals stored separately from food, in
clearly identified containers to avoid the risk of (malicious or
accidental) contamination of food?
4.1.2
Cleaning
procedures
methods
and
Are cleaning schedule available for
- floors
- walls
- ceiling
- doors and windows?
- electrical fitting?
Are QSP'
s available for cleaning & sanitization?
Are disinfectants used rotated?
Are log books maintained for cleaning and sanitation?
Is microbial load monitored in different sections?
Are personnel instructed to observe personal hygiene?
Are hygiene instructions displayed in change rooms &
strategic locations?
Are clean protective clothing provided to personnel?
4.2
Cleaning
programmes
4.2.1 Specifications Do cleaning procedures specify:
- areas, items of equipment and utensils to be cleaned;
- responsibility for particular tasks;
- method and frequency of cleaning;
- monitoring arrangements.
4.2.2 Monitoring Are cleaning and disinfection programmes continually and
and verification
effectively monitored for their suitability and effectiveness
and where necessary, documented?
4.3.1 General
Does the company have a Pest control programme?
4.3.2
Preventing Are buildings kept in good repair and condition to prevent
access
pest access and to eliminate potential breeding sites?
Are holes, drains and other places where pests are likely to
gain
access
kept
sealed?
Where sealing is not possible (e.g. open windows, doors and
ventilators) are measures like wire mesh screens in place to
reduce the problem of pest entry?
Are animals excluded from the grounds of factories and food
processing plants?
4.3.3 Harbourage Are potential food sources stored in pest-proof containers
and infestation
and/or stacked above the ground and away from walls?
Are areas both inside and outside food premises kept clean?
Is refuse stored in covered, pest-proof containers?
4.3.4 Monitoring Are records of regular examination of establishments and
and detection
surroundings available?
4.3.5 Eradication
behaviour
5.4.1
Smoking, Do people engaged in food handling activities refrain from
eating, sneezing
behaviour which could result in contamination of food, for
example:
- - smoking;
- - spitting;
- - chewing or eating;
- - sneezing or coughing over unprotected food.
5.4.2 Jewellery
Are personal effects such as jewellery, watches, pins, etc.
brought in food handling areas?
5.5 Visitors
5.5.1 Cleanliness Do visitors to food manufacturing, processing or handling
and behaviour
areas wear protective clothing and adhere to the other
personal hygiene provisions in this section?
6 Transportation
6.1 General
Is food adequately protected during transport to assure food
safety?
6.2 Requirements Are conveyances and bulk containers
designed and
constructed so that they:
- do not contaminate foods or packaging;
- can be effectively cleaned and, where necessary,
disinfected;
- permit effective separation of different foods or foods from
non-food items where necessary during transport;
- provide effective protection from contamination, including
dust and fumes;
- can effectively maintain the temperature, humidity,
atmosphere and other conditions necessary to protect food
from harmful or undesirable microbial growth and
deterioration likely to render it unsuitable for consumption;
- allow any necessary temperature, humidity and other
conditions to be checked?
6.3
Use
and Are conveyances and containers for transporting food kept
maintenance
in an appropriate state of cleanliness, repair and condition?
If the same conveyance or container is used for transporting
different foods or non-foods, do effective cleaning and,
where necessary, dis-infection take place between loads?
7 Product information and consumer awareness
7.1
Batch Is there master production document for each product being
identification
produced?
Is stage of manufacture clearly indicated on containers?
Is batch production record prepared for each batch of product
and maintained?
Do the batch production records indicate that each significant
95 A U G ~
Bill No. 123 of 2005
ARRANGEMENT OF CLAUSES
CHAPTER I
PRELIMINARY
CHAPTER 11
FOOD SAFETY AND STANDARDS
AUTHORITY
OF INDIA
4. Establishment of Food Safety and Standards Authority of India.
5. Composition of Authority and qualifications for appointment of its Chairperson
and other Members.
6. Selection Committee for selection of Chairperson and Members of Food
Authority.
7. Terms of ofice, salary, allowances and other conditions of service of
Chairperson and Members of Food Authority.
8. Removal of Chairperson ~ n Members
d
of Food Authority.
9. Offcers and other employees of Food Authority.
10. Functions of the Chief Executive Officer.
11. Central Advisory Committee.
12. Functions of Central Advisory Committee.
13. Scientific Panels.
14. Scientific Committee.
15. Procedure for Scientific Committee and Scientific Panel.
16. Duties and functions of Food Authority.
17. Proceedings of Food Authority.
CHAPTER 111
CHAPTER IV
CLAUSES
CHAPTER V
PROVISIONS RELATING
TO IMPORT
25. All import of articles of food to be subject to this Act.
CHAPTER VI
SPECIAL RESPONSIBILITIES AS TO FOOD SAFETY
26. Responsibilities of the food business operators.
27. Liability of the manufacturers, distributors and sellers.
28. Food Recall Procedures.
CHAPTER VII
ENFORCEMENT OF THE ACT
29. Authorities responsible for enforcement of Act.
30. Commissioner of Food Safety of the State.
31. Licensing and registration of food business.
32. Improvement notices.
33. Prohibitions orders.
34. Emergency prohibitions notices and orders.
35. Notification for Food Poisoning.
36. Designated Officer.
37. Food Safety Officer.
38. Powers of the Food Safety Officer.
39. Liability of Food Safety Oficer in certain cases.
40. Purchasers may have food analyzed.
4 1. Powers of search, seizure, investigation, prosecution and procedure thereof.
42. Procedure for launching prosecution.
CHAPTER VII
ANALYSIS
OF FOOD
43. Recognition and accreditation of laboratories, research institutions and referral food
laboratory.
44. Recognition of organization or agency for food safety audit.
45. Food Analysts.
46. Functions of food Analyst.
47. Sampling and analysis.
CHAPTER VIII
OFFENCES
AND PENALTIES
48. General Provisions relating to offences.
49. General Provision relating to penalty.
50. Penalty for selling food not of the nature or substance or quality demanded.
5 1. Penalty for sub-standard food.
52. Penalty for misbranded food. .
53. Penalty for misleading advertisement.
54. Penalty for food containing extraneous matter.
55. Penalty for failure to comply with the directions of the Food Safety Officer.
56. Penalty for unhygienic or unsanitary processing or manufacturing of food.
57. Penalty for possessing adulterant.
58. Penalty for contraventions for which not specific penalty is provided.
59. Punishment for unsafe food.
BILL
to consolidate the laws relating to food and to establish the Food Safety and Standards
Authority of India for laying down science basedstandards for articles offood and to
regulate their manufacture, storage, distribution, sale and import, to ensure
availability of safe and wholesome food for human consumption and for matters
connected therewith or incidental thereto.
BE it enacted by Parliament in the Fifty-sixth Year of the Republic of India as follows:-
CHAPTERI
1. (I) This Act may be called the Food Safety and Standards Act, 2005.
Short title,
extent and
~~mmencement
(3) It shall come into force on such date as the Central Government may, by notification
in the Official Gazette, appoint, and different dates may be appointed for different provisions
of this Act and any reference in any such provision to the commencement of this Act shall be
construed as a reference to the coming into force of that provision.
10
2. It is hereby declared that it is expedient in the public interest that the Union should
Declaration
as to
expediency of
control by
the Union.
Definitions.
(a) "adulterant" means any material which is or could be employed for making
the food unsafe or sub-standard, mis-branded or containing extraneous matter;
(b) "advertisement" means any audio or visual publicity, representation or
pronouncement made by means of any light, sound, smoke, gas, print, electronic 5
media, internet or website and includes through any notice, circular, label, wrapper,
invoice or other documents;
( c ) "Chairperson" means the
j0
(e) " Commissioner of Food Safety" means the Commissioner of Food Safety
appointed under section 30;
'
u> "consumer" means and includes person and families purchasing and receiving
food in order to meet their personal needs;
(g) "contaminant" means any substance, whether or not added to food, but
which is present in such food as a result of the production (including operations
carried out in crop husbandry, animal husbandry or veterinary medicine), manufacture,
processing, preparation, treatment, packing, packaging, transport or holding of such
food or as a result of environmental contamination and does not include insect
fragments, rodent hairs and other extraneous matter;
Is
2 0
Provided that the Central thvernment may declare, by notification in the Official
Gazette, any other article as food for the purposes of this Act having regards to its use,
nature, substance or quality;
3s
(k) "food additive" means any substance not normally consumed as a food by
itself or used as a typical ingredient of the food, whether or not it has nutritive value,
the intentional addition of which to food for a technological~(includingorganoleptic) 4 o
purpose in the manufacture, processing, preparation, treatment, packing, packaging,
transport or holding of such food results, or may be reasonably expected to result
(directly or indirectly), in it or its by-products becoming a component of or otherwise
affecting the characteristics of such food but does not include "contaminants" or
substances added to food for maintaining or improving nutritional qualities;
45
(I) " Food Analyst" means an analyst appointed under section 45;
(m) " Food Authority" means the Food Safety and Standards Aut9ority of India
established under section 4;
(n)"food business" means any undertaking, whether for profit or not and whether
public or private, carrying out any ofthe activities related to any stage of manufacture,
processing, storage, transportation and distribution of food and includes food services,
sale of food or food ingredients;
(p) "food laboratory" means any food laboratory or institute established by the
Central or a State Government or any other agency and accredited by National
I o Accreditation Board for Testing and Calibration Laboratories or an equivalent
accreditation agency and recognized by the Food Authority under section 43;
(q)"food safety" means assurance that food is acceptable for human consumption
according to its intended use;
(t) " Food Safety Officer " means an officer appointed under section 37;
(u) "hazard" means a biological, chemical or physical agent in, or condition of,
food with the potential to cause an adverse health effect ;
(v) " import" means bringing into India any article of food by land, sea or air;
25
(w) "improvement notice" means an order issued under section 32 of this Act;
(x) "infant food" and "infant milk substitute" shall have the meanings assigned
to them in clauses (nand (g)ofsub-section (I) of section 2 ofthe Infant Milk Substitutes,
Feeding Bottles and Infant Foods (Regulation of Production, Supply and Distribution)
Act,1992, respectively;
(41 of 1992)
30
(y) "ingredient" means any substance, including a food additive used in the
manufacture or preparation of food and present in the final product , possibly in a
modified form;
(z) "label" means any tag, brand, mark, pictorial or other descriptive matter ,
written, printed, stencilled, marked, embossed, graphic, perforated, stamped or
35 impressed on or attached to container, cover, lid or crown of any food package and
includes a product insert;
(16) "local area" means any area , whether urban or rural , notified by the
Commissioner of Food Safety, to be a local area for the purposes of this Act;
40
45
(zfl "misbninded food" means an article of food(A) if it is purported, or is represented to be, or is being( i ) offered or promoted for sale with false, misleading or deceptive
claims either:
(a) upon the label of the package, or
(B) ifthe article is sold in packages which have been sealed or prepared by
or at the instance of the manufacturer or producer bearing his name and address
but(i) the article is an imitation of, or is a substitute for, or resembles in
a manner likely to deceive, another article of food under the name ofwhich I 5
it is sold, and is not plainly and conspicuously labelled so as to indicate its
true character; or
(ii) the package containing the article or the label on the package
bears any statement, design or device regarding the ingredients or the
substances contained therein, which is false or misleading in any material 2 0
particular, or if the package is otherwise deceptive with respect to its
contents; or
(iii) the article is offered for sale as the product of any place or
country which is false; or
(C) if the article contained in the package-
25
(zT) " prohibition order" means an order issued under section 33 of this Act;
(zm) "risk", in relation to any article offood, means the probability of an adverse
effect on the health of consumers of such food and the severity of that effect,
consequential to a food hazard;
lb
/S
(zq) "risk management" means the process, distinct from risk assessment, of
evaluating policy alternatives, in consultation with all interested parties considering
risk assessment and other factors relevant for the protection of health of consumers
and for the promotion offair trade practices, and, if needed, selecting appropriate
prevention and control options.;
(zr)"sale" with its grammatical variations and cognate expressioas, means the
sale of any article of food, whether for cash or on credit or by way of exchange and
whether by wholesale or retail, for human consumption or use, or for analysis,
and includes an agreement for sale, an offer for sale, the exposing for sale or having
in possession for sale of any such article, and includes also an attempt to sell any such
2 5 article;
20
(zs)"sample" means a sample of any article of food taken under the provisions of
this Act or any rules and regulations made thereunder;
(zt) " specified by regulations" means specified by regulations made by the
Food Authority.
30
(zu) "standard", in relation to any article pf food, means the standards notified
by the Food Authority;
(N) '' State Govenunent" in relation to a Union territory means the Administrator
of that Union territory appointed by the President under article 239 ofthe Constitution;
40 section 70;
(z2) "unsafe food" means an article of food whose nature, substance or quality
is so affected as to render it injurious to health:
(i) by the article itself, or its package thereof, which is composed, whether
wholly or in part, of poisonous or deleterious substances; or
45
(ii)by the article consisting, wholly or in part, of any filthy, putrid, rotten,
decomposed or diseased animal substance or vegetable substance; or
insects; or
(x) by virtue of its being prepared, packed or kept under in sanitary I>conditions; or
(xz] by virtue of its being mis-branded or sub-standard or food containing
extraneous matter.
(2) Any reference in this Act to a law which is not in force in the State of Jammu and
Kashmir shall, in relation to that State, be construed as a reference to the corresponding Law,
if any, in force in that State.
20
CHAPTER II
Establishment
of Food
Safety and
Standards
Authority o f
India.
!A(
(2) The Food Authority shall be a body corporate by the name aforesaid, having
perpetual succession and a common seal with power to acquire, hold and dispose of property,
both movable and immovable, and to contract and shall, by the said name, sue or be sued.
(3) The head office of the Food Authority shall be at Delhi.
30
(4) The Food Authority may establish its offices at any other place in India.
Composition
of Food
Authority and
qualifications
for
appointment
of its
Chairperson
and other
Members.
5. (I) The Food Authority shall consist of a Chairperson and the following eighteen
members namely:(a) seven Members, not below the rank of a Joint Secretary to the Government of
India, to be appointed by the Central Government, to respectively represent the
Ministries or Departments of the Central Government dealing with( i ) Agriculture,
(ii)Commerce,
(iii)ConsumerAffairs,
35
(2) The Chairperson and other Members of the Food Authority shall be appointed in
such a manner so as to secure the highest standards of competence, broad range of relevant
expertise, and shall represent, the broadest possible geographic distribution within the country.
(3) The Chairperson shall be appointed by the.Central Govimunent fio& amongst the
persons of eminence in the field of food science or fiom amongst the persons fioni the
J( administration who have been associated with the subject and is either holding or hasjheld
the position of not below the rank of Secretby to the Government of India.
(4) The Chairperson and the Members other than ex oficio Members of the Food
Authority shall be appointed by the Central Government on the recommendations of the
Selection Committee.
26
(5) The Chairperson or Members other than ex officio Members ofthe Food Authority
shall not hold any other office.
6. (1) The Central Government shall, for the purpose of selection of the Chairperson
and the Members other than ex officio Members ofthe Food Authority, constitute a Selection
Committee consisting of-
2g
40
(2) The Central Government shall, within two months fiom the date of occurrence of
any vacancy by reason of death, resignation or removal of the Chairperson or a Member of
the Food Authority and three months before the superannuationor completion of the term of
office of the Chairperson or any Member of that Authority, make a reference to the Selection
Committee for filling up of the vacancy.
(3) The Selection Committee shall finalisethe selection of the Chairpersonand Members
of the Food Authority within two months from the date on which the reference is made to it.
(4) The Selection Committee shall recommend a panel of two names for every vacancy
referred to it.
Selection
Committee
for selection
0f
Chairperson
and Members
of Food
Authority.
7. (1) The Chairperson and the members other than ex officio Members shall hold
office for a term of three years from the date on which they enter upon their offices, and shall
be eligible for re-appointment for a further period of three years:
Provided that no Chairperson or a member other than ex officio Member shall hold f 0
off~ceas such after he has attained( a ) in the case of the Chairperson, the age of sixty-five years, and
( b ) in the case of a Member, the age of sixty-two years.
(2)The salary and allowances payable to, and the other terms and conditions of
service of, the Chairperson and Members other than ex-officio Members shall be such as I 5
may be prescribed by the Central Government.
(3) The Chairperson and every Member shall, before entering upon his office, make
and subscribe to an oath of office and of secrecy in such form and in such manner and before
such authority as may be prescribed by the Central Government.
36
9. (1) There shall be a Chief Executive Officer ofthe Food Authority, not below the rank
ofAdditional Secretary to the Government of India, who shall be ex officio Commissioner of
Food Safety, t i be appointed by the Central Government.
40
(2)The Food Authority may, with the approval of the Central Government, determine
the number, nature and categories of other officers and employees required to the Food
45
Authority in the discharge of its hnctions.
(3) The salaries and allowances payable to, and other conditions of service of, the
Chief Executive Officer, officers and other employeesshall be such as may be specified by
regulations by the Food Authority with the approval of the Central Government
10. (1) The Chief Executive Officer shall be the legal representative of the Food
Authority and shall be responsible for(a) the day-to-day administration of the Food Authority;
Functions of
the Chief
Executive
Oficer.
la
I5
(e) ensuring that the Food Authority carries out its tasks in accordance with the
requirements of its users, in particular with regard to the adequacy of the services
provided and the time taken;
20
(2) Every year, the Chief Executive Officer shall submit to the Food Authority for
approval-
(a) a general report covering all the activities of the Food Authority in the
previous year;
(b)programmes of work;
(c) the annual accounts for the previous year; and
(d) the budget for the coming year.
(3) The chief ~xecutiveOficer shal1,followingadoption by the Food Authority, forward
the general report and the programmes to the Central Government and the State Govenunents
and shall have them published.
30
(4) The Chief Executive Officer shall approve all fmancial expenditure of the Food
Authority and report on the Authority's activities to the Central Government.
(5) The Chief Executive Officer shall exercise the powers of the Commissioner of Food
Safety while dealing with matters relating to food safety of such articles.
(6) The Chief Executive Officer shall have administrativecontrol over the officers and
(2) The Central Advisory Committee shall consist of two members each to represent
the interests of food industry, agriculture, consumers, relevant research bodies and food
ko laboratories, and all Commissioners of Food Safety, and the Chairperson of the Scientific
Committee shall be ex ofticio member.
hf
Central
Advisory
Committee.
(4) The Chief Executive Officer shall be ex officio Chairperson of the Central Advisory
Committee.
(5) The Central Advisory Committee shall follow such rules ofprocedure including its
transaction of business as may be specified by regulations.
Functions of
Central .
Advisory
Committee.
12. (1) The Central Advisory Committee shall ensure close co-operation between the 5
Food Authority and the enforcement agencies and organisations operating in the field of
food.
(2) The Central Advisory Committee shall advise the Food Authority on(a) the performance of its duties under this section and in particular in drawing
up of a proposal for the Food Authority's work programme,
10
13. (1) The Food Authority shall establish scientific panels, which shall consist of
independent scientific experts.
(2) The Scientific Panel shall invite the relevant industry and consumer representative 20
in its deliberations.
(3) Without prejudice to the provisions of sub-section (I), the Food Authority may
establish as many Scientific Panels as it considers necessary in addition to the Panels on:
(a) food additives, flavourings, processing aids and materials in contact with
food;
25
foods;
30
14. (1) The Food Authority shall constituteScientific Committee which shall consist of
the Chairpersonsof the Scientific Panels and six independent scientific experts not belonging
or affiliated to any of the Scientific Panels.
(2) The Scientific Committee shall be responsiblefor providing the scientific opinions to
the Food Authority, and shall have the powers, where necessary, of organizingpublic hearings.
(3)The Scientific Committee shall be responsiblefor the general coordination necessary
to ensure consistency of the scientific opinion procedure and in particular with regard to the
adoption of working procedures and harmonisation of working methods of the Scientific
Panel.
4a
(4) The Scientific Committee shall provide opinions on multi-sectoral issues falling
within the competence of more than one Scientific Panel, and on issues which do not fill
within the competence of any of the Scientific Panel.
(5) Wherever necessary, and particularly in the case of subjects which do not fall
5 within the competence of any of the Scientific Panel, the Scientific Committee shall set up
working groups and in such cases, it shall draw on the expertise of those working groups
when establishing scientific opinions.
16
15, (I) The members ofthe Scientific Committee, who are not members ofthe Scientific
Panel and the members of the Scientific Panel shall be appointed by the Food Authority, for
a period of three-years, which shall be renewable, for such period, and the vacancy notice
shall be published in the relevant leading scientific publications and on the Food Authority's
'website for a call for expressions of interest.
Procedure for
Scientific
Committee
and Scientific
Panel.
(2) The Scientific Committee and the Scientific Panel shall each choose a Chairperson
fiom amongst their members.
1s
(3) The Scientific Committee and the Scientific,Panel shall act by a majority of their
members and the views of the members shall be recorded.
(4) The procedure for the operation and co-operation of the Scientific Committee and
the Scientific Panel shall be specified by regulations.
(5) These procedures shall relate in particular to(a) the number of times that a member can serve consecutively on a Scientific
Committee or Scientific Panel;
3 0
25
(4the manner in which tasks and requests for scientific opinions are assigned
.
to the Scientific Committee and the Scientific Panel;
(e) the creation and organisation ofthe working groups of the Scientific Committee
and the Scientific Panel, and the possibility of external experts being included in those
working groups;
30
35
16.(1) It shall be the duty of the Food Authority to regulate and monitor the manufacture,
processing, distribution, sale and import of food so as to ensure safe and wholesome food.
(2) Without prejudice to the provisions of sub-section (I), the Food Authority may by
regulations specify--
40
(a) the standards and guidelines in relation to articles of food and specifying an
appropriate system for enforcing various standards notified under this Act;
(b) the limits for use of food additives, crop contaminants, pesticide residues,
residues of veterinary drugs, heavy metals, processing aids, myco-toxins, antibiotics
and pharmacological active substances and irradiation of food ;
45
Duties and
Functions of
Food
Authority.
(d) the procedure and the enforcement of quality control in relation to any
article of food imported into India;
( e ) the procedure and guidelines for accreditati9 of laboratories and notification
of the accredited laboratories;
(h) food labelling standards including claims on health, nutrition, special dietary
uses and food category systems for foods ; and
(i) the manner in which and the procedure subject to which risk analysis, risk
assessment, risk communication and risk management shall be undertaken.
10
(a) provide scientific advice and technical support to the Central Government
and the State Governments in matters of framing the policy and rules in areas which
have a direct or indirect bearing on food safety and nutrition;
15
(b) search, collect, collate, analyse and summarise relevant scientific and technical
data particularly relating t e
(i) food consumption and the exposure of individuals to risks related to
the consumption of food;
26
(g) take all such steps to ensure that the public, consumers, interested parties Y 0
and all levels of panchayats receive rapid, reliable, objective and comprehensive
information through appropriate methods and means;
(h) provide, whether within or outside their area, training programmes in food
safety and standards for persons who are or intend to become Involved in food
Q5
businesses, whether as food business operators or employees or otherwise;
(i) undertake any other task assigned to it by the Central Government to carry
out the objects of this Act;
(j)contribute to the development of international technical standards for food,
sanitary and phyto-sanitary standards;
its activities.
(5) The Food Authority may, from time to time give such directions, on matters relating
to food safety and standards, to the Commissioner of Food Safety, who shall be bound by
such directions while exercising his powers under.this Act;
(6) The Food Authority shall not disclose or cause to be disclosed to third parties
confidential information that it receives for which confidential treatment has been requested
and has been acceded, except for information which must be made public if circumstances so
require. in order to protect public health.
17. (1) The Food Authority shall meet at the head office or any of its ofices at such
time as the Chairperson may direct, and shall observe such rules of procedure in regard to the
transaction of busi~essat its meetings (including the quorum at its meetings) as may be
specified by regulations.
(2) If the Chairperson is unable to attend a meeting of the Food Authority, any other
Member nominated by the Chairperson in this behalf and, in the absence of such nomination
or where there is no Chairperson, any Member chosen by the Members present from amongst
themselves, shall preside at the meeting.
(3) All questions which come up befor? any meeting of the Food Authority shall be
decided by a majority of votes of the Members present ar,d voting, and in the event of an
equality of votes, the Chairperson or the person presiding over the meeting shall have the
right to exercise a second or casting vote.
(4) Ail orders and decisions of the Food Authority shall be authenticated by the Chief
Executive Officer.
(5) The Chief Executive Ofilcer shali take part in the meetings of the Food Authority
but without a right to vote.
(6) The Food Authority may invite the Chairperson cf the Scientific Committee to
attend its meetings b u without a right to vote.
Proceedings
Authority.
CHAPTER 111
GENERAL PRINCIPLES
OF
FOODSAFI:TY
General
18. The Central Government. the Sta!e Governments, the Food Authoritv and other
p rinci pl es
agencies, as the case may be, while implementing the provisions ofthis Act shall be guided
be followed in
adrninistrat~on by the following principles, namely :of Act.
(1) (4) endeavour to achieve an appropriate level of protection of human life
and health and the protection of consumers' interests, including fair practices in all I b
kind of food trade with reference to food safety standard and practices;
( h )carry out risk management which shall include taking into account the results
of risk assessment, and other factors which in the opinion of the Food Authority are
relevant to the matter under consideration where the conditions are relevant, in order
to achieve. the general objectives of regulations ;
iT
(4 the measures adopted on the basis of clause & shall be proportionate and
no more restrictive of trade than is required to achieve appropriate level of health
protection, regard being had to technical and economic feasibility and other factors
regarded as reasonable a!~dproper in the matter under consideration :
( e ) the measures adopted shall be reviewed within a reasonable period of time, a 9
depending on the nature of the risk to life or health being identified and the type of
scientific infonnation needed to clarify the scientific uncertainty and ta conduct a
more comprehensive risk assessment ;
CI) in cases where there are reasonable grounds to suspect rhat a food may
present a risk for human health, then, depending on the nature, seriousness and extent 30
of that risk, the Food Authority and the Commissioner of Food Safety shall take
appropriate steps to inform the general public of the nahlre of the risk to health,
identifying to the hllest extent possible the food or type of food, the risk that it may
present, and the measures which are taken or about to be taken to prevent, reduce or
35
eliminate that risk; and
( g ) Where any food which fails to comply with food safety requirements is part
of a batch, lot or consignment of food of the same class or description, it shall be
presumed until the contrary is proved, that all of the food in that batch, lot or
consignment fails to comply with those requirements.
(2) The Food Authority shall, while framing regulations or specifying standards 0 0
under this Act(a) take into accounc(i) prevalent practices and conditions in the country including agricultural
practices and handling, storage and transport conditions; and
(ii) international standards and practices, where international standards 4 S
or practices exist or are in the process ~f being formulated,
unless it is of opinion that taking into account of such prevalent practices and
conditions or international standards or practices or any particular part thereof would
not be effective or appropriate means for securing the objectives of such regulations
or where there is a scientific justification or where they would result in a different level
of protection From the one determined as appropriate in the country;
(b) specify food standards on the basis of risk analysis except where it is of
opinion that such analysis is not appropriate to the circumstances clr the nature of the
case;
(c) undertake risk assessment based on the available scientific evidenc? and in
an independent; objective and transparent manner;
lo
(J)ensure prevention of(i) fraudulent , dcccptive or unfair trade practices which may mislead or
harm the consumer; and
(ii) unsafe or contaminated or sub-standard food.
CHAPTER IV
G5?;rRAL, PROVISIONS AS TO AKTIC1.E.S OF FOOC
19. No article of food shall contain any food additive or processing aid unless it is in
accordance with the provisions of this Act and regulations made there under.
zS
30
Explanarion.-For the purposes o!'this secfion, "processing aid" means any substance
or msterial, ~ o i11c:uding
t
apparatus or utensi!~,and not consumed as a fond ingredient by
itself, used in the processing of raw materials, h o d s or its ingredients to hlfill a certain
technological purpose during treatment or processing and which may result in the nonintentional but unavoidable presence of residues or derivatives in the final ~ruduct.
20. No article of f ~ o dshall contain any contaminant, naturally occurrlfig toxic
substances or toxins or hormone or heavy meta!s in excess of such quantities as may be
specified by regulations . .
Use of fond
addiliv-, or
processing
aid.
contaminant^,
naturaily
occurring
tOXlC
substances,
heavy metals,
etc.
21. (I) No article of food shall contain insetricides or pesticides residue, veterinary
drugs residues, antibiotic residues, solvent residues. pharmacologicai active substances
3 r and micro-biological counts in excess of such toterance limit as may be specified by
regulations.
46 of 1968.
?a
(I) "pesticide residue" means any specified substance hl food resulting from
the use of z pesticide and includes any derivatives of a pesticide, such as conversion
products, metabolites, reaction products and impurities considered to be of toxicological
significance and also includes such residues coming into food from environment;
Pesttcides,
veterninary
dnlgs residues,
antibiotic
residueq and
microbiological
counts.
22. Save as otherwise provided under this Act and regulations made thereunder, no
person shall manufacture, distribute, sell or import any novel food, genetically modified 5
articles of food, irradiated food, organic foods, foods for special dietary uses, functional
foods, neutraceuticals, health supplements, proprietary foods and such other articles of
food which the Central Government may notify in this behalf.
16
(b) (i) a product that is labeled as a 'Food for special dietary uses or
functional foods or nutraceuticalsor health supplemellts or similar such foods'
which is not represented for use as a conventional food and whereby such
products may be formulated in the form of powders, granules, tablets, capsules, g a
liquids, jelly and other dosage forms but not parenterals, and are meant for oral
administration;
(il) such product does not include a drug as defined in clause (b) and
ayurvedic, sidha and unani drugs as defined in clauses (a) snd (h) of section 3 of
35 23 of 1940.
the Drug and Cosmetic Act, 1940 and rules made there under;
(iii) does not claim to cure or mitigate any specific disease, disorder or
condition (except for certain health benefit or such promotion claims) as may be
permitted by thz rules made under this Act;
(iv) does not include a narcotic drug or a psychotropic substance as
defined in the ~che'duleof the Narcotic Drugs and Psychotropic Substances $0
Act, 1985 and rules made there under and substances listed in Schedules E and 61 of
EI ofthe Drugs and Cosmetic Rules, 1945;
(2) "genetically engineered or modified food" means food and food ingredients
composed of or containing genetically modified or engineered organisms obtained
through modem biotechnology, or food and food ingredients produced from but not 4 5
containing genetically modified or engineered organisms obtained through modem
biotechnology;
(3) " organic food" means food products that have been produced in accordance
with specified organic production standards ;
198s.
(4) "proprietary and novel food" means an article of food for which standards
have not been specified but is not unsafe:
Provided that such food does not contain any of the foods and ingredients
prohibited under this Act and regulations made thereunder.
23. ( 1 )No person shall manufacture, distribute, sell or expose for sale or dispatch or
deliver to any agent or broker for the purpose of sale, any packaged food products which are
not marked and labelled in the manner as may be specified by regulations:
Packaging
and labelling
o f foods.
Provided that the labels shall not contain any statement, claim, design or device which
is false or misleading in any particularconcerning the food products contained in the package
la or concerning the quantity or the nutritive value impIying medicinal or therapeutic claims or
in relation to the place of origin of the said food products.
Is
(2) Every food business operator shall ensure that the labelling and presentation of
food, including their shape, appearance or packaging, the packaging materials used, the
manner in which they are arranged and the setting in which they are displayed, and the
information which is made available about them through whatever medium, does not mislead
consumers.
24. (1)No advertisement shall be made of any food which is misleading or contravenes
the provisions of this Act, the rules and regulations made thereunder.
(2) No person shall engage himself in any unfair trade practice for purpose ofpromoting
2 a the sale, supply, use and consumption of articles of food o: adopt any unfair or deceptive
practice including the practice of making any statement, whether orally or in writing or by
visible representation which-
Restrictions
o f advertisement and
prohibition as
to unfair
trade
practices.
(a) falsely represents that the foods are of a particular standard, quality, quantity
or grade-composition;
2 5
(b) makes a false or misleading representation concerning the need for, or the
usefulness;
(c) gives to the pablic any guarantee of the efficacy that is not based on an
adequate or scientific justification thereof:
Provided that where a defence is raised to the effect that such guarantee is based on
30 adequate or scientific justification, the burden of proof of such defence shall lie on the
person raising such defence.
matter;
(ii)any article of food for the import of which a licence is requiredunder any Act
or regulation, except in accordance with the cooditions of the licence; and
46
( 22 of 1992)
(iii) any article of food in contravention of any other provision of this Act or of
any rile and regulation made thereunder or any other Act.
(2) The Central Government shall , while prohibiting, restricting or otherwise regulating
import of article of food under the Foreign Trade ( Development and Regulation )Act, 1.992,
follow the standards laid down by the Food Authority under the provisions of this Act and
the rules and regulations made thereunder.
P.11 imports
o f ai-ticles o f
food to be
subject to this
Act.
Responsihllitia
o f the tbod
bilsiness
operator.
26. (1) Every food Susiness operator shall ensure that the articles of food satisfy the
requirements of this Act and the rules anc! regulations made thereunder at all stages of
production, processing, import, distribution and sale within the businesses under his control. 5-
(2) No food business operator shall himse!f or by any person on his behalf manufacture,
store, sell or distribute any article of food-(i)
which is unsafe ; or
(iv) which is for the time being prohibited by the Food Authority or the Central
Government or the state Government in the interest of public health; or
(2) ?u'ofood business operator shall enploy mi person who is suffering from infectious,
contagious or loathsome disease.
(4) No food business operator shall sell or offer for sale any article of f ~ o dto any
vendor unless he also give a guarantee in writing in the form specified by regulations about
the cature and quality of such article to the vendor :
20
Provided that a bili, cash memo, or invoice in respect of the sale of any article of food
given by a food bl~sinessoperator to rhe vendor sha!! be deemed to he a guararltee ander
rhis sectioil, even if a guarantee in the specified fonn is not included in the bill. casr: memo or
invoice.
(5) Wbere any food which is unsafe is part of a batch, lot or consignment of food of the 25
s a w ciass or description, it shall be presumed that all the food in that batch, lot or consignment
is also unsafe, unless following a detaiicd assessment within a specified time, it is found that
there i q no evidence that the rest of the batch, !ot or consignment is unsafe:
Provided that any conformity of a food with specific provisions applicable to that
food shal! be without prejudice to the competent authcrities taking appropriate measures to 30
impose restrictions on that food being placed on the market or to requlre its withdrawal from
the market fa: the reasons to be recorded in writing where such authorities suspect that,
despite the conformit?, the food is unsafe.
Liability of
the
manufacturers,
distributors
and sellers.
27. (1)The manufacturer ofan article of food shall be liable for such article of food if
it does not meet the requiremeats of this Act and the rules and regulations made thereunder. 3 5
(2) The distributor shall be liable under this Act for any article of food which is(a) supplied after the date of its expiry or which is likely to expire; or
or
(4) unidentifiable of manufacturer from whom the artic!e of food have been
received; c r
(e) stored or handled or kept in violation of the provisions of this Act, the rules
and regulations made thereunder.
( 3 )The seller shall be liable under this Act, for any article of food which-
(a) is sold after the date of its expiry or which is likeiy to expire; or
(b) is handled or kept in unhygienic conditions; or
( c ) is misbranded ;or
28. (1) If a food business operator considers or has reason to believe that a food
which it has processed, manufactured or distributed is not in compliance with this Act and
the rules and regulations made thereunder, it shall immediately initiate procedures to withdraw
the food in question from the market and consumers jndicating reasons for its withdrawal
and inform the competent authorities thereof.
Food recall
procedures.
(2) A food business operator'shall immediately inform the competent authorities and
co-operate with them, if it considers or has reasons to believe that a food which it has placed
on the market may be injurious to human healtf!.
( 3 ) The food business operator shall inform the competent authorities of the action
taken to prevent risks to the consumer and shal! riot prevent or discourage zny person from
co-operating. in accordance with this Act, with the competent authorities, where this may
prevent, reduce or eliminate a risk arising From a food.
(1)Every food business operator shall follow such conditions and guidelines relating
to food recall procedures as the Food Authority may speci@ by regulations.
CHAPTER VII
29. (1) The Food Authority and the State Food SafetyAu:horities shal! be responsible
for the enforcement of this Act.
(2) The Food Authority and the State Food Safqty Authonties shall monitor and verify
that the relevant requirements of law are fulfilied by food business onerdtors z: all stages of
food business.
Authnritirs
responsbilc
i or
enf~3rcen:ent
of Acr
(3)The authorities shall maintain a system of controi anr! ol!ler activ~tiesas appropriate
to the circumstances, including ptiblic communicatiofi on f o ~ safety
d
and ris!i, food saiety
surveillance and other monitoring ncrivities coverin3 a11 stzges ocfood bilsiness.
(4) The Food Safety Oflicers shall enforce and execute within their area the provisions
ofthis Act with respect to which the duty is r.ot imposed expressly or by necessary implication
on some otherauthority.
(5) The regulations under this Act shall specify which of the Food Safe9 OORci-.r are
to enforce and execute them, eitti~rger~erallyor in relation to cases ofa particular descr-iption
or aparticular area, and any such reguiations or orders may provide for the giving of assistance
and information, by any authority concerned in the adminisrration of thr: regulations or
orders, or of any provisions ofthis Act, to any other authority so concerned, :i:r :he pu:poses
of their respective duties under them.
(6)The Commissioner of Food Safety and Designated Officer s!lall exetzise the same
powers as are conferred on the Food Safety Officer and follow the same prcrcedure specified
in this Act.
30. (1) The State Government shall appoint the Con~missionerof Food Safety for the
State for efficient implementation of food safety and standards and other requirements laid
down under this Act and the rules and regulations made thereunder.
Commissioner
of Food
Safety of the
State.
(2) The Commissionerof Food Safety shall perform all or any ofthe following functions,
namely:(a) prohibit in the interest of public health, the manufacture, storage, distribution
or sale of any article of food, either in the whole of the State or any area or part thereof
for such period, not exceeding one year, as may be specified in the order notified in this 5
behalf in the Official Gazette;
(b) cany out survey of the industrial units engaged in the manufacture or
processing of food in the State to find out compliance by such units of the standards
notified by the Food Authority for various articles of food;
(c) conduct or organize training programmes for the personnel of the ofice of lo
the Commissioner of Food Safety and, on a wider scale, for different segments of food
chain for generating awareness on food safety;
Act;
(f) such other functions as the State Government may, in consultation with the
Food Authority, prescribe.
31. (1) No person shall commence or cany on any food business except under a
licence.
2c
(2)Nothing contained in sub-section (I) shall apply to such petty manufacturer who
himself manufactures or sells any article of food or a retailer as may be notified by the Food
Authority, or a hawker, itinerant vendor or a temporary stall holder:
Provided that such petty manufacturer, retailer, hawker, itinerant vendor or a temporary
stall holder shall only register their business with concerned municipality or the Panchayat, 3 a
as the case may be.
(3) Any person desirous to commence or cany on any food business shall make an
application for grant of a license to the Designated Officer in such manner containing such
particulars as may be specified by regulations.
(4) The Designated Officer on receipt of an application under sub-section (2). may 3 5
either grant the license or after giving the applicant an opportunity of being heard and for
reasons to be recorded in writing, refuse to grant a licence to any applica~t,if he is satisfied
that it is necessary so to do in the interest of public health and sha!l make available to the
applicant a copy of order:
Provided that if a license is not issued within two months from the date of making the 40
application or his application is not rejected, the applicant may start his food business after
expiry s f the said period and in such a case, the Designated Officer shall not refuse to issue
a licence b~itmay, if he considers necessary, issue an improvement notice, under section 32
and follow pr~~ccdures
in that regard.
(5) Every !icence shall be in such form and subject to such conditions as may be 4 5
specified by regulations.
(6)Asing;e licence may be issued by the Designated Oficer for one or more articles of
food and also for different establishments or premises in the same area.
( 7 ) ifthe articles of food are manufactured, stored, sold or exhibited for sale at different
premises situated in more than one area, separate applications shall be made and separate
licence shall be issued in respect of such premises not falling within the same area.
S
(8) An appeal against tke order of rejection for the grant of license shall lie to the
Commissioner of Food SaC:?y.
(9) A licence unless sooner suspended or cancelled shall be in force for such period
as may be specified by regulations:
Io
Provided that if an application for a renewal of licence is made before the expiry
ofthe period of validity ofthe licence, the licence shall continue to be in force until orders are
passed on the application.
(10) The licence shall subsist for the benefit of the deceased's personal representative
or any other member of his family, until the expiry of(a) the period of three months beginning with his death; or
(b) such longer period as the Designated Oflicer may allow.
IF
32. (1) If the Designated Officer has reasonable ground for believing that any food
business operator has tailed to comply with any regulations to which this section applies, he
may, by a notice sewed on that food business operator (in this Act referred to as an
"improvement noticeu)-(a) state the grounds for believing that the food business operator has failed to
comply with the regulations;
20
(b) specify the matters which constitute the food business operator's failure so
to comply;
(c) specify the measures which, in the opinion of the said Authority, the food
business operator must take, in order to secure compliance; and
2f;
(2) If the food business operator fails to comply with an improvement notice, his
licence may be suspended.
30
(3) If the food business operator still fails to comply with thf:
notice, the
Designated Officer may, after giving the licensee an opportunity to show cause, cancel the
licence granted to him:
Provided that the Designated Officer may s~spendany iicence forthwith in the interest
of public health for rezsons to be recorded in writing.
35
(5) The period within which such rn appeal may be brought shall be+
((I) fifteen dzys from the date on which mtice orthe decisior! was sewed on the
persan desiring to appcal; or
(6) in the case cf an appeal under sub-section (i), the said period or the period
specified in the improven?entiloticc,whichever expires carlier;
Improvement
Notices.
Explanation.-For the purpose.of this sub-section, the making of the complaint shall
be deemed to be the bringing of the appeal.
Prohibition
orders.
(6) the court by or before which he is so convicted is satisfied that the health risk 5
'exists with respect to that food business,
the court, after giving the food business operator an opportunity of being heard, may by an
order, impose the following prohibitions, namely :(i) a prohibition on the use of the process or treatment for the purposes of the
food business;
10
(ii) a prohibition on the use ofthe premises or equipment for the purposes ofthe
food business or any other food business of the same class or description;
(iii) a prohibition on the use of the premises or equipment for the purposes of
any food business.
(2) The court may, on being satisfied that it is necessary so to do, by an order, impose !27
a prohibition on the food business operator participating in the management of any food
business, or any food business of a class or description specified in the order.
(3) As soon as practicable after the making of an order under sub-section (1) or subsection (2) (in this Act referred to as a "prohibition order"), the concerned Food Safety
LO
Officer shall(a) serve a copy of the order on the food business operator; and
(b) in the case of an order under subsection (I), affix a copy of the order at a
conspicuous place on such premises used for the purposes of the food business,
and any person who knowingly contravenes such an order shall be guilty of an offence and
25
be punishable with a fine which may extend to three lakh rupees.
' ( 4 ) The concerned Food Safety Officer shall with the approval of the Designated
Officer issue a certificate to the effect that the food business operator has taken sufficient
measures justifying lifting of the prohibition order, within seven days of his being satisfied
on an application made by the food business operator for such a certificate or the said officer
30
shall-
(5)A prohibition order shall cease to have effect upon the court being satisfied, on an 3 5
application made by the food business operator not less than six months after the prohibition
order has been passed, that the food business operator has taken sufficient measures
justifying the lifting of the prohibition order.
(6) The court shall give a direction on an application by the food business operator, if
the court thinks it proper so to do having regard to all the circumstances of the case, 40
including in particular, the conduct of the food business operator since the making of the
order; but no such application shall be entertained if it is not made-
(a) within six months after the making of the prohibition order; or
(b) within three months after the making by the food business operator of a
'6
previous application for such a direction.
(i) any reference above shall apply in relation to a manager of a food business as
it applies in relation to the food business operator; and any reference to the food
business operator of the business, or to the food business eperator, shall be construed
accordingly.
(ii) "manager", in relation to a food business, means any p w o n who is entrusted
by the food business operator with the day to day running of the business, or any part
of the business.
34. (1) If the Designated Officer is satisfied that the health risk condition exists with
to respect to any food business, he may, after a notice served on the food business'operator (in
Emergency
prohibition
notices and
orkrs.
(a) serve a copy of the order on the food business operator of the business; or
(b) affix a copy of the order at a conspicuous place on such premises used for
the purpcjses of that business;
and any person who knowingly con6avenes such an order sh~allbe guilty of an offence and
25 shall be punishable with imprisonment for a term which may extend to two years and with h e
which may extend to two lakh rupees,
(5) An emergency prohibition order shall cease to have effect on the issue by the
Designated Officer of a certificate to the effect that he is satisfied that the food business
operator has taken sufficient measures for justifying the lifiing of such order.
30
(6) The Designated Officer shall issue a certificate under sub-section (-5) within seven
days of an application by the food business operator for such a certificate and on his being
not satisfied, the said officer shall give notice to the food business operator within a period
of ten days indicating the reasons for such decision.
40
45
(b) to prohibit the sale of any alticle of food which is in contravention of the
provisions of this Act and mies and regulations made thereunder ;
( c ) to receive report and sainples of article of foods from Food Safety Officer
under his jurisdiction and get them analysed ;
Notification
of Food
Poisoning.
Designated
Officer.
ffi to maintain record of all inspections made by Eons! Safety Officers and action 5
taken by them in the performance of rheir dulies;
(g) to get investigated any complaint which may be made in writing in respect of
any contravention of the provisions of this Act and the rules and regu!ations made
thereunder;
(h) to investigate any complaint which may be made in writing against the Food I o
Safety Oficer; and
( i ) to perform such other duties as may be entrusted by the Commissioner of
Food Safety.
Food Safety
~fiicer.
37. ( I ) The Commissioner of Food Safety shall, by notification, appoint such persons
as he thinks fit, having the qualifications prescribcd by the Central Government, as Food 15
Safety Officers for such local areas as he may assign to them for the purpose of performing
functions under this Act and the rules and regulations made thereunder.
(2) The State Government may authorize any oficer ~f the State Government having
the qualifications prescribed under sub-section (I) to perform the functions of a Fond Safety
26
Oficer within a specified jurisdiction.
Powers of
Food Safety
Officer.
(i) of any food, or any substance, which appears to him to be intended for
sale, or to have been sold for human consumption; or
fii) of any article of food or substance which is found by him on or in any zS
such premises;
which he has reason to believe that it may be required as evidence iii proceedings under any
of the provisions of .thisAct or of the regulations or orders made there under ; or
(b)seize any article of food which appears to the Food Safety Officer to be in
contravention of this Act or the regulations made thereunder ; and
30.
(c) keep it in the safe custody of the food business operator such article of food
after taking a sample;
and in both cases send the same for analysis to a Food Analyst for the local area within
which such sample has been taken.
Provided that wheire the Food Safety Officer keeps such article in the safe custody of 35
the food business operator, he may require the fcod business operator to execute a bond for
a sum of money equal to the value of such article with one or more sureties as the Food
Safety Oficer deems fit and the food business operator shall execute the bond accordingly.
(2) The Food Safety Officer may enter and inspect any place where article of food is
mafiufactured, or stored for sale, or s t ~ r e dfor the manufacture of any other article of food, or
exposed or exhibited for sale and where any adulterant is manufactured or kept, and take
samples of such articles of food or adulterant for analysis.
(3) Where any sample is taken, its cost ca!culated at the rate at which the article is
usually sold to the public sI~allbe paid to the person fiom whom it is taken.
(4) Where any article of food seized under clause (h)of sub-section ( I ) is of a perishable 4 (
nature and the Food Safety Officer is satisfied that such article of food is so deteriorated that
it is unfit for human consumption,the Food Safety Officer may, after giving notice in writing
to the food business operator, cause the same to be destroyed.
(5) The Food Safety Officer shall, in exercising the powers ofentry upon, and inspection
of any place under this section, follow, as far as may be, the provisions of the Code of
Criminal Procedure, 1973(2 of 1974) relating to the search or inspection of a place by a police
officer executing a search warrant issued under that Code.
Provided that no such books of account or other documents shall be,seized by the
Food Safety Officer except with the previous approval of the authority to which he is
subordinate.
(7) Where the Food Safety Officer takes any action under clause (a) of sub-section (I),
sub-section (2),sub-section (4) or sub-section (6), he shall, call one or more persons to be
present at the time when such action is taken and take his or their signatures.
(8) Where any books of account or other documentsare seized under sub-section (6);
the Food Safety Officer shall, within a period not exceeding thirty days fiom the date of
seizure, return the same to the person from whom they were seized after copies thereof or
extracts therefrom as certified by that person in such manner as may be prescribed by the
Central Government have been taken:
Provided that where such person refuses to so certify and a prosecution has been
instituted against him under this Act, such books qf account or other documents shall be
returned to him only after copies thereof and extracts therefrom as certified by the court have
been taken.
(9) When any adulterant is seized under sub-section (6), the burden of proving that
such adulterant is not meant for purposes of adulteration shall be on the person from whose
possession such adulterant was seized.
(10) The Commissioner of Food Safety may from time to time issue guidelines with
regard to exercise of powers of the Food Safety Oficer, which shall be binding:
Provided that the powers of such Food Safety Officer may also be revoked for a
specified period by the Commissioner of Food Safety.
39. Any Food Safety Officer exercising powers under this Act or the rules and
regulations made thereunder who(a) vexatiously and without any reasonable ground seizes any article of food or
adulterant; or
Liability of
Food Safety
Oficer in
certain cases.
(b) commits any other act to the injury of any person without having reason to
believe that such act is necessary for the execution of his duty,
shall be guilty of an offence under this Act and shall be punishable for such offence with fine
which may extend to twenty-five thousand rupees.
40. (1) Nothing contained in this Act shall be held to prevent a purchaser of any
article of food other than a Food Safety Officer from having such article analyzed by the
Food Analyst on payment of such fees and receiving from the Food Analyst a report of his
analysis within such period as may be specified by regulations:
Purchaser
may have
food
analysed.
Provided that such purchaser shall inform the food business operator at the time of
purchase of his intention to have such article so analyzed:
Provided further that if the report of the Food Analyst shows that the article of food is
not in compliance with the Act or the rules or regulations made there under, the purchaser
shall be entitled to get refund of the fees paid by him under this section.
5(2) In case the Food Analyst finds the sample in contravention of the provisions of
this Act and rules and regulations made there under, the Food Analysts shall forward the
report to the Designated Officer to follow the procedure laid down in section 42 for prosecution.
Power of
search,
seizure,
investigation,
prosecution
and procedure
thereof.
41. (1) The Food Safety Officer may search any place, seize any article of food or
adulterant, if there is a reasonable doubt about them being involved in commission of any
offence relating to food:
10
Provided that no search shall be deemed to be irregular by reason only of the fact that
witness for the search are not inhabitants of the locality in which the place searched is
situated.
(2) Save as in this Act otherwise expressly provided, provisions ofthe Code of Criminal 15
Procedure, 1973 relating to search, seizure, summon, i~vestigationand prosecution, shall 2 of 1974.
apply, as far as may be, to all action taken by the Food Safety Officer under this Act.
Procedure for
launching
prosecution.
42. ( 1 ) The Food Safety Oficer shall be responsible for inspection of food business,
drawitig samples and sending them to Food Analyst for analysis.
(2) The Food Analyst afier receiving the sample from the Food Safety Officer shall
analyze the sample and send the analysis report mentioning method of sampling and analysis
within fourteen days to Designated Oflicer with a copy to Commissioner of Food Safety.
(3) The Designated Officer afier scrutiny of the report of Food Analyst shall decide as
to whether the contravention is punishable with imprisonment or fine only and in the case of
contravention punishable with imprisonment, he shall send his recommendations within 25
fourteen days to the Commissioner of Food Safety for sanctioning prosecution.
. (4) The Commissioner of Food Safety shall, if he so deems fit decide, within the period
presciibed by the Central Government, as per the gravity of offence, whether the matter be
referred to,(a) a court of ordinary jurisdiction in case of offences punishable with 38
imprisonment for a term upto three years; or
(6) a Special Court in case of offences punishable with imprisonment for a term
exceeding three years where such Special Court is established and in case no Special
Court is established, such cases shall be tried by a court of ordinary jurisdiction.
(5) The Commissioner of Food Safety shall communicate his decision to the Designated 35
Officer and the concerned Food Safety Officer who shall launch prosecution before courts of
ordinary jurisdiction or Special Court, as the case may be; and such communication shall
also be sent to the purchaser if the sample was taken under section 40.
Recognition
and
accreditation
of
laboratories,
research
institutions
and referral
food
laboratory.
43. (1) The Food Authority may notify food laboratories and research institutions
accredited by National Accreditation Board for Testing and Calibration Laboratories or any
other accreditation agency for the purposes of cawing out analysis of samples by the Food
Analysts under this Act.
(2) The Food Authority shall, establish or recognize by notification, one or more 4 5
referral food laboratory or laboratories to cany out the functions entrusted to the referral
food laboratory by this Act or any niles and regulations made thereunder.
(3) The Food Authority may frame regulations specifying(a) the functions of food laboratory and referral food laboratory and the local
area or areas within which such functions may be carried out;
(b) the procedure for submission to the said laboratory of samples of articles of
food for analysis or tests, the forms of the laboratory's reports thereon and the fees
payable in respect of such reports; and
(c) such other matters as may be necessary or expedient to enable the said
laboratory to carry out its fbnctions effectively.
44. The Food Authority may recognize any organization or agency for the purposes of
food safety audit and checking compliance with food safety management systems required
under this Act or the rules and regulations made thereunder.
45. The Commissioner of Food Safety may, by notification, appoint such persons as
he thinks fit, having the qualifications erescribed by the Central Government, to be Food
Analysts for such local areas as may be assigned to them by the Commissioner of Food
Safety:
Recognition
of
organisation
or agency for
food safety
audit.
Food Analysts.
Provided that no person, who has any financial interest in the manufacture or sale of
any article of food shall be appointed to be a Food Analyst under this section:
Provided fkrther that different Food Analysts may be appointed for different articles of
food.
46. (1) On receipt of a package containing a sample for analysis fiom a Food Safety
Officer or any other person, the Food Analyst shall compare the seal on the container and the
outer cover with specimen impression received separately and shall note the conditions of
the seal thereon:
Functions o f
Food Analyst.
Provided that in case a sample container received by the Food Analyst is found to be
in broken condition or unfit for analysis, he shall within a period of seven days fkom the date
ofreceipt of such sample inform the Designated Officer about the same and send requisition
to him for sending second part of the sample.
(2) The Food Analyst shall cause to be analyzed such samples of article of food as may
be sent to him by Food Safety Officer or by any other person authorised under this Act.
(3) The Food Analyst shall, within a period of fourteen days fiom the date of receipt of
any sample for analysis, send :
( i )where such sample is received under section 38 or section 47 ,to the Designated
Officer, four copies of the report indicating the method of sampling and analysis; and
(ii) where such sample is received under section 40 ,a copy of the report indicating
the method of sampling and analysis to the person who had purchased such article of
food with a copy to the Designated Officer:
Provided that in case the sample can not be analyzed within fourteen days of its
receipt, the Food Analyst shall inform the Designated Officer and the Commissioner of Food
Safety giving reasons and specifying the time to be taken for analysis.
(4)An appeal against the report of Food Analyst shall lie before the Designated Officer
who shall, if he so decides, refer the matter to the referral food laboratory as notified by the
Food Authority for opinion.
47. (1) When a Food Safety Officer takes a sample of food for analysis, he shall (a) give notice in writing of his intention to have it so analysed to the person
fiom whom he has taken the sample and to the person, if any, whose name, address and
other particulars have been disclosed ;
Sampling and
analysis.
(b) except in special cases as may be provided by rules made under this Act,
divide the sample into four parts anc! mark and seal or fasten up each part in such a
manner as its nature permits and take the signatureor thumb impression of the person
from whom the sample has been taken in such placeand in such manner as may be
5
prescribed by the Central Government:
Provided that where such person refuses to sign or put his thumb impression,
the Food Safety Officer shall call upon one or more witnesses and take his signature or
thumb impression, in lieu of the signature or thumb impression of such person;
(c) ( i ) send one of the parts for analysis to the Food Analyst under intimation to
the Designated Officer;
\a
(ii) send the remaining two parts to the Designated Oficer for keeping these in
safe custody ; and
(iii) give one part to food business operator for making available to the said
authorities, if required.
(2) When a sample of any article of food or adulterant is taken ,the Food Safety Officer 15
shall, by the immediately succeeding working day, send the sample to the Food Analyst far
the area concerned for analysis and report.
(3) Where the part of the sample sent to the Food Anaiyst is iost or damaged, the
Designated Officer shall, on a requisition made to him, by the Food Analyst or the Food
Safety Officer, despatch one of the parts of the sample sent to him, to the Food Analyst for
analysis.
20
(4) An article of food or adulterant seized, unless destroyed, shall be produced before
the Designated Officer as soon as possible and in any case not iater than seven days after
the receipt of the report of the Food Analyst:
Provided that if an application is made to the Designated Officer in this behalf by the 2 5
person from whom any article of food has been seized, the Designated Officer shall by order
in writing direct the Food Safety Officer to produce such article before him within such time
as may be specified in :he order.
(5) In case of imported articles of food, the authorized officer of the Food Authority
shall take its sample and send to the Food Analyst of notified laboratory for analysis who 3a
shall send the report within a period of five days to the authorised officer.
(6) The Designated Oficer, the Food Safety Oficer, the authorised officer and the
Food Analyst shall follow such procedure as may be specified by regulations.
General
provisions
relating to
offences.
48. (1)A person may render any article of food injurious to health by means of one or
more of fie following operations, namely(a) adding any article or substance to the food;
(6) using any article or substance as an ingredient in the preparation ofthe food;
40
(iQ the information provided to the consumer, including information on the label,
or other information generally available to the consumer concerning the avoidance of
specific adverse health effects from a particular food or category of foods not only to
the probable, immediate or short-term or long-term effects of that food on the health of
a person consuming it, but also on subsequent generations;
(iii) to the probable cumulative toxic effects;
(iv) to the particular health sensitivities of a specific category of consumers
where the food is intended for that category of consumers; and
(v) also to the probable cumulative effect of food of substantially the same
composition on the health of a person consuming it in ordinary quantities;
(6) the fact where the quality or purity of the article, being primary food, has
fallen below the specified standard or its constituents are present in quantities not
within the specified limits of variability, in either case, solely due to natural causes and
beyond the control of human agency, then such article shall not be deemed to be
unsafe or sub-standard or food containing extraneous matter.
Explanation.-Forthe purposes of the this section, "injury", includes any impairment,
whether permanent or temporary, and "injurious to health" shall be construed accordingly;
49. While adjudging the quantum of penalty under this Chapter, the Adjudicating
Officer or the Tribunal, as the case may be, shall have due regard to the following -
General
provisions
relating to
penalty.
(b) the amount of loss caused or likely to cause to any person as a result of the
contravention,
(c) the
50. (1) Any person who sells to the purchaser's prejudice any food which is not in
compliance with the provisions of this Act or the regulations made thereunder, or of the
nature or substance or quality demanded by the purchaser, shall be liable to a penalty not
exceeding two lakh rupees.
(2) In a proceeding under sub-section (I), it shall not be a defence that the purchaser
was not prejudiced because he bought the article of food for analysis or examination.
Penalty for
selling food
not o f the
nature or
substance or
quality
demanded.
51. Any person who whether by himself or by any other person on his behalf
manufactures for sale or stores or sells or distnbutes or imports any article of food for
human consumption which is sub-standard, shall be liable to a penalty which may extend to
five 1akh;rupees;
Penalty for
sub-standard
food.
52. (1) Any person who whether by himself or by any other person on his behalf
manufactures for sale or stores or sells or distributes or imports any article of food for
human consumption which is misbranded, shall be liable to a penalty which may extend to
three lakh rupees.
Penalty for
misbranded
food.
(2) The Adjudicating Officer may issue a direction to the person found guilty of an
offence under this section, for taking corrective action to rectifL the mistake or such article
of food shall be destroyed.
53. (I) Any person who publishes, or is a party to the publicationof an advertisement,
which-
Penalty for
misleading
advertisement.
54. Any person whether by himselfor by any other person on his behalf nanufactures
for sale or stores'or sells or distributes or imports any article of food for human consumption
containing extraneous matter, shall be liable to a penalty which may extend to one lakh I CI
rupees.
Penalty for
failure to
comply with
the directions
o f the Food
Safety
Officer.
55. If a food business operator or importer without reasonable ground, fails to comply
with the requirements of this Act or the regulations or orders issued thereunder, as directed
by the Food Safety Officer , he shall be liable to a penalty which may extend to two lakh
rupees.
IS
Penalty for
unhygienic or
unsanitary
processing or
manufacturing
o f food.
56. Any person who, whether by himself or by any o'ther person on his behalf,
manufactures or processes any article of food for human consumption under unhygienic or
unsanitary conditions, shall be liable to a penalty which may extend to one lakh rupees.
Penalty for
prossessing
adulterant.
57. (I) Subject to the provisions ofthis chapter, if any person who whether by himself
or by any other person on his behalf, imports or manufactures for sale , or stores, sells or
distribute any adulterant shall be liable-
20
(i) where such adulterant is not injurious to health, to a penalty not exceeding
two lakh rupees;
58. Whoever contravenes any provisions of this Act or the rules or regulations made
thereunder, for the contravention of which no penalty has been separately provided in this
30
Chapter, shall be liable to a penalty which may extend to two lakh rupees.
59. Any person who, whether by himself or by any other person on his behalf,
manufacturesfor sale or stores or sells or distributes or imports any article of food for human
consumption which is unsafe, shall be punishable,( i ) where such failure or contravention does not result in injury, with imprisonment
for a term which may extend to six months and also with fine which may extend to one 35lakh rupees;
(iv) where such failure or contravention results in death, with imprisonment for
a term which shall not be less than seven years but which may extend to imprisonment
for life and also with fine which shall not be less than ten lakh rupees.
60. If a person without the permission of the Food Safety Oflicer, retains, removes or
5 tampers with any food, vehicle, equipment, package or labelling or advertising material or
other thing that has been seized under this Act, shall be punishable with imprisonment for a
term which may extend to six months and also with fine which may extend to two lakh
rupees.
(0
61. If a person, in connection with a requirement or direction under this Act, provides
any information or produces any document that the person knows is false or misleading,
shall be punishable with imprisonment for a term which may extend to three months and also
with fine which may extend to two lakh rupees.
Punishment
for
interfering
with seizcd
items.
Punishment
for false
information.
Punishment
for
obstructing or
impersonating
a Food Safety
Oficer.
63. If any person or food business operator himself or by any person on his behalf
who is required to obtain licence, manufactures, sells, stores or distribute or imports any
article of food without licence, shall be punishable with imprisonment for a term which may
20 extend to six months and also with a fine which may extend to one lakh rupees.
Punishment
for carrying
out a business
without
licence.
64. (1) If any person, after having been previously convicted of an offence punishable
under this Act subsequently commits and is convicted of the same offence, he shall be liable
to-
Punishment
for subsequent
offences.
25
(i) twice the punishment, which might have been imposed on a fmt conviction,
subject to the punishment being maximum provided for the same offence; and
(ii) a further fine on daily basis which may extend upto one lakh rupees, where
the offence is a continuing one ; and
(iii) his licence shall be cancelled.
30
(2) The Court may also cause the offender's name and place of residence, the
offence and the penalty imposed to be published at the offender's expense in such
newspapers or in such other manner as the court may direct and the expenses of such
publication shall be deemed to be part of the cost attending the conviction and shall be
recoverable in the same manner as a fine;
65. (1) Without prejudice to the other provisions ofthis Chapter, if any person whether
3S by himself or by any other person on his behalf, manufactures or sells or imports any article,
of food causing injury to the consumer or his death, it shall be lawful for the Adjudicating
Officer or as the case may be, the court to direct him to pay compensation to the victim or the
legal representative of the victim, a sum-
(2) Where any person is held guilty of an offence leading to grievous injury or death,
the Adjudicating Officer or the court may cause the name and place of residence of the
person held guilty, the offence and the penalty imposed to be published at the offender's
4 5 expense in such newspapers or in such other manner as the Adjudicating Officer or the court
may direct and the expenses of such publication shall be deemed to be part of the cost
attending the conviction and shall be recoverable in the same manner as a fine.
Compensation
in case of
injury or
death of
consumer.
(3) The Adjudicating Officer or the court may also,(a) order for cancellation of licence , re-call of food from market, forfeiture of
establishment and property in case of grievous injury or death of consumer;
(b) issue prohibition orders in other cases
Offences by
companies.
66. (1) Where an offence under this Act which has been committed by .a company, 5
every person who at the time the offence was committed was in charge of, and was responsible
to , the company for the conduct of the business of the company, as well as the company,
shall be deemed to be guilty of the offence and shall be liable to be proceeded against and
punished accordingly:
lo
Provided further that nothing contained in this sub-section shall render any such
person liable to any punishment provided in this Act, if he proves that the offence was IS
committed without his knowledge or that he exercised all due diligence to prevent the
commission of such offence.
(2) Notwithstanding anything contained in sub-section (I), where an offence under
this Act has been committed by a company and it is proved that the offence has been
committed with the consent or connivance of or is attributable to any neglect on the part of, 20
any director, manager, secretary or other officer of the company, such director, manager,
secretary or other officer shall also be deemed to be guilty of that offence and shall be liable
to be proceeded against and punished accordingly.
Explanation.-For the purpose of this section,(a) " company" means any body corporate and includes a fm or other association 2s
of individuals; and
67. (1)Any person who imports any article of food which is in contravention of the
provisions of this Act, rules and regulations made thereunder, shall, in addition to any
penalty to which he may be liable under the provisions of the ForeignTrade (Development 30
and Regulation) Act, 1992 and the Customs Act, 1962 be also liable under this Act and shall 22 of 1992.
52 of 1962.
be proceeded against accordingly.
(2) Any such article of food shall be destroyed or returned to the importer, if permitted
by the competent authority under the Foreign Trade (Development and Regulation) Act,
1992 or the Customs Act, 1962, or any other Act, as the case may be.
35
CHAPTER X
ADJUDICATION AND FOOD SAFETY APPELLATE TRIBUNAL
Adjudication.
68. (1) For the purposes of adjudication under this Chapter, an officer not below the
rank of Additional District Magistrate ofthe district where the alleged offence is committed,
shall be notified by the State Government as the Adjudicating Officer for adjudication in the 4 o
manner as may be prescribed by the Central Government.
(2) The Adjudicating Officer shall, after giving the person a reasonable opportunity for
making representation in the matter, and if, on such inquiry, he is satisfied that the person has
committed the contravention of provisions of this Act or the rules or the regulations made
thereunder, impose such penalty as he thinks fit in accordance with the provisions relating to 4 5
that offence.
(3) The Adjudicating Officer shall have the powers of a civil cowt and(a) all proceedings before him shall be deemed to be judicial proceedings within
the meaning of sections 193 and 228 of the Indian Penal Code (45 of 1860);
5
(6) shall be deemed to be a court for the purposes of sections 345 and 346 of the
Code of Criminal Procedure, 1973 (2 of 1974).
(4) while adjudicating the quantum of penalty under this Chapter , tllz Adjudicating
Officer shall have due regard to the guidelines specified in section 49.
1Q
69. (1) The Commissioner of Food Safety may, by order, empower the Designated
Oficer, to accept from petty manufactllrers who himself manufacture and sell any article of
food, retailers, hawkers, itinerant vendors, temporary stall holders against whom a reasonable
belief exists that he has committed an offence or contravention against this Act, payment of
sum of money by way of composition of the offence which such person is suspected to have
committed.
Power to
offences.
(2) On the payment of such sum of money to such officer, the suspected person, if in
IScustody, shall be discharged and no further proceedings in respect of the offence shall be
taken against such person.
(3) The sum of money accepted or agreed to be accepted as composition under sub
section (I), shall not be more than one lakh rupees and due regard shall be made to the
guidelines specified in section 49:
20
Provided that no offence, for which punishment of imprisonment has been prescribed
under this Act, shall be compounded.
70. (1)The Central Government or as the case may be, the State Government may, by
notification, establish one or more tribunals to be known as the Food Safety Appellate
Tribunal to hear appeals from the decisions of the Adjudicaring Officer under section 68.
25
Establishment
of Food
Safety
Appellate
Tribunal.
(2) The Central Government or the State Government, as the case may be, shall prescribe,
the matters and areas in relation to which the Tribunal may exercise jurisdiction.
(3) The Tribunal shall consist of one person only (hereinafter referred to as the Presiding
Officer of the Tribunal) to be appointed, by notification, by the Central Government or the
State Government, as the case may be:
30
Provided that no person shall be qualified for appointment as a Presiding Oficer to the
Tribunal unless he is or has been qualified to be a District Judge.
(4) The qualifications, appointment, term of ofice, salary and allowances, resignation
and removal of the Presiding Officer shall be such as may be prescribed by the Central
Government.
35
5 o f 1908.
(5) The procedure of appeal and powers of the Tribunal shall be such as may be
prescribed by the Central Government.
71. (1) The Tribunal shall not be bound by the procedure laid down by the Code of
Civil Procedure, 1908 but shall be guided by the principles of natural justice and, subject to
the other provisions of this Act and the rules made thereunder, the Tribunal shall have
40 powers to regulate its own procedure including the place at which it shall have its sittings.
Procedure and
powers o f the
Tribunal.
(2) The Tribunal shall have, for the purposes of discharging its functions under this
Act, the same powers as are vested in a civil court under the Code of Civil Procedure, 1908,
while trying a suit, in respect of the following matters, namely:-
45
(a) summoning and enforcing the attendance of any person and examining him
on oath;
'
(3) Every proceeding before the Tribunal shall be deemed to be a judicial proceeding
within the meaning of sections 193 and 228, and for the purposes of section 196 ofthe Indian
Penal Code, shall be deemed to be a civil court for all the purposes of section 195 and Chapter
XXVI of the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1973.
5
45 of 1860.
2 of 1974.
(4) The appeliant may either appear in person or authorize one or more legal practitioners I o
or any of its officers to represent his case before the Tribunal.
(5) The provisions of the Limitation Act, 1963, sha!l, except as otherwise provided in
this Act, apply to an appeal made to the Tribun~l.
36 of 1963.
(6)Any person aggrieved by any decision or order of the Tribunal may file an appeal
to the High Court within sixty days from the date of communication of the decision or order 1 5
of the Tribunal to him on any question of fact or law arising out of such order:
Provided that the High Court may, if it is satisfied that the appellant was prevented by
sufficient cause from filing the appezl within the said period, allow it to be filed within a
hrther period not exceeding sixty days.
Civil court
have
jurisdiction.
72. No civil court shall have jurisdiciion to entertain any suit or proceeding in respect 2 0
of any matter which an Adjudicating Officer or the Tribunai is empowered by or under this
,4ct to deten-ninc and no injunction shall be granted by any court or other authority in
respect of any action taken or to be taken in pursuance of any power conferred by or under
this Ac?.
Power of
73. Notwithstanding anything contained in the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1973, all ~ ' 2of 1974.
offenoes not triable by a Special Court, shall be tried in a stunmary way by a Judicial Magistrate
of the first class or by a Metropolitan Magistrate and the provisions of sections 262 to 265
(both inclusive) of the said Code shall, as far as may be, apply to such a trial:
'O
'v
cases
summarily.
Provided that in the case of any conviction in a summary trial under this section, it
shall be lawhi for the Magistrate to pass a sentence of imprisonmentfor a term not exceeding 30
one year:
Provided further that when at the commencement of, or in the course of, a summary
trial under this section, it appears to the Magistrate that the nature of the case is such that a
sentence of imprisonment for a term exceeding one year may have to be passed or that it is,
for any other reason, undesirable to try the case summarily, the Magistrate shall after hearing 32
the parties, record an order to that effect and thereafter recall any witness who may have
been examined and proceed to hear or rehear the case in the manner provided by the said
Code.
Special courts
"d "blic
Prosecutor
74. (I) Notwithstanding anything contained in this Act or in the Code of Criminal
Procedure, 1973, the Central Government or the State Government in their respective'cn2 of 1974.
jurisdictions may, if consider expedient and necessary in the public interest, for the purposes
of the trial of offences relating to grievous injury or death ofthe consumer for which punishment
of imprisonment for more than three years has been prescribed under this Act, constitute, by
notification in the Official Gazette, as many Special Courts with the concurrence ofthe Chief
Justice of the High Court as mzy be necessary for such area or areas and for exercising such 4 5
jurisdiction, as may be specified in the notification.
(2) A Special Court may, on its own motion, or on an application made by the Public
Prosecutor and if it considers it expedient or deskable so to do, sit for any of its proceedings
at any place other than its ordinary place of sitting.
5
(3) The trial under this Act of any offence by a Special Court shall have precedence
over the trial of any other case against the accused in any other court (not being a Special
Court) and shall be concluded in preference to the trial of suck other case and accordingly
the trial of such other case shall remain in abeyance.
(qFor every Special Court, the Central Government or the State Government, as the
case may be, shall appoint a person to be the Public Prosecutor and may appoint more than
l o one person to be the Additional Public Prosecutors:
Provided that the Central Government or the State Government, as the case may be,
may also appoint for any case or class or group of cases, a Special Public Prosecutor.
(5) A person shall not be qualified to be appointed as a Public Prosecutor or an
Additional Public Prosecutor or a Special Public Prosecutor under this section ilnless he has
IS been in practice as an Advocate for not less than seven years or has held any post, for a
period of not less than seven years, under the Union or a State, requiring special knowledge
of law.
75. Where, after taking cognizance of any offence, a Special Court is of the opinion
that the offence is not triable by it, it shall, notwithstanding that it has no jurisdiction to try
20 such offence, transfer the case for the trial of such offence to any court having jurisdiction
under the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1973 (2 of 1974) and the court to which the case is
transferred may proceed with the trial of the offence as if it had taken cognizance of the
offence.
Power to
transfer cases
to regular
courts.
76. (I) Any person aggrieved by a decision or order of a Special Court may, on payment
2 5 of such fee as may be prescribed by the Central Government and after depositing the amount,
Appeal
if any, imposed by way of penalty, compensation or damage under this Act, within forty-five
days from the date on which the order was served, prefer an appeal to the High Court:
Provided that the High Court may entertain any appeal after the expiry of the said
period of forty-five days, if it is satisfied that the appellant was prevented by sufficient cause
30 for filing the appeal within the said period.
(2) An appeal preferred under this section shall be disposed of by the ~ i g h ' c o u rby
t a
bench of not less than two judges.
77. Notwithstanding anything contained in this Act, no court shall take cognizance of
an offence under this Act after the exphy of the period of one year from the date of commission
35 of an offence:
Time limit
for
Prosecutions
Provided that the Commissioner of Food Safety may, for reasons to be recorded in
writing, approve prosecution within an extended period of upto three years.
78. Where at any time during the trial of any offence under this Act alleged to have
been committed by any person, not being the importer, manufacturer, distributor or dealer of
bo any article of food, the court, is satisfied, on the evidence adduced before it, that such
importer, manufacturer, distributor or dealer is also concerned with that offence, then the
court may, notwithstanding anything contained in sub-section (3) of section 319 ofthe Code
2 of 1974.
of Criminal Procedure, 1973, or in section 71, proceed against him as though a prosecution
has been instituted under this Act.
2 of 1974.
Power of
court to
implead
manufacturer,
etc.
Magistrate's
power to
impose
enhanced
punishment.
Defences
which may or
may not be
allowed in
prosecution
under this
~ct:
80. (A)
. . Defence relating
- to -publication of advertisements-
( I ) In any proceeding for an offence under this Act in relation to the publication
of an advertisement, it is a defence for a person to prove that the person carried on the
business of publishing or arranging for the publication of advertisements and that the
person published or arranged for the publication of the advertisement in question in 5
the ordinary course of that business.
(2) clause ( I ) does not apply if the person:
(a)should reasonably have known that the publication ofthe advertisement
was an offence; or
(b)had previously been informed in writing by the relevant authority that I o
publication of such an advertisement would constitute an offence; or
(c) is the Food business operator or is otherwise engaged in the conduct
of a food business for which the advertisements concerned were published.
(B) Defence of due diligence(?} In any proceedings for an offence , it is a defence if it is proved that the I Y
person took all reasonsb!~precautions and exercised al! due diligence to prevent the
commission of the offence by such person or by another person under the person's
control.
(2) Without limiting the ways in which a person may satis@the requirements of
20
clause ( I ) , a person satisfies thnze requirements if it is proved:
(a) that the con~rnissicrnorrhe offence was due to(!) an anc? ar default qf another person; or
(11')
(h) (9the penou carried out all such checks of t!re food concerned as were
25
aeasonabte in sll the circi~nstaricen;or
(ii) it was reasonable in all the circumstances to rely on checks carried out
by the person who supplied such food to the person; and
(c)that the person did not import the food into the jurisdiction from another
country; and
30
( i ) the person sold the food in the same condition as and when the
person purchased it, or
(r'i) the person sold the food in a different condition to that in
which the person prchased it, but that the difference did not result in any
contravention of this Act or the rules and regulations made thereunder, and 35
(e) that the person did not know and had no reason to suspect at the time
of commission of the alleged offence that the person's act or omission would
constitute an offence under the relevant section.
(3) In sub-clause (a) of clause (t),another person does not include a person
who was46
(4) Without limiting the ways in which a person may satisfy the requirements of
clauses (I) and item ( i ) of sub-clause (6) of clause (Z), a person may satisfy those
requirements by proving that-
(a) in the case of an offence relating to a food business for which a food
safety programme is required to be prepared in accordance with the regulations,
the person complied with a food safety programme for the food business that
complies with the requirements of the regulations, or
(6) in any other case, the person complied with a scheme (for example, a
quality assurance programme or an industry code of practice) that was(i) designed to manage food safety hazards and based on national
or international standards, codes or guidelines designed for that purpose,
and
(ii) documented in some manner.
In any proceedings for an offence under the provisions of this Act, it is no defence
that the defendant had a mistaken but reasonable belief as to the facts that constituted the
offence.
(D) Defence in respect of handling food-
In proceedings for an offence under section 56, it is a defence if it is proved that the
20 person caused the food to which the offence relates to be destroyed or otherwise disposed
of immediately after the food was handled in the manner that was likely to render it unsafe.
(E) Defences of significance of the nature, substance or quality of food-
30
81. (1) The Food Authority shall prepare, in such form and at such time in each
financial year as may be prescribed by the Central Government , its budget for the next
financial year, showing the estimated receipts and expenditure of the Food Authority and
forward the same to the Central Government.
Budget of
Food
Authority.
(2) The Food Authority with the prior approval of the Central Government , shall
adopt financial regulation which specifies in particular, the procedure for drawing up and
35 implementing the Authority's budget.
82. (1) The Central Government may, after due appropriation, make to the Food
Authority grants of such sumsof money as the Central Government may think fit.
Finances of
the Food
Authority.
(2) The Food Authority on the recommendation of the Central Advisory Committee
shall specifL a graded fee from licensed food business operator ,accredited laboratories or
LID food safety auditors to be charged by the Commissioner of Food Safety.
83. (1) The Food Authority shall maintain proper accounts and relevant records and
prepare an annual statement of accounts in such form as may be prescribed by the Central
Government in consultation with the Comptroller and Auditor General of India.
(2) The Comptroller and Auditor-General and any person appointed by him in
45 connection with the audit of the accounts of the Food Authority under this Act shall have
the same rights and privileges and authority in connection with such audit as the Comptroller
Accounts and
Audit o f Food
Authority.
and Auditor General generally has in connection with the audit of Government accounts and,
in particular, shall have the right to demand the production of books, accounts, connected
vouchers and other documents and papers and to inspect any of the offices of the Food
Authority.
(3) The accounts of the Food Authority , as certified by the Comptroller and Auditor 5
General or any other person appointed by him in this behalf, together with the audit report
thereon shall be forwarded annually to the Central Government by the Food Authority and
the Central Government shall cause the audit report to be laid, as soon as may be after it is
received, before each House of Parliament.
Annual report
o f Food
Authority.
84. (1) The Food Authority shall prepare once every year, in such form and at such lo
time as may be prescribed by the central Government, an annual report giving a summary of
its activities during the previous year and copies of the report shall be forwarded to the
Central Government and State Governments.
(2)A copy of the report received under sub-section (I) shall be laid, as soon as may be
IS
after it is received, before each House of Parliament.
CHAPTER XI1
Power o f
Central
Government
to issue
directions to
Food
Authority and
obtain reports
and returns.
85. (I) Without prejudice to the foregoing provisions of this Act, the Food Authority
shall, in exercise of its powers and in performance of its functions under this Act, be bound
by such directions on questions of policy, other than those relating to technical and 20
administrative matters, as the Central Government may give in writing to it from time to time:
Provided that the Food Authority shall, as far as practicable, be given an opportunity
to express its views before any direction is given under this sub-section.
(2) 1f any dispute arises between the Central Government and the Food Authority as to
whether a question is or is not a question of policy, the decision of the Central Government 95
thereon shall be final.
(3) The Food Authority shall furnish to the Central Government such returns or other
information with respect to its activities as the Central Government may, from time to time,
require.
Power o f
Central
Government
to give
directions to
State
Governments.
86. The Central Government may give suchdirections, as it may deem necessary, to a 30
State Government for carrying out all or any of the provisions of this Act and the State
Government shall comply with such directions.
Members,
off~cerso f
Food
Authority
and
Commissioner
o f Food
Safety to be
public
servants
87. The Members, officers of the Food Authority and the Commissioners of Food
Safety and their officers shall be deemed, when acting or purporting to act in pursuance of
any of the provisions of this Act, to be public servants within the meaning of section 2 1 of $45 o f 1860.
the Indian Penal Code.
Protection o f
action taken
in good faith.
88. No suit, prosecution or other legal proceedings shall lie against the Central
Government, the State Government, the Food Authority and other bodies constituted under
this Act or any officer of the Central Government, the State Government or any member,
officer or other employee of such Authority and bodies or any other officer acting under this 40
Act for anything which is in good faith done or intended to be done under this Act or the
rules or regulations made thereunder.
89, The provisions of this Act shall have effect notwithstanding mything inconsistent
therewith contained in any other law for the time being in force or in any instrume3t having
effect by virtue of any law other than this Act.
Overriding
effect of this
Act over all
other food
related laws.
90. On and from the date of establishment of the Food Authority, every employee
5 holding office under the Central GovernmentAgencies administering food h w s immediately
before that dateshall bold his office in the Food Authority by thesame tenureand upon the
same terns and conditions of service including remuneration, leave, provident fund,
retirement and other terminal benefits as he would have held such office if the Food Authority
had not been established and sbsll continue to do so as an employee of the F o d Authority or
I 0 utltil the expiry of the period of six months from that date ifsuch employee opts not to be the
eniployee &the Food Authority.
Transfer of
existing
employees of
Central
Government
Agencies
governing
various food
related Acts
or Orders to
the Food
Authority.
(2) In particclar, and without prejudice to the generality ofthe foregoing power, such
15 rules may provide for all or any of the foliowing matters, name1.i:-
jc ) the mafiner of taking the extract of documer!ts seized under sub-clause (8) of
section 38;
(4determination of cases for referring to appropriate Courts and time frsme for
such determination under sub-section ( 4 ) of section 42;
(e) qua!ifications of Food Analysts under sectiorl45;
2.
(f) the manner of sending sample for ana!ysis and details of the ~rccedureto be
followed in this regard under sub-section ( I ) of section 47;
(g) the procedure to be followed in adiudication of cases under sub-section ( I )
of section 68;
30
35
(m)the form and time for preparing annual report by Food Authority under subsection(1) of section 84 ; and
40
(n) any other matter which is required to be, or may be , prescribed or in respect
of which provision is to be made by rules by the Central Government.
Power o f
Central
Government
to make mles.
Power o f
Food
Authority to
make
regulations.
92. ( 1 ) The Food Authority may, with the previous approval of the Central Government
and after previous publication, by notification, make regulations consistent with this Act
and the rules made thereunder to cany out the provisions of thfs Act.
( 2 ) In particular, and without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing power, such
regulations may provide for all or any of the following matters, namely:5
(a) salaries and other conditions of service of officers and other employees of
the Food Authority under sub-section ( 3 ) of section 9;
2.0
(I) form in which guarantee shall be given under sub-section (4) of section 26;
3-5
(m) conditions and guidelines relating to food recall procedures under subsection ( 4 ) of section 28;
@) the respective areas of which the Designated Officer shall be in-charge for 3C
food safety administration under sub-section ( I ) of section 36;
(q) procedure in getting food analysed, details of fees , etc, under sub-section
( I ) of section 40;
( r ) functions, procedure to be followed by food laboratories under sub-section
40
( 3 ) of section 43;
(s)
4s
(v) any other matter which is required to be, or may be, specified by regulations
or in respect of which provision is to be made by regulations.
93. Every rule and every regulation made under this Act shall be laid, as soon as may
be after it is made, before each House of Parliament, while it is in session, for a total period
of thirty days which may be comprised in one session or in two or more successive sessions,
and if, before the expiry of the session immediately following the session or the successive
sessions aforesaid, both Houses agree in making any modification in the rule or regulation or
both Houses agree that the rule or regulation should not be made, the rule or regulation shall
thereafter have effect only in such modified form or be of no effect, as the case may be; so,
however, that any such modification or annulment shall be without prejudice to the validity
of anything previously done under that rule or regulation.
Laying o f
ru!es and
regulations
before
Parliament.
94. ( 1 ) Subject to the powers of the Central Government and the Food Authority to
make rules and regulations respectively, the State Govenunent may, after previous publication
and with the previous approval of the Food Authority, by notification in the Official Gazette,
make rules to cany out the functions and duties assigned to the State Government .and the
State Commissioner of Food Safety under this Act and the rules and regulations made
thereunder.
Power o f
State
Government
to make rules
.
(2) In particular and without prejudice to the generality of the foregoing power, such
rules may provide for all or any ofthe following matters, namely :-
( a )other functions of the Commissioner of Food Safety under clause (n of subsection ( 2) of section 30;
(b) earmarking a fund and the manner in which reward shall be paid to a person
rendering assistance in detection of offence or apprehension of offender under section
95; and
(c) any other matter which is required to be, or may be prescribed or in respect of
which provision is to be made by rules by the State Government.
(3) Every rule made by the State Government under this Act shall be laid, as soon as
may be after it is made, before each House of the State Legislature where it consists of two
Houses or where such State Legislature consists of one House, before that House .
95. The State Government may empower the Commissioner of Food Safety to order
payment of reward to be paid to a person who renders assistance in the detection of the
offence or the apprehension of the offender, from such fund and in such manner as may be
prescribed by the state Government.
Reward by
State
Government.
96. A penalty imposed under this Act, if it is not paid, shall be recovered as an arrear
of land revenue and the defaulters licence shall be s~spendedtill the penalty is paid.
Recovery of
penalty.
97. (1) With effect from such date as the Central Government may appoint in this -Repeal and
savings.
behalf, the enactments specified in the Second Schedule shall stand repealed:
Provided that such repeal shall not affect :( i ) the previous operations of the enactments under .repeal or anything duly
done or suffered thereunder; or
(ii) any right, privilege, obligation or liabiiity acquired, accrued or incurred under
any of the enactments under repeal; or
.
punishment,
and any such investigation, legal proceedings or remedy may be instituted , continued or
enforced and any such penalty, forfeiture or punishment may be imposed, as if this Act had
not been passed:
(2) If there is ar.y other law for the time being in force in any State. corresponding to
this Act, the same shall upon the commencement of this Act. stand repealed and in such
case, the provisions of section 6 of the General Clauses Act. 1897 shall apply as if sgch
provisions of tile State law had been repealed.
I(J
111
1847
98. Notwithstanding !he repfa1 of the enactnient and Orders specitied in the Second
Schedule the standards, safely requiremenr~and other provisions of the Acts and t.he rulcs
and regulations made thereunder and Orders listed in that Schcd~ileshall continue to be in
force'and operate till new standards arc specified ur,der this Act or rules and regulastionr; : T
made thereunder:
Provided that anytl~ingdone or any action :ahen under rhe enactment and Orders
under repeal sha!l be dezmed to have becn done or taken under the corresponding p r ~ i s i o n s
of this Act and shall continue in force accnrdrngly ur:less and until wperseded by anything
2c
done or-by any action taken under this Act:
99. (!)On and from the date ofcomn~encementofthis Act. the Milk and Milk Products
Order, !992 issued under the Essential Commodities Act, 1955 shall be deemed to be the Milk
and Milk Products Regulations,l992 issued b?. the Food Authority under this Act.
100. As from the sppainted day, the provisions of the Infant Milk Substitutes, Feeding
Bottles and Ir,Cznt Foods (Regulation of Production. Supply and Distribution) Act, 1992 4 1 of
(herein referred to as the principal Act) shall appiy subject to the following amendments,
name!y :--30
(a) throughout !he principal Act, any reference to "the Prevention of the Food
Adulteration Act, 1954" shall be substituted by reference to "the Food Safety and
Standards Act, 2005"
37 of
1992.
1954
(b) in section 12 of the principa! Act. tile reference to "any Food Inspector
appointed under section. 9 ofthe Prevenrion of the Food Adulteration Act, 1954" shall35 37 of 1954.
he substituted by reference to "any Food Safety Qfficer appointed under the Food
Act, 2005" ;
Safety and Sta~~dards
(c) throughout the principal Act, any reference to "Food Inspector" shall be
substituted by the expression "the-Food Safety Officer"; and
(6)in section 2 1 of the principal Act, ir? sub-section ( I ) , the reference to clause 4 u
( a )shall be substituted by the following, namely:" (a)the Designated Officer or tne Food Safety Oficer directed under subsection (5) of section 42 of the Food Safety and Standards Act, 2005 or '' ;
Power to
reniove
dificulties
of 195%
101. (I) If any difficulty arises in giving effect to the provisions ofthis Act, the Central
Government ma); by order published in the Official Gazette, make such provisions not 4 5
inconsistent with the provisions of this Act, as may appear to be necessary, for removing the
difiiculty :
Provided that no order shall be made under this section after the expiry ofthe period of
three years from the date of commencement of this Act.
(2) Evety order made under this section shall be laid, as soon as may be after it is made,
before each House of Parliament.
FIRST SCHEDULE
[ See section 5 ( I ) (e) ]
Zone I
1 . Andhra Pradesh,
2. Assam,
3. Bihar,
4. Gujarat,
5. Kerala,
6. Madhya Pradesh,
7. Tanil Nadu.
Zone I1
1. Maharashtra,
2. Karnataka,
3. Orissa,
4. Punjah,
5. Rajasthan,
6. Uttar Pradesh,
7. West Bengal.
Zone 111
5. Manipur.
6. Tripura,
7. Meghalaya.
Zone IV
1 . Sikkim,
2. Mizoram,
3. Arunachal Pradesh,
4. Goa,
5. Chattisgarh,
6. Uttaranchal,
7. Jharkhand.
Zone V
1. Delhi,
3. Lakshadweep,
4. Dadra and Nagar Haveli,
5. Daman and Diu,
6. Pondicherry,
7. Chandigarh.
SECOND !XHEDULE
(See section 97)
1. The Prevention of Food Adulteration Act, 1954 (37 of 1954).
2. The Fruit Products Order, 1955.
3. The Meat Food Products Order, 1973.
4. The Vegetable Oil Products (control) Order, 1947.
Sponsored by
Australian Centre for International
Agricultural Research (ACIAR), Canberra
and organized by
R. Mehta1
J. George2
1.
Senior Fellow and India Team Leader, RIS, New Delhi-110 003
2.
--------------------------------This country paper has been produced as part of ACIAR Research Project International Food Safety
Regulations and Processed Food Exports from Developing Countries: A Comparative Study of India and
Thailand.
Valuable inputs were received from participants of AU-TU Bangkok Conference (1-3 October
2002) and are gratefully acknowledged.
A special thank to Mr. S.N. Menon, IAS, Additional Secretary,
Ministry of Commerce and Chairman Research Advisory Committee for the current study and Ms. Shashi
Sareen, Director, EIC for elucidating many institutional and legal dimensions of SPS that have found reflection
in the paper. Tons of thanks to Mr. S.K. Singh and Mr. M. Saqib for allowing to use some of the product
specific inputs contributed by them.
All correspondence may please be addressed to Project Leader of India Team: Dr Rajesh Mehta,
Research and Information System for the Non-Aligned and Other Developing Countries, Core-IVB, Fourth
Floor, India Habitat Centre, Lodhi Road, New Delhi-110 003.
E-mail: spsindia@indiatimes.com
Units of Conversions
1 Lakh = 100,000
1 Crore =1,00,00,000
1 Million = 10 lakh
1 Billion = 100 crores
1 US$ = Rs 47.53 (2001-02)
--------Indian Financial Year = April-March
Glossary
AA:
Aquaculture Authority
ACIAR:
APEDA:
AQIS:
BIS:
CCFS:
CCP:
CEPAC:
CIFTI:
CII:
CRZ:
CWI:
DMI:
EIAs:
EIC:
EOU:
ETP:
EXIM:
F&FP:
FDA:
FICCI:
FSMSC:
FYM:
GAP:
GATT:
GMPs:
HACCP:
ICAR:
ICPM:
IPPC:
IPQC:
ISC:
ISIC:
ISO:
JECFA:
OGL:
OIE:
MFPI:
MFPO:
MMPO:
MPEDA:
NAFED:
NCRM:
NEERI:
NPPO:
NPR-PPMS:
NSF:
PFA:
PPB:
PPM:
QMS:
RPPO:
SPS:
SGS:
TBT:
TRIMS:
USDA:
US Department of Agriculture
VAT:
WTO:
ii
Contents
I.
Introduction
II.
Domestic Institutions
II.1
II.2
III.
IV.
V.
International Institutions
HACCP
10
IV.1
10
IV.2
10
IV.3
Technicalities of SPS
12
IV.4
12
IV.4.1
Poultry
12
IV.4.2
Shrimps
17
IV.4.3
Mango Pulp
17
IV.4.4
Mushroom
19
Conclusion
21
Figure I.1
Figure I.2
Figure II.1
Figure IV.1
15
16
In India
Figure IV.3
19
Annexure I:
Some Notes on Import Policy as Announced Under EXIM Policy, April 2002
22
Annexure II:
23
Annexure III:
Basic Structure of the Integrated Food Law being considered by the Government
27
Annexure IV:
30
iii
INTRODUCTION
The multilateral trade agreements to be effective and functional enshrined in itself a robust
institutional and legal framework. Since the agricultural sector for the first time was being brought under the
Uruguay Round of negotiations, it was indeed a challenging task to make a blueprint for institutional and legal
framework. The challenges became more complex with the realisation that a majority of the WTO members
have a domestic economy that is predominantly driven by the agricultural sector and that the linking
mechanism with the industrial processing sector on the one hand and the exports markets on the other was
extremely weak or non-existent.
The incorporation of food safety regulations as part of the broader
Agreement, hence, is a welcome initiative.
The sanitary and phytosanitary agreement concerns the
application of food safety, animal and plant health regulations and is integrated with the agreement on
agriculture.
The fear that the sanitary and phytosanitary (SPS) measures may be used for crafting trade distortion
and used for protectionist ends, the Agreement on the Application of Sanitary and Phytosanitary Measures
(SPS Agreement) came to lay added emphasis on institutional and legal mechanisms across a wide spectrum
of WTO member countries.
Having recognised that many member countries would face exogenous roadblocks and hindrances on
account of food science and food safety considerations among others, each Article of SPS Agreement and the
Annex appears to suggest a foundation for formulation and application of regulatory mechanism within the
national territorial boundaries.
Therefore, issues of harmonization, equivalence, transparency, technical
assistance and processes for dispute settlement have been specifically addressed albeit on the existing
institutional and legal endowments in a member country.
Truly stating the primary objective of WTO Agreement being removal of market distorting measures
and enhancing market access, the SPS Agreement is perceived to be one of the six non-tariff barriers to
market access (Figure I.1). Interestingly, each of the six measures has a unique institutional set-up in as
much as the trade dimensions are concerned. Another modification to these set-ups would be stipulation of
the domestic market regulatory measures.
Figure 1.1
SPS
Technical
Barriers to Trade
(TBT)
Market Access
Transportation
and Transit
Formalities
Investment
and Financial
Matters
International
Trade Rules
It has become mandatory to become SPS compliant if market access to many member countries are
sought. Thus, various Articles of SPS Agreements come into force. A graphical representation however, is,
provided in Figure I.2 below. The finer details of these Articles will be discussed in subsequent sections.
Figure 1.2
Consultations &
Dispute
Settlement
(Article 11)
TRANSPARENCY
(Article7)
Special
&DT
Article
10)
HARMONIZATION
(Article 3)
EQUIVALENCE
Article 4)
IPPC
Health of
Humans
Plants
Animals
OIE
CODEX
1
2
3
Admin. SPS
Committee
Article 12/A-B
4
5
SPS
COMPLIANT
EXPORTS
SCIENTIFIC
MERIT
LDC-Delayed
Application
(Article 14)
Technical
Assistance
(Article 9)
Risk Assessment
(Article 5)
CIA Procedure
Article 8/A-C
In what follows, however, a brief examination of the Export Import Policy of India is carried out. This
has become imminent for two reasons. First, the institutional set-up is geared to the policy statement on
exports and imports for a period of five years. Secondly, the currently valid/and applicable Exim Policy 200207 has invited a detailed request for consultations by the European Communities, among other WTO
provisions, Articles 2,3,5,7 and 8 of SPS Agreement has been utilized by EC to make out a case of
infringement against India.
Further discussions in Section II strives to situate the structure, functional dimensions and institutional
set-up for becoming SPS compliant.
Section III takes a brief overview of the international institutional framework that closely and regularly
interface with the domestic institutions.
In Section IV, a detailed examination of the implementation aspects of SPS Agreement is carried out
for deriving learnings from grass roots level experiences. Needless to say the concluding observations are
put together in Section V.
II.
DOMESTIC INSTITUTIONS
II.1
playing a twofold role for product promotion. The first role has been that of nodal agencies for disbursement of
export subsidies, a function that has considerably declined after liberalisation and the removal of subsidies
like the Cash Compensatory Scheme. The second role has been that of acting as the nodal point for
interaction between the Industry and the Government. Some of these agencies, notably, Marine Product
Export Development Authority (MPEDA) and Agriculture Produce Export Development Authority (APEDA)
have been actively involved in implementation of policies relating to product standards , as we shall see in due
course.
Standard Setting Bodies
The Bureau of Indian Standards (BIS) is the main Standard Setting body
market requirements. It sets voluntary standards that can be acquired to indicate the
the use of ISI mark. However, BIS is also the guiding organisation behind most of
set by Government agencies. Notably, BIS is also the enquiry point of India under
Technical Barriers to Trade.
Enforcement Bodies
The Export Inspection Council (EIC) is the Chief enforcement body for exports, and the one relevant
for our research study. The EIC was set up by the Government of India in order to ensure sound development
of export trade of India through quality control and inspection. The EIC and its associated agencies are
expected to:
notify commodities, which will be subject to quality control and/or inspection prior to export.
establish standards of quality for such notified commodities
specify the type of quality control and/or inspection to be applied to such commodities.
prohibit the export in the course of international trade of a notified commodity unless it is accompanied by
a certificate issued indicating that it conforms to the standard specification applicable to it.
certification of quality of export commodities through installation of quality assurance systems (In-process
Quality Control and Self-Certification) in the exporting units as well as consignment-wise inspection.
certification of quality of food items for export through installation of Food Safety Management Systems in
the food processing units as per international standards.
issue of Certificates of Origin to exporters under various preferential tariff schemes for export products.
laboratory testing.
training and technical assistance to the industry in installation of Quality and Safety Management Systems
based on principles of Hazard Analysis Critical Control Point (HACCP), ISO-9000 and other related areas.
Details on the above-mentioned and some other domestic agencies is given in Annexure II. Keeping
in view the presence of a large number of agencies, an Integrated Food Law is being considered by the
Government of India. Basic structure o f this law is given in Annexure III.
Ministry of Food Processing Industries (MFPI)
Recognizing that a robust and dynamic food processing sector is to play a vital and stellar role in the
new emerging global economy, all policies and plans for the food processing industries in the national interest
is coordinated by the Ministry of Food Processing Industries. The Ministry was reconstituted in September
2001.
The MFPI through the Directorate of Fruit and Vegetable Product is responsible for implementation of
Fruit Product Order (FPO) 1955 in India. The FPO 1955 derives its strength from Section 3 of the Essential
Commodities Act 1955 to ensure that only hygienic and good quality food products are manufactured and sold
in India.
The functioning of FPO, though with the MFPI, has an apex body called the Central Fruit Products
Advisory Committee (CFPAC).
CFPAC is constituted consisting of competent officials of concerned
government departments, technical experts, representatives of Central Food Technology Research Institute,
Bureau of Indian Standards, Fruit and Vegetable Producers and Processing Industry.
The MFPI being the nodal point, actively interfaces with various Ministries of the Government of India
and State Governments. For export consignments, MFPI interacts with APEDA, MPEDA and EIC all these of
1
the Commerce Ministry and other industry associations. Thus, the coordination for effectively addressing the
export obligations is performed by MFPI as also between food parks and agri-export zones.
MFPI is deeply involved in updating the Codex norms. In fact, MFPI is the Chairman of following five
Shadow Committees of Codex Committees: Food Additives and Contaminants; Food Labeling; Processed
Fruits and Vegetables; Cocoa and Chocolate Products and Mineral Water.
II.2
In the domestic market there are a number of legislations that becomes relevant to the food
processing in its entire chain perhaps terminating at the global market. The most important legislative
initiatives can be summarized as follows:
Ministry of Agriculture
Insecticide Act
Milk and Milk Product Control Order (MMPO)
Meat Food Product Order 1973
Ministry of Rural Development: Directorate of Marketing and Inspection (DMI)
Agricultural Produce (Grading and Marking) Act
Ministry of Health & Family Welfare
Prevention of Food Adulteration Act 1954
Ministry of Food Processing Industries
Fruits & Vegetable Products (Control) Order FPO 1955
Ministry of Commerce
Export (Quality Control & Inspections) Act 1963
Ministry of Civil Supplies, Consumer Affairs and Public Distribution
Standards of Weights & Measures Act
Standards of Weights & Measures (Enforcement) Act
Solvent Extracted Oils, De-oiled Meal and Edible Flour Control
Order, 1967
Vegetable Products Control Order, 1976
Bureau of Indian Standards (BIS) Act 1986
Ministry of Environment and Forests
Aquaculture Authority Notification 1997 & 2002
Environment (Protection) Act 1986, Environment
Third Amendment Rules, 2002
Coastal Regulation Zone Notification 21 May 2002
Aquaculture Authority - Notification
(Protection)
Whereas salient features of most of the above mentioned legislations that have immediate relevance
to the research study under consideration are given in Annexure II, it is important to highlight here that BIS
and DMI are the two nodal agencies and legislative Acts that deal exclusively with voluntary standards of
processed food products in the domestic market.
In the final analysis, it can be said that the domestic institutional mechanism is gearing up towards the
international food safety standards. The three sisters of the international standards, namely Codex, IPPC
and OIE are being addressed at various apex level institution. For example, the Central Committee of Food
Safety (CCFS), a legal body under the Prevention of Food Adulteration (PFA) Act 1954, the Central Fruit
Products Advisory Committee (CFPAC) and the concerned apex export promotion institutions under the
Ministry of Commerce are regularly interacting to update and amend existing domestic food laws. The
relevant processing industry specific association or Confederation has become an essential part of these
interactions.
For details see Mehta, Rajesh, M. Saqib, and J. George (2002) Addressing Sanitary and Phytosanitary
Agreement: A Case Study of Select Processed Food Products in India, RIS-DP#39.
5
Be that as it may, the mandatory regulations have become a norm for all export bound commodity
lines. In this respect, the Export Inspection Council (EIC) is the designated Competent Authority in India. All
SPS compliant activities are generally handled by the autonomous institution under the Ministry of Commerce,
EIC and details can be seen in Annexure IV.
To conclude, the domestic institutional and legal framework in India is evolving itself into a web of
interlinkages. Be it the commercial interests or the health safety issues at the national level, a set of legal
framework is already in place. In association with industry specific associations and commodity specific
export promotion boards, financial and environmental issues too are being addressed. An overview of this
complex interlinkages can be viewed in the accompanying Figure II.1 below.
Figure II.1:
and
Industry
F
I
N
A
N
C
I
A
L
Agricultural Sector
Linkages
International
Human
(Codex)
Plant
(IPPC)
Exports
Import
Policy
Animal
(OIE)
Do
Do
I
N
S
T
I
T
U
T
I
O
N
S
Health
Environment
III.
INTERNATIONAL INSTITUTIONS
The General Agreement on Tariffs and Trade (GATT) has been the beacon of the multilateral
trading system since 1948. Through the results of the Uruguay Round of multilateral trade negotiations, the
World Trade Organisation (WTO) came into being in 1994 and came into force on 1/1/1995, subsuming
GATT under it. Article XX allows member countries to deviate from their obligations under the Agreement
inter-alia in the case of three types of trade measures. These are, measures necessary to protect human,
animal or plant or life of health; measures relating to the conservation of exhaustible natural resources if
such measures are made effective in conjunction with restrictions on domestic production or consumption,
and measures necessary to secure compliance with laws or regulations not otherwise inconsistent with
GATT rules. However, such unilateral measures have to pass a composite trade test. This trade test has
three components viz. no arbitrary discrimination, no unjustifiable discrimination and no disguised trade
protection. It is often called the least trade restrictiveness test. Jurisprudence has shown that the second of
these measures has become the most potent tool for taking GATT compliant unilateral trade measures
pursuant to environmental objectives.
The Agreement on the application of sanitary and phytosanitary measures (SPS) is an elaboration of
GATT rules as they relate to measures necessary to protect human, animal or plant or life of health. Under
this Agreement, member countries are required to base their SPS measures on scientific principles and
refrain from maintaining measures without sufficient scientific evidence. Exceptionally, measures could be
taken without sound science provided ht ey are provisionally adopted, additional sound science is sought and
the measure reviewed within reasonable time based on risks that non-fulfilment may entail. This provision
was tested in three WTO cases in recent times. Broadly speaking, the precautionary principle was not
allowed to be expanded beyond what is already available in this provision. Also, it was considered essential
to consider the risks that non-fulfilment would entail in adjudging the compatibility of the measure with WTO
rules. The Ag reement encourages harmonisation of SPS measures and considers the standards set by
three international standard setting bodies as acceptable standards. These are the Codex Alimentarius
Commission, the International Office of Epizootic and the International Plant Protection Convention.
Equivalence is encouraged and conformity assessment guidelines are laid down.
Special and more
favourable treatment provisions exist for developing countries, but in name only.
The Agreement on Technical Barriers to Trade (TBT) allows members to apply standards (both
mandatory and voluntary) for protection of human health or safety, animal or plant or life of health, or the
environment. This Agreement also requires sound science and fulfilment of the least trade restrictiveness
test. Even voluntary standards (such as eco-labels) have to be followed a code of good practice based on
the above principles. Rules are laid down for conformity assessment here also. The Agreement does not
consider standards set by any particular international setting organisation as acceptable. In practice,
however, ISO standards are considered compatible unless certain trade rules and certain jurisprudentially
developed practices are not followed in setting them. For example, standards based on non-product related
process and production methods and those differentiating between like products may not be acceptable.
International Standards Organisation (ISO)
ISO is the most important of international standard setting organisations. It is a world federation of
123 national standards bodies, an international non-governmental organisation with, however, a majority of
its members coming from the public sector.
Its core business is the development, approval and
promulgation of consensus based international standards. Unlike WTO, however, majority vote is practised
in this organisation.
ISO develops standards through 200 technical committees split into about 650 sub-committees and
2000 working groups. It also develops guide for standard setting. In preparing these, ISO interfaces with
specific users of standards including those in the private sector. All its standards and guides are voluntary in
nature. However, given its credibility as the most internationally accepted organisation, ISO standards have
considerable trade affects due to their wide use in international trade. Therefore, those who can afford do
apply for ISO certification. ISO certification is a costly process by Indian standards. It may take anything
between rupees 100,000 to 500,000 to get certified, apart from the cost of maintaining the certificate. While
ISO 9000 series is the general quality certification standard of ISO, there is an environmental management
standard also, viz. ISO 14000 series. India has about 5000 ISO 9000 companies. About 100 companies
have taken ISO 14000 certification.
There is a sliding scale of fees structured into six different categories. Members have the option to
decide the category according to the size of their economy. There is one vote for each country and
generally decisions are made through consumers.
An International Committee (IC) comprising permanent delegates appointed by the governments of
the member-countries is the apex decision making body in OIE. The permanent delegates are expected to
be animal health professionals in their country.
At the operational level, activities of OIE are conducted by a Central Bureau. The Chief Executive is
called Director-General, who is appointed by the International Committee. The Central Bureau is the
implementing wing for all resolutions of IC, the Regional Commissions and the Specialist Commissions.
Depending upon the topical exigencies, OIE has provisions for Working Groups. Similarly, the standardsetting processes begin as and when a need is felt. Usually, the Central Bureau is the pivotal point in any
exercise on the standard setting.
International Plant Protection Convention (IPPC)
The Director-General of FAO administers the multilateral treaty, International Plant Protection
Convention (IPPC) (adopted in 1951) through the IPPC Secretariat located within FAO under the Plant
Protection Service. The main thrust of IPPC is to provide a framework and forum for international cooperation, harmonisation and technical exchange in collaboration with the Regional Plant Protection
Organisation (RPPOs) and the National Plant Protection Organisations (NPPOs). The focus is to provide
scientific inputs to deliberations on global trade. The Convention has undergone a number of revisions.
Notably, the more recent revisions incorporate the contemporary discourses on plant health in relation to the
Uruguay Round Agreements.
In the field of international standards setting for phytosanitary measures, a global programme for
harmonisation was finalised in 1992. However, the currently operative revision is the 1979 Convention, as
the required 66 per cent approval of the contracting parties to the latest revisions of the Convention is not
available yet.
The standard setting process is finally sent out to the contracting parties (members) by the Interim
Commission on Phytosanitary Measures (ICPM). The main work, however, is carried out by the IPPC
Secretariat in co-operation with NPPOs, RPPOs and expert Working Groups. There are three main stages
in the standard setting exercise, namely, Draft, Consultation and Approval.
IPPC membership is open to all FAO member-governments and non-members that inform the
Director-General about their governments willingness to approve the Convention. Certain interim measures
have been put in place through RPPOs in the absence of the required proportion of approval to the 1997
revision to the Convention.
The developing countries have a special focus in IPPC.
Consequently,
technical assistance has become the key element of IPPCs work programme.
IV.
The Article 13 of the SPS Agreement has made it obligatory for all member-countries to put in place a
reasonable implementation strategy. Further, this implementation strategy at all levels of governance in the
country has to be consistent with the provisions of the Agreement. Towards this end, the Indian government
has taken appropriate steps since the multilateral agreement came into force.
IV.1
As laid out in the Transparency Clause (Article 7) and further elaborated in the Annex-B of SPS
Agreement, the Trade Policy Division (TPD) in the Ministry of Commerce has been designated as the National
Notification Authority (NNA) for the country. NNA in the Commerce Ministry is co-ordinating with different
concerned Ministries and Department for appointment of Enquiry Points. However, for export-oriented units,
mandatory stipulations are to be certified by the apex Export Inspection Council (EIC) or their regional offices
2
and Export Inspection Agencies (EIAs).
In addition, India has a permanent representative to WTO with an active interest in matters pertaining
to agro-product trade issues. It is therefore expected that SPS Committee meetings would be attended by a
representative from the Indian Mission Office in Geneva. Besides, technical expertise as and when required
is addressed by composing an appropriate delegation for attending crucial meetings.
However, going by the emerging literature and discussion amongst various officials, the tenor of the
3
discourse appears to centre around the legislative dimensions. There appears to be a need to bring in a
more deeper and sustained participation from the scientific fraternity. The scientific fraternity, as is evident,
belong to three distinct streams, namely human health, plant and animal health. Notably, scientific community
of the country has been interacting with the international standards-setting organisation that is in the forefront
and have found mention in SPS Agreement. These institutions are as follows: International Organisation for
Standardisation (ISO); Codex Alimentarius Commission (Codex) that is jointly run by FAO and WHO; Office
International des Epizooties (OIE) and International Plant Protection Convention (IPPC).
Since the WTO designated these international standards -setting organisations to act as benchmarks
for international standards in their distinct specialised discipline, incorporation of such scientific inputs into
trade related decision-making is indeed a challenge to be addressed by the developing countries in general
and India, in particular.
The institutional mechanism thus is evolving itself to first understand and then confidently address
myriad issues pertaining to trade effects of standards. In this direction, the first step is to design appropriate
legislative mechanism.
This is facilitated by gaining access to the decision making body either as observer or votingmember Status. The next step as a continuum is to regularly attend the annual meetings where major
decisions are discussed.
The next step is a pro-active effort demanding participation in technical committees and subcommittees in which standards are specifically discussed. The final two steps are participation in the
administration of the organisation and scientifically influencing the discussions. Arguably, both these final
steps are restrictive in the sense that they require a mature attempt. The developing countries, unfortunately
deem it a greater challenge.
IV.2
Poor participation and absence of developing country specific discussion have been the hallmark of
the first five years of the SPS Committee meetings. Given the technical nature of the discussion on the one
hand and the legal nature of SPS agreement requiring administrative and legislative approval, on the other
hand, it is not surprising at all to discover that sufficient information about the Indian participation in the SPS
Committee meetings are hard to come by.
2
3
However, going by the secondary level literature certain broad contours can possibly be drawn.
Whereas contracting developing countries as a group form a sizeable block in terms of numbers in the
SPS Committee or even in WTO, international standard setting organisation differ greatly in their approaches.
This happens even though a number of such organisations come under the UN umbrella.
The prohibitive direct cost argument for non-participation, as a matter of fact, requires to be examined
in greater details. This has become imperative since the UN bodies often put forth the same argument for
fiscal prudence reasoning.
The provision of granting observer status to parastatal bodies or collectives of trade bodies from the
developing countries is taken upon a case to case basis while the Permanent Observer Status is granted to
IMF. Many issues follow out from such approvals granted by the SPS Committee.
The credit for scientific wisdom to IMF and the World Bank measured in terms of the Core Fund
facility does not guarantee scientific rigour and directly address issues of variability in scientific inputs from the
developing countries.
The poor communication and dissemination of scientific determinants of stringent and higher than
international standards are yet another set of challenges that seriously questions the basic intentions of the
developed countries.
In stark contrast to the developing countries participation in the SPS meetings in Geneva, the
developed countries have been regular members to all meetings. Most OECD countries have always been
5
represented. An analysis showed that upto 2001, the matters discussed indicated 27 related to food safety,
38 to animal health, 37 to plant health and 3 to other SPS issues. Thus, the agenda for discussion appeared
too skewed in favour of the developed countries. Surely, attendance in the meetings of SPS Committees has
its own compulsions.
Since the new order of trade requires planned and sustained exports, there is no gainsaying that
quality consciousness and related technical competence especially in the food processing sector would show
an ascendancy across the spectrum of farm to table. And hence ascendancy of kitchen diplomacy in the
contemporary world scenario. The new trend in the kitchen diplomacy is being set by the ready to eat
segment of the agribusiness. Against this backdrop the recent announcement in September 2002 about
establishment of a new fund, namely, Standards and Trade Development Facility, by the World Bank and
WTO and expectations of a wider support from other international standards setting institutions as well as G-8
countries assume importance for any discussion on SPS.
It is claimed that the new facility of fund will bring about a w
in-win outcome for developed and
developing countries. A close look at the ground realities do indicate that this outcome will never be achieved
since the developed countries keep shifting their standards higher and higher, albeit, under the legitimate
clause of scientific evidence.
The developing countries have been strongly arguing, both at the Doha Ministerial Conference and
afterwards, that in the area of sanitary and phytosanitary (SPS) measures, standards set in developed nations
are trade distorting. For example, a cursory glance at any request for consultations filed by a developing
nation with the dispute settlement board of WTO post-1996 clearly indicate SPS as a main cause of the plaint.
The SPS norms can be broadly looked at from three perspectives, namely, microbiological, physical
and chemical to appreciate the economics of ground reality and therefore the significance for agenda setting
at the SPS Committee meetings. This can at best be called the shifting (goal)-post syndrome. A few of recent
controversy can be cited here to echo the shifting post syndrome. Following instances merely indicate tip of
the iceberg. European countries banning import of fish from many African countries; seafood exports to EU
from India and Thailand on grounds of drug residues; frequent raising/shifting of acceptable levels of chemical
elements and foreign bodies in the food commodities; exceptionally high standard not based on any scientific
evidence especially for the processed fruits and vegetables, etc. We also have instances in EU of 100 per
cent testing of imports from selective countries while only a few sample testing is done for few countries.
These restrictions not only push up the cost of exports, but also adversely impact on the competitiveness and
4
Notable amongst them are Henson, Spencer et.al. (2001) Review of Developing Country Needs and
Involvement in International Standards-Setting Bodies Centre for Food Economics Research, University of
Reading; OECD (2002) Sanitary and Phytosanitary Measures and Agricultural Trade: A Survey of issues and
Concerns Raised in the WTOs SPS Committee, Joint Working Party of Agriculture and Trade (JT00129244).
COM/TD/AGR/WP(2002)21/Final.
OECD (2002) op.cit.
11
value-volume trade off amongst different product lines. Hence emergence of the developed countries as
global leaders of agricultural trade and the need for ingenious SPS mechanism to stay as leaders. Such
being the motivations participation in meetings by developing country members indeed would require to be
addressed in a different manner.
A growing volume of international trade in agricultural products in the post-WTO period has
made it abundantly clear to India that vulnerability to food based health problems, be it humans,
plant or animal lives, is indeed serious. Therefore, for a win-win outcome in agricultural trade
between rich and poor nations, the short to medium term temptations of the richer nations, namely,
to prescribe more stringent standards on dubious scientific evidence must be avoided. The
harmonization, equivalence and transparency principles enunciated in the SPS agreement has to be
rescued from being merely slogans for rich nations.
IV.3
Technicalities of SPS
As has been examined in Section III above the scientific merit of the food safety standards has
become the key operating word for the implementation of SPS Agreement. The scientific temper of the
Agreement notwithstanding, the rigour and sensitivity levels of testing instruments and labelling requirements
to trace the field/tank/farm of origin as well as precision farming approaches in the final analysis impose
certain technical barriers that developing countries find hard to address.
Risk Analysis is a technical area but the farmers have their own way of assessing it and thus have
devised mitigating strategies. These strategies take different forms and diversified cropping pattern, mixed
farming, fishing holidays, etc. are some of them that acquired indigenous practices/knowledge label.
Perhaps, it has stood the scientific audit too. The technical rigour under SPS agreement requires adoption of
HACCP routines. Practitioners of HACCP as examined earlier in one of the Sections demand documentation.
A telling commentary on documentation can be seen in the following section.
The need for documentation is well recognised in Indian agriculture and allied discipline as it helps
6
one out to fine tune the package of practices protocol. The fundamental question, however, for Indian
producers aspiring to gain access to the international market is a question of not much significance. The
reasons for such insignificances is discussed below taking a few product specific instances.
IV.4
The Indian experiences during the last five years in facing the SPS measures in their export
consignments have been very varied. The product specific detentions by the US government show an
7
interesting picture. However, details of product specific global experiences are briefly examined below.
IV.4.1
Poultry
About two years ago, India was de-listed from the list of approved countries in EU for the import of
egg powders into EU for non-submission of Residue Monitoring Plan. It has been the strategy of EU countries
to introduce newer, stricter residue limits every time they feel like restricting imports from developing countries
like India. This can be illustrated with a few cases.
First, the issue of residue limits and the Residue Monitoring Plan itself has been used as an SPS
measure very strongly by developed countries like EU and USA. India also suffer since no agency took the
responsibility of preparing the Residue Monitoring Plan for animal products including egg powders and the
matter was thrown from one Ministry/department to other. If this had been laid down clearly in the documents
itself that who will do and implement, this matter could have been sorted out easily. Therefore, the issue of
proper and good documentation comes out very strongly even in this case.
The second example of SPS measure which the developed countries are using is in the matter of
granting equivalency to countries like India since we do not have a proper document and where some
document exists, EU and USDA has just not bothered to grant equivalency to Indian standards for egg
powders. Even after four years since having submitted the list of plants to be notified by EU they have not
constituted a commission to inspect these plants in India, notify them and grant them equivalency.
6
7
For further details on documentation reference be made to Mehta, Rajesh and J. George (2002) op.cit
Details are discussed in Mehta, Rajesh and J. George (2003) Processed Food Products Export from India: An
Exploration with SPS Regime, RIS Paper for the Joint ACIAR Research Project, March 14-17.
12
Thirdly, invariably the test certificates issued by Indian laboratories are not accepted in EU and other
developed countries as these labs are not accredited to the labs of developed countries. Though, the Indian
labs follow the same testing methods and protocol for testing the samples. Therefore, the certification issue is
also being used as an SPS measure by other countries.
If we look into the US importation rules, it is inherently placed in their document that they can stop
importation of poultry and poultry meat products from other countries on various grounds which are favourably
placed in their hand and in their favour. The FSIS can suspend the eligibility of another country if it feels that
an emerging sanitary measure is to be implemented to address a hazard that is so severe that no product can
enter from a foreign establishment until a control is in place. In a second situation, if the other country does
not provide satisfactory documentation of equivalent sanitary measure or if FSIS audit reveals that exporting
country is not implementing a public health sanitary measure in the manner that FSIS determined to be
equivalent, they can permanently stop eligibility of that country for export. They can further take action
against a particular country if they feel that their products are adulterated or misbranded on on-site audit or
because of Port of Entry re-inspection etc. These are the SPS measures in different garbs which are used
and can be potentially used by the developed countries like USA for stopping exports from developing
countries like India.
We should also keep in mind the environment and welfare issue adopted by EU. Legislation on
Nitrate levels in Denmark and the growing trends towards organic production and their increasing cost on
housing would further bring in new issues in the shape of SPS measures. In Germany, animal welfare is
becoming an important issue and there is a general agreement to limit the bird density of broilers while small
cages are to be banned and in future these rules are going to be stricter. After the BSE crises of late 2000,
which damaged the reputation of EUs food and farming industry, Salmonella control in laying hens by costly
vaccine has become a normal thing. In France, new manure disposal regulations and the traditional method
of producing animals, slowly and at low density will be an important animal welfare issue for future. In
Netherlands, high livestock density accompanied by tough regulations and manure disposal has resulted in
eco-tax, which again has increased the cost of gas and electricity there. They are trying to bring in tougher
rules on ammonia emission and current policy is to ban laying hen cages. There are Directives to regulate
broiler bird densities and production.
Similar example can be given of Spain, Hungary and Poland where these issues are emerging and
they will be used tomorrow in the shape of SPS measure agains t developing countries like India. It has been
observed, that many a times, Certificate of Foot and Mouth disease and anti -radiation are being asked from
Indian egg processors which has nothing to do with poultry production and even if there is an evidence of this
disease in any part of the country, SPS Agreement clearly talks of disease-free zones, under Article 6, that
clearly lays down that members shall take into account the level of prevalence of specific disease or pests, the
existence of eradication or control program or proper criteria/guidelines which may be developed by relevant
organisation. Finally, whereas Article 9 of the SPS Agreement talks of technical assistance or special and
differential treatment to developing country members for phased introduction of SPS measures, these are not
adhered to.
Sometimes the non-availability of proper protocols, equipment and sampling procedures
domestically also hampers the work of certification by the local testing labs.
Figure IV.1 and IV.2 present the structure of the supply chain for both types of birds, layers and
broilers has been explained. It is very, very essential that this chain at each stage is maintained properly and
health and hygiene requirements are met strictly, then only the food can be assumed as safe.
Poultry industry consist of both layers and broiler producing eggs, chicken meat and represents
different stages starting from Great Grand Parents or Purelines which is followed by the next generation of
Grand Parents and Parent Breeding Farm. Upto this stage, the science involved is pure genetics followed by
very sound principles of management in poultry management. Hatchery is the hub area either of broiler or
layer where sanitation and hygiene plays a very major and critical role. This is one area where lot of care has
to be taken otherwise the chicks production from incubators and hatchers can catch different diseases which
will not only affect the health of the birds but also can create food safety problems for the consumers. There
is a very close inter-relationship between each stage of this chart and each link has to be protected from
contamination. This chain can be in the form of vertical integration or independent companies can work in the
production of purelines, great grand parents, parent stock. Similarly, independent companies can also work in
the production of day-old chicks in their hatcheries, which can just be started by a parent-breeding farm. Food
can be produced by the integrator himself as well as can be purchased from the farmers from outside sources
in the form of broiler chicken and eggs.
In India, vertical integration has not taken its root very strongly and there are only a few companies,
who are involved in all the activities of the supply chain in a typical integrated operation. Most of the poultry
operations operated otherwise are run by independent producers of Grand Parents, Parents and there is a
13
large number of hatchery operators also. Similarly, poultry feed is produced by the integrator himself but at
the same time there
are
many
companies who are involved in the feed production. There are a large
number of commercial farmers both for layers and broilers and further processing of chicken and eggs is still
at a nascent stage. There are about half a dozen egg processing plants out of which three are operating
presently and two of them are HACCP compliant meeting the international standards.
During 1996 all 6 plants were exporting egg products to EU and other developed countries. Due to
instance of EU for a new residue limits of pesticides and instance for submission and execution of RMP by
India as country; the export of egg powder declined significantly. In fact the capacity utilisation of all most all
the units became negligible. In fact it led to the closure of 3 units. The export of egg powder has again picking
up after 3 plants have got themselves equipped with higher standards. To adjust these plants to higher
standard and HACCP compliance, each unit had to invest around Rs 1.5 to 2.00 crores and operating cost
has also increased by around 1 per cent.
Similarly, further processing is being done by companies like Venkys (India) Limited who are also
suppliers to multi-national food chains like Dominos, Pizza Hut, KFC and TGI Fridays etc. Such plants are
meeting the international standards but about half a dozen plants are also in operation that are basically doing
whole bird slaughter and processing. About 97% of the chicken is still sold live in Mandies and typically some
of the mandies (m arket yards) like Gazipur of Delhi, where more than 2,00,000 birds are traded everyday.
The broiler is still sold live and that too on score basis (20 number make one score). The layer farms, egg
grading, washing and packaging has just started for export purposes. However, majority of the eggs are still
sold in small numbers by small, small operators.
This complex situation of so many players in the chain and when you want a fully vertically integrated
system in the country, the food safety becomes a major problem as there are so many handlers and these
handlers are doing different jobs and many a times they may not be aware of the food safety requirements.
Many companies operate from the primary breeding stage where rest of the chain is integrated and the control
is centralised which may put them in an advantageous position in terms of food safety as compared with the
companies that are not integrated and where separate and different companies are responsible for different
steps in the chain, as is evident in India.
In countries like India, where live market still dominates and it is a major and significant outlet for
chicken producers and marketers, the standards of food safety are little difficult to meet as the number of
butchers and processors selling the same are very large and above all there are no documented guidelines
available which are either voluntary or can be enforced. To achieve an acceptable level of confidence in the
food safety, certain steps can be undertaken pertaining to risk assessment. These steps are variously defined
to consist of stages, such as Good Manufacturing Practices (GMP); Quality Management Systems (QMS),
HACCP, etc.
In India, there are different agencies that are dealing with the food safety of food products
particularly that of poultry. Export Inspection Council (EIC) and its agencies under the Ministry of Commerce
deal with the export of egg products and have also formulated standards for poultry meat and poultry
products which are under notification (see Annexure IV). Directorate of Marketing and Inspection (DMI) in
part deals with processed poultry products under Meat Food Products Order (MFPO) which is under the
Ministry of Agriculture. Additionally, the Department of Animal Husbandry & Dairying also deals with meat
and poultry products. Bureau of Indian Standards (BIS) has also formulated some rules, which are voluntary
in nature. APEDA and EIC has taken lead in formulating Residue Monitoring Plan for the monitoring of
residues of pesticides, antibiotic etc. in egg products and animal products. The PFA also deals with the
food products under its Prevention of Food Adulteration Act.
All these measures/standards which should currently be in use in parts for domestic products and in
parts for export really do not encompass all the products under one head as the standard formulating,
implementing and monitoring agencies are separate. There are no standards at all for commercial bird
producers and procedures for broilers and eggs. Similarly, India has not been able to do zoning of diseases
wherein countries in EU, East Europe and South-East Asia requires a certificate that there is an absence of
disease like Newcastle and absence of pesticides in the animal or egg products. Wherein some standards
have been made by BIS, they have not been upgraded for years together. Wherever standards are
available they are obsolete, out of place and do not meet the present requirements of international
standards. However, the standards framed for export of poultry meat and egg powder do match with the
international standards of EU and USDA. But the Government has not been able to get an equivalence for
these standards from EU and USDA for the last three years.
14
Figure IV.1:
Typical Structure of Broilers (Meat Type Birds) Industry and Different Stages of Supply
Chain in India
Grand Parents
Hatchery
Day-Old Broiler Chicks
Feed Mill
Commercial Broiler Farm
Rendering &
Waste Unit
Processing Plant of
Vertical Integrator
Further Processing
Dealers/Retailers
Consumer
Wholesaler
Sub / Small Wholesaler
Retailers / Butchers
Consumer
15
Figure IV.2:
Typical Structure of Layers (Egg Type Birds) Industry and Different Stages of
Supply Chain in India
Layers (Egg Type Birds)
16
IV.4.2
Shrimp
The marine product lines have been undergoing major upheavals due to SPS measures imposed by
the EU. It has already been examined how marine exporters addressed this ban by EU.8 The main product
line that we have chosen to explore in detail is the Shrimps. Shrimps have two very distinct characteristics in
terms of production processes. These are aquaculture and sea catches.
The Shrimp exporters from India after the 1997 ban by EU are better prepared for the SPS regime.
Even the certifying agency has geared itself for the stringent quality norms that has been imposed. The
Australian Quarantine and Inspection Service (AQIS), the apex Australian import control agency recognised
the Indian certifying agency.
This implied that seafood consignments from India accompanied by EIC
certificate is to undergo only random verification sampling not exceeding 5 per cent of the consignments and
health certificates issued by EIC is to accepted.
The experience with quality compliance in the Shrimp exports can be looked at from three broad
perspectives:
(1)
(2)
(3)
pre-processing including Shrimp aquaculture and handling of raw Shrimp like harvesting, sorting, etc.
processing issues where water quality, source of water for ice making, infrastructure and
transportation utilities come in for sanctions.
Post-processing, including testing, packaging and marketing activities.
A reference to Annexure IV is sufficient to indicate that the legislative dimensions have been taken
care of by the Indian government. The industry group on the other hand is attempting to gain EU compliance.
Those, who made their plants EU approved, have been able to mop-up supplies from the catchment areas of
those, who could not afford EU approval.
IV.4.3
Mango Pulp
The experience of fruit and fruit product exporters are different from the experiences of poultry
products and Shrimp exporters. In the export business of Mango pulp a proactive role played by APEDA
appeared to have helped the exporters. As we shall examine below implementation of HACCP was
encouraged by the Ministry of Food Processing Industries in association with APEDA functionaries.
Incidentally APEDA has taken firm export promotion steps for the sector that is in fact, extending the Indian
brand equity enjoyed by the fresh Mango fruit in the market.
The compliance costs for implementing HACCP would have been prohibitive, had APEDA not come
to their rescue with both financial and technical assistance. All the participating units in the Chittoor District
have implemented HACCP. Five units were assessed and certified by International Standards Certification
(ISC) South Asia Pvt. Ltd. during the 1998 mango season. Six units of Chittor District and 6 units of
Krishnagiri District were assessed during the 1999 mango season. The National Sanitation Foundation (NSF)
has recommended all the participating units of Chittoor district for certification after the certification audit. A
certification audit of all the 6 units in the Krishnagiri District was carried out by the Quality Assurance Service
(Australia). All of these, interestingly, have been recommended for certification. Small units have not been
able to benefit from APEDAs efforts. There have been problems in applying HACCP at the farm level
because of the nature of farms and practices in India.
The quality norms under the Prevention of Food Adulteration Act (PFA) of India do not fully match with
Codex. For example, PFA does not cover rules for the various tests for water as required under Codex.
According to some small exporters, HACCP has not been followed in the pulp industry. There is a general
awareness about HACCP, but they think it has not been passed as a law so far and they do not have to worry
about it yet, especially because there is no consumer insistence in India for such standards. They admit that
HACCP will certainly increase market accessibility, but they will have problems in adopting this. Some of the
problems pointed out were:
(a)
(b)
Since orchards land holdings are small and contractors procure all the raw material, it will be
impossible to keep records at the field level as required for HACCP. The general age of
orchards ranges between 3 - 100 years, so it will be difficult to establish control;
Since this industry is seasonal (3 months) it is not feasible to adopt these standards, and to
retrain staff, as the units cannot keep permanent staff. Training new staff every year is also
not possible;
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
It will be more viable for large plants or industrial houses, which deal in multiple products,
work throughout the year and have their own orchards. But most of the units are small in this
sector and HACCP will not suit them;
As far as financial aspect of HACCP compliance is concerned, units which are setting up now,
will not have any problem. It does not cost much for new units, but the old units will have to
revamp their infrastructure. It is a costly affair; according to rough estimates the cost for
following HACCP will increase by 40 per cent;
Financial institutions do not fund HACCP activi ty;
Main markets for Mango Pulp are Gulf countries and they are only interested in cheap prices
not HACCP; and
It costs money to get ISO certification. The cost may range between 1.5 -2.5 lakhs for ISO
audit. The surveillance audit is every six-month and it costs Rs. 10,000 per man-day.
Apart from HACCP, pesticide residue is one of the main quality issues that applies in the same way
as it does in peanuts. The other quality issues are that Indian pulp is brown in colour, is supplied in punctured
bags, poor quality of drums in which it is exported, feathering (peeling of the coat), rusting, metallic taste (tin
taste) and damage to seam of the tin or drum. These are packaging issues and do not affect health. The
reason for above packaging problem is the quality of packaging material available in the domestic market.
The imported tin is good in quality but adds to the costs. According to exporters, they do not have the
technology or the technology is costly and they do not have the economies of scale to meet the costs. They
feel that packaging should not be considered a health hazard.
Testing is a major problem for these units. There are a number of institutions but these are spread all
over the country are quite expensive. The Central Food Technological Research Institute (CFTRI) charges
Rs.3000/- per test and Societe Generale De Surveillance (SGS) charges 0.27 per cent of f.o.b. value of the
consignment. Laboratories in India are not equipped with equipment based on the new technology required
for the complicated tests necessary to comply with HACCP. Foreign health authorities are moving from parts
per million (ppm) to parts per billion (ppb). Indian laboratories are not equipped to do these tests. There are
differences between the test results of India and those of Europe, allegedly due to the methods of testing, and
not due to the objectives behind the tests. In Europe only natural food imports are encouraged, i.e. no sugar
should be added. However, sugar is also a natural product but if sugar is added there is an increase of 13 per
cent import duty. The duty is 6.5 per cent without sugar and 19.5 per cent with sugar. They add sugar
themselves because they have a surplus of beat sugar, which is also subsidised in Europe. The buyers are
interested to buy the pulp with sugar but are dissuaded by the higher duty levied. All the ex colonies of
France, Portugal and Spain do not pay duty on food items. However, all ex-colonies of UK have to pay duty.
Successful exporters feel that the quality of Indian food has to be monitored for exports, and APEDA
should introduce licensing. It will be very difficult to monitor implementation of norms if everybody is allowed
to export. Small-scale units should not be encouraged to export because of their fling-by-night operations,
according to them. The FPO has issued 4700 licenses for food processing units, out of which 21 are large
units, 156 medium and the rest are small scale; 90 per cent of these units are making Mango pulp.
Exporters have fixed buyers for years; th erefore, their relationship is good. In the event of any trouble
with the authorities on account of quality or any other reason most of the buyers are helpful in sorting out the
problems at their end due to their stake in the clearance of consignments. The quality issue becomes a major
hurdle when the buyers have an excess stock or the prices of the goods have fallen in the international market
below the agreed/contracted price. In such cases, sometimes the exporters have to accept price discounts,
especially because of the perishable nature of the goods.
The main issue to be appreciated here is the issue of processing industries where the timetemperature and moisture contents in the harvested fruits play a decisive role. Consider the following flow
chart to appreciate the perspective of the industry following HACCP.
The point being made is that at each stage different food safety regulations come into reckoning that
is not entirely in the control of the processor. A good agricultural practice protocol unfortunately does not hold
any promise as the scale and intensity of mango cultivation is entirely different in India.
18
Figure IV.3:
The Ministry of Commerce takes interest in their operations, as they are responsible for trade
promotion. But the problems faced by the exporters are quality or health related for which the Health Ministry
should be involved. Even in business negotiations, the foreigners want an assurance from the Health Ministry,
which is not easy to obtain. There is a need to create better policy coherence here. The Health Ministry is
responsible for the development of Codex standards. The exporters feel that the Ministry could consult
producers to their benefit while attending Codex meetings and formulating domestic standards. Food laws lay
an emphasis on economic offences and not on safety. The basic thrust of food laws is thus misplaced so far
as export promotion is concerned.
In the final analysis, the study clearly indicates the positive impact of affirmative action by an apex
export agency like APEDA in enhancing quality export earnings.
IV.4
Mushrooms
Mushrooms are an enterprise with rich backward linkages in terms of employment generation without
competing for the scarce arable a
l nd resource. In fact, Mushroom cultivation offers an opportunity to value
add on biological coarse inedible resources with a little help from the scientific endeavour. A severe constraint
in productivity is being experienced by most of the small growing units. Some of the bottlenecks identified
during our preliminary interaction with the industry are discussed below.
Quotas on mushrooms are continuing from the past when the agriculture sector was not covered by
GATT disciplines. The tariffication process built into the Agreement on Agriculture of the WTO is yet to result
in quota free access of mushrooms to EU.
Multilateral efforts are required to expedite this process. Meanwhile, India needs to submit a
representation to EU to have an exclusive quota fixed.
Although composting was accomplished by the grower, information on the raising of a healthy crop of
mushrooms has been emerging as a major bottleneck. The grower would collect spawn from some source
and not know about the growing parameters, nor was the modern cropping room available to him/her. So, this
19
method of growing in improvised cropping rooms continued till the late eighties for a majority of the growers in
India, resulting in poor yields.
In the late eighties and early nineties, modern cultivation units were established with help from various
companies in Europe, which were more interested in selling their machinery and in the establishment of the
mushroom farms at their asking rate. This did help in the building of modern mushroom units but the big
question was who would manage/run them. That is where the Indian industry took a beating and unit after unit
failed to produce mushrooms on a scale of profitability. This is the period when sometime was taken to tune
the production parameters till economic yields were obtainable by most of the units in India. By the time this
was achieved, the international market came crashing down and the same impasse is still continuing.
20
V.
CONCLUSION
A detailed analysis of the institutional and legal framework in India envisaged to usher in an efficient
SPS regime in the post-WTO phase bring out more challenges in three distinct areas. First, is that the current
emphasis on adjudicative and legislative roles for the legal professionals and bureaucrats perhaps is being
overplayed at the WTO Secretariat. Whereas, it is recognised that under the nations sovereign governance
framework three elements, namely, judiciary, legislative and executives have their roles and status clearly
marked out. However, under the globalisation framework, the contemporary institutions require, perhaps, to
take more seriously the trade issues with a long backward linkage chain. It is here in the backward loop
where issues of sub-national governance come in for a critical appraisal. This is imminent because SPS
affect India differently than is generally believed. Hence, by an overtly disproportionate attention to the legal
text and institutional arrangements in the mold of one size fits all (OSFA) across the developing countries
appears faulty.
The second area is the dovetailing of scientific knowledge with the existing institutions in the country
with the trade concerns for facilitating processual inputs in the production stages. Given the base of scientific
manpower in the country, this task is not at all daunting. Biological processes have a distinction that may not
be easily accounted for in the industrial processing activities.
Besides, the residual limits for
pesticides/insecticides or presence of microorganism etc. do require a level of sensitivity of high precision.
Such precision is to be made available by the instrumentation specialists and sectors that is not figuring in the
core agenda. Incidentally, this sector is at the threshold level if food safety measures and regulations are to
give the desired results. The Indian instrumentation sector in that sense is not in its infancy but requires
encouragement and support.
The experiences of the lab to land and other reaching out initiatives of the scientist therefore begs
for a relook in the present environment where GAP, GMP and HACCP lay a heavy emphasis on many
disaggregated processes.
Thirdly, the dichotomised framework for domestic consumption and export market orientation in the
food-processing sector is yielding to harmonisation efforts in many product lines. The process could be
hastened if the legal and administrative mechanisms are fine tuned to appreciate the public-private
partnership framework.
All products studied as typical cases in the paper underscore the importance of information that is
credible and authentic.
The wide variation in safety standards within the EU or frequently changing
regulations without sufficient scientific probity brings to a naught the transparency, equivalence and
harmonization troika of SPS Agreement.
21
Annexure I: Some Notes on Import Policy as Announced Under EXIM Policy, April 2002
1.
Hazardous Waste is permitted for import against a licence for the purpose of processing and reuse.
2.
Import of Beef in any form and import of products containing beef in any form is prohibited.
3.
All consignments of edible oils and processed food products, imported in bulk, shall carry a
declaration from the concerned exporter on the shipping documents that the consignment does not
contain beef in any form. All consignments of edible products, imported in consumer packs, shall carry
a declaration on the label of the package that the product does not contain beef in any form.
4.
Import of meat and poultry products will be subject to the compliance of conditions regarding
manufacture, slaughter, packing, labelling and quality conditions as laid down in Meat Food Products
Order, 1973. All manufacturers of meat/poultry products exporting their goods to India shall be
required to meet the sanitary and hygienic requirements as stipulated under Schedule-II of the
aforementioned order. The imported product shall also comply with the specified packaging, labelling
and quality standards as laid down in Schedule-IV of the order. Compliance of these conditions is to
be ens ured before allowing customs clearance of the consignments.
5.
Import of all such edible/food products, domestic sale and manufacture of which are governed by
Prevention of Food Adulteration Act. 1954, shall be subject to all the conditions laid down in the
aforesaid Act. Import of all these products will have to comply with the quality and packaging
requirements as laid down in the Act. Compliance of these conditions is to be ensured before allowing
customs clearance of the consignment.
6.
Import of all primary agricultural products will be subject to a Bio-Security & Sanitary-Phyto Sanitary
import permit, to be issued by Department of Agriculture and Co-operation, as per conditions of
Plants, Fruits and Seeds (Regulation of Import into India) Order, 1989. The permit will be based on
Import Risk Analysis of the product, to be conducted on scientific principles, in accordance with the
WTO Agreement on the Application of Sanitary and Phyto-sanitary measures. The Import Risk
Analysis will be conducted based on various scientific principles, including inter alia,
(a)
(b)
(c)
the type of pests etc. known to be associated with the particular product in the exporting
country;
the organism already established in India; and
the potential impact of such organisms on Indias international trade.
7.
Import of tea waste is to be allowed only to the licence holders under the order issued by Tea Board.
8.
Import of alcoholic beverages as classified under Chapter 22 of ITC(HS) Classifications of Export and
Import Items, 1997-2002, shall be subject to compliance of various mandatory requirements as
stipulated by various State Governments.
9.
Import of all such edible/food products, domestic sale and manufacture of which are governed by
Prevention of Food Adulteration Act, 1954 shall also be subject to the condition that, at the time of
importation, the products are having a valid shelf life of not less than 60 per cent of its original shelf
life. Shelf life of the product is to be calculated, based on the declaration given on the label of the
product, regarding its date of manufacture and the due date for expiry.
10.
Import of Meat and Meat Products of all kinds including fresh, chilled and frozen meat, tissue organs
of poultry, pig, sheep, goat; egg and egg powder; milk and milk products; bovine, ovine and caprine
embryos, ova or semen; and pet food products of animal origin shall be subject to a sanitary import
permit to be issued by Department of Animal Husbandry and Dairying, Government of India, as per
Section 3A of Live -stock Importation Act, 1898, as incorporated by Live Stock Importation
(Amendment) Ordinance, 2001 dated 05.07.2001 and as notified on 07.07.2001
11.
Import of Whale shark (Rhincodon typus) and parts and products of this species shall be restricted.
22
Annexure II:
India has plethora of laws regulating the food safety and other activities of food industry. Most of these laws
restrict the functioning of trade industry in a competitive trade without attaching much importance to food
safety standards. There is a multiplicity of agencies both for making as well as implementing the food safety
standards which has resulted into a very lose system which is not at all coherent, integrated. It is ve ry
important for the decision-makers in India to recognise that presence of multiplicity of food laws in the country
is not going to serve the purpose particularly in the international trade. In order to give a boost to the food
industry the need of the hour is to harmonise not only the various food laws but also the agencies. According
to apex industrial bodies there should be only one national food safety code, which should cover all aspects of
Indian food safety under a unified system.
Recently, in ht e budget speech of Finance Minister, he had called for an effort to simplify these laws and bring
them under one umbrella organisation. Accordingly, a group of Ministers has been set up to deliberate on this
issue but nobody knows how long it is going to take and when this new national food safety code will see the
light of the day.
What is more important today is to have a comprehensive, integrated food law which can not only take care of
ensuring public health, safety but also specify quality norms for meeting the globally recognised standards. It
may be kept in mind that whenever a country allows other country for exports, particularly, any foodstuff, they
very closely look at the domestic standards of that country.
Unfortunately, we do not have domestic
standards in place, which also results in imports of third grade products from other countries. If enabling
environment for rapid growth of food processing industry is to be created then the major challenges before the
food industry today are availability of choices, threats of imports as a result of globalisation, rapid advances in
science and technology, changing consumer preferences and concerns which can be addressed by a legal
framework which would need simplification and amendments across Central, State and local legislation.
The plethora of laws and multiple controls have led to a system, which is over-regulated and underadministered.
It neither assures safety nor quality.
Moreover, the documentation part is completely
neglected. An urgent need for re-focussing our existing food laws and aligning them with the internationally
prescribed for food trade widely followed in the world has been greatly felt. It has been now recognised that
this would greatly enhance innovation and would also protect adequately the consumer.
The following are the Indian regulatory agencies dealing with the food safety issues in the domestic markets
presently.
Prevention of Food Adulteration (PFA) Act, 1954
The most important regulation for ensuring food safety and quality in India continues to be out-dated PFA,
1954. The objective of this Act is to formulate and monitor the standards of quality and purity. The provision
of the Act are mandatory and contravention of the rules can theoretically lead ot both fine and imprisonment.
But this happens rarely in practice.
The Central Committee of Food Safety (CCFS) and Directorate General of Health Services, Ministry of Health
and Family Welfare are the primary policy making bodies that advise Central and State Governments
regarding the administration of the Act and developed standards relating to the Act. The State Governments
and local bodies in Corporation and Municipalities implement the provisions of the Act. It is the responsibility
of the Ministry of Health and Family Welfare to liase with the national and international food quality control
organisation, namely the Bureau of Indian Standards (BIS) which is associated with the certification of the
processed food articles, the Directorate of Marketing and Inspection (DMI), the Ministry of Food Processing
Industries as well as the Codex Alimentarius Commission. It also includes in its role the creation of consumer
awareness, which is hardly evident.
The PFA lays emphasis on the prevention of adulteration of foods and is not comprehensive enough to deal
with the contamination of food through the animal feed and the food chain. The apex industrial bodies like
Confederation of Indian Industries (CII), Federation of Indian Chambers of Commerce and Industry (FICCI)
and Central Food Technological Research Institute (CIFTRI) have very strongly called for a complete overhaul
of PFA in order to harmonise it with the international standards set by the Codex Alimentarius Commission.
Obviously, this demand from the food industry is to protect the health of the people but at the same time
there is a concern that food safety standards by other countries are being used against India as non-tariff
barriers to stop/restrict exports from India to the developed countries.
If we take a cursory look at the quality of food commodity being sold in the domestic market and PFA
functionaries, who are more than 6000 Food Inspectors, the domestic market challenges towards food safety
23
standards come to the fore. These typical Food Inspectors very often have no scientific background, but
orientation is towards legal technicalities. Any re-orientation of food laws may not have any incentive to
perform their duties diligently and honestly.
In theory, producers or traders who supply
adulterated/contaminated produce can be taken to court and fined or imprisoned, if found guilty. But there are
some problems in implementing the Act. It is a very long way from the central food laboratory to the court
room and the whole Act is unable to guarantee food safety at one hand and it also does not restrict import of
unhygienic, expired, badly labelled products from other countries. It is very important that the sampling
procedure is standardised and it is transparent which does not happen in PFA. The procedure for formulation
of standards should be participatory and all stake-holders should be consulted. With regard to certification the
emphasis should be on process control rather than the final product inspection. The procedures for inspection
and drawing samples should be laid down in accordance with the standards prescribed and should be in tune
with the international practice.
Export Quality Control Inspection Act, 1963
Export Inspection Council (EIC), Ministry of Commerce is responsible for implementation of this Act under
which the exportable commodities are notified for compulsory pre-shipment inspection. As regards export of
egg powder, Government has framed rules called the Export of Egg Products (Quality Control, Inspection &
Monitoring) Rules, 1997 that are applicable for the export of egg powders to EU. It may be noted that these
rules are basically a replica of EU Regulations. Under these rules quality assurance and monitoring system
manual has been made under which Export Inspection Agencies (EIAs) have been designated as competent
authorities for monitoring the egg products which are made for export purposes to EU. Presently, the egg
powder plants in India are regulated through these rules and the egg powder is also exported according to
these rules. The complete booklet published contains different sections which give details of the executive
instructions and specifies as under :
Prohibits the export of egg powders by a unit in the course of international trade which includes EU and
United States unless it confirms to standards applicable to it and is accompanied by a certificate stating that
such unit is approved and monitored by Export Inspection Agency establishment u/s 7(1) of the Export
(Quality Control & Inspection) Act, 1963 (22 of 1963). All the conditions have been published in the Gazette
rd
of India Extra-ordinary Part II Section 3, Sub-Section (ii) dated 23 August, 1997. This booklet is a complete
document, which is a replica of EU and United States standards for the same products and following has
Chapters:
Chapter I : General conditions of Approval and Operations
Chapter II : Special conditions for the approval of establishment
Chapter III : Hygiene requirements relating to the premises, equipments and staff of establishment
Chapter IV : Requirements concerning eggs intended for manufacture of egg products
Chapter V : Special hygiene requirements for the manufacture of egg products
Chapter VI : Analytical specifications
Chapter VII : Health Control and Supervision of Production
Chapter VIII : Packaging of egg products
Chapter IX : Storage
Chapter X : Transport
Chapter XI : Marking of Egg Products
It also has Annexure I and II, which talks of residues, sampling strategy, frequency etc. In fact, Government
of India has submitted a Residue Monitoring Plan to EU which otherwise is also a necessity to keep the name
of India listed in the EU list of importers. This Residue Monitoring Plan gives details of various residues
alongwith surveillance system to monitor the residues, name of approved labs, procedures for obtaining test
services, nomination of National Reference Lab, responsibility of the nominated lab, evaluation of the report
by National Reference Lab, description of pesticide residues limit, residue limits of pharmacological
substances etc.
24
Government of India through Ministry of Commerce and Export Inspection Council had applied for
equivalency for these standards with the EU Commission and it is over three years now but so far equivalency
has not been granted and Indian plants have not been notified by the EU Commission pertaining to egg
powder products.
Similarly, Government of India through Export Inspection Council are also in the process of notifying order on
fresh poultry meat and poultry meat products which also specifies and lays down draft rules for export of fresh
poultry meat and poultry meat products under Quality Control, Inspection and Monitoring Rules, 2002 which
will be applicable for the inspection and monitoring of fresh poultry meat and poultry meat products prior to
export.
In this proposal fresh poultry meat and poultry meat products including meat which is vacuum wrapped or
wrapped in controlled atmosphere, which has not undergone any preserving process other than chilling or
freezing; poultry meat products which are further processed by means of drawing, curing, smoking, cooking,
frying, seasoning, flavouring or by any other method of processing.
It is understood that preliminary
notification of these draft standards has been issued and final notification is expected anytime. These
standards also are a replica of EU and USDA standards and have the following annexures :
Annexure I : General conditions for the approval of establishments
Annexure II : Special conditions for the approval of poultry slaughter houses.
Annexure III : Special conditions for the approval of cold-stores.
Annexure IV : Hygiene of staff and premises and equipment in the establishment
Annexure V : Pre-slaughter health inspection
Annexure VI : Hygiene requirement for slaughtering and handling of poultry meat
Annexure VII : Post-mortem Health inspection
Annexure VIII : Decision of the Official veterinarian at the post-mortem inspection
Annexure IX : Provisions concerning meat intended for cutting
Annexure X : Health monitoring of cut poultry meat and poultry stored meat
Annexure XI : Health marking
Annexure XII : Storage
Annexure XIII: Wrapping and Packaging of poultry meat
Annexure XIV : Transport
Annexure XV : Professional qualifications of Plant Technologists
Annexure XVI : Description of poultry from where fresh meat is obtained
Annexure XVII : Model Health Attestation
Annexure XVIII : Model Health Certificate for fresh poultry meat
It may not be out of place to mention that there is one more exercise going on to frame standards for the
export of table eggs and for that purpose USDA Regulations of FSIS has been taken as a base but this matter
is still under process. For some latest updates on Notifications reference to Annexure IV may please be
made.
Meat Products Control Order, 1973
These is one more agency which talks of controlling meat food products which falls under Ministry of
th
Agriculture and has been issued in the Extra-Ordinary Gazette Part II Section 3 Sub-Section (ii) of dated 28
March, 1973. The name of this order is Meat Products Control Order, 1973, which came into force from
15/7/75. This order also covers some part of meat including poultry meat. The licensing authority under this
order is the Agriculture Marketing Advisor to the Government of India. Similarly, the Bureau of Indian
25
Standards (BIS) who are completely voluntary has also formulated certain standards, which again remains a
half-hearted approach for the standardisation of the food safety rules. For other food products ht ere are
orders like Milk and Milk products Order, 1992, Solvent Extracted Oil, De-Oiled Meal and Edible Flour Control
Order, Vegetable Oil Products control Order, Compulsory Compliance Legislation and Food Products Order.
Food Testing Labs
There are 72 food labs under the administrative control of Central and State Governments as well as local
bodies.
Central Food Labs : Four Central Food Labs have been established under PFA Act to serve as Appellate
Labs. Here samples of food articles taken by Food Inspectors from State and Local levels are tested. Two of
these labs, the Food Research and Standardisation Labs, Ghaziabad and Central Food Lab, Kolkata are
under the administrative control of the Directorate General of Health Services. The other two, Central Food
Lab (CFL), Pune and Food Central Lab, Mysore are under the administrative control of Government of
Maharashtra and Council of Scientific and Industrial Research. In addition to this, there are 84 State Food
Labs and one-third are under the administrative control of local bodies. Some labs under EIC and BIS are
also operating. Presently, there is no national apex lab that can offer entire range of testing services and
results of which cannot be challenged by the labs and the buyers in developed countries. Moreover, these
labs also lack in infrastructure except the CFTRI lab at Mysore.
Insufficient capacity inadequate training : Another important lacunae in the food quality assurance system, if
we can call it a system, is lack of proper training facilities in the area of food safety and testing despite the fact
that we have a large human resource available with us. The training given to Food Inspectors is minimal,
highly inadequate and it is not relevant in the present scenario of globalisation. Out of the 150 Universities
and colleges teaching agriculture and health, only few offer courses related to food safety and quality. Even
their food safety and quality forms a very small component of training provided as a part of the nutrition course
in home science or food technology department. The only mentionable source of training in food quality
control is provided by the organisations like CFTRI, Mysore and CFL, Kolkata etc.
Voluntary Standards
Bureau of Indian Standards : As mentioned earlier BIS developed standards for most processed foods that
are domestically traded in India. In general these standards cover raw material permitted and their quality
parameters, hygiene conditions under which the products must be manufactured and meet the packaging and
labelling requirements. Producers who comply with BIS standards can obtain the ISI mark. The BIS has four
regional offices and its Head Quarter is in Delhi.
Directorate of Marketing & Inspection(DMI) :
DMI enforces the agriculture produce (Grading and
Marketing) Act, 1937. Under this Act, grade standards are prescribed for agriculture and allied commodities.
Grading is voluntary and manufacturers who comply with the standards laid down by DMI are allowed to put
Agmark labels on their products.
Ministry of Environment and Forest : Ministry of Environment and Forest has introduced Ecomark criteria
for certain food items such as edible oil, tea, coffee, baby foods and preserved food and vegetables. The
criteria are in accordance with PFA, as in the case of BIS standards, Ecomark is voluntary standard and not a
mandatory one.
The Compound Livestock and Food Manufacturers Association of India, which also
manufactures animal and poultry feed has also laid down, certain standards for its own members for the
manufacture of compounded cattle and poultry feed. They have also installed certain labs for testing Aflatoxin
and other toxins. In the private sector, particularly in poultry, there are labs like Poultry Diagnostic Research
Centre which are having excellent facilities for testing the samples, particularly on residues and microorganisms etc. These labs also have been recognised by organisations like APEDA for testing the residues of
pesticides and antibiotic.
26
Annexure III:
An autonomous Food Regulatory Authority of India to be set up, to coordinate and supervise the
implementation of the Food Act, to formulate rules and procedures, and to amend, add or delete any
of the same as may be required from time to time in fulfillment of the objectives of The Food Act. To
recommend to the Govt. on related issues.
(b)
All current Laws governing food to be converged into this Food Act. This will include:
(1)
(2)
(3)
(4)
The Prevention of Food Adulteration Act, 1954, PFA Rules, 1955. All the State amendments
and orders relating to the same.
All orders under the Essential Commodities Act and other statutes pertaining to food
standards, quality, safety, packaging, mandatory certification etc. including FPO, MMPO,
MFPO, VOP, SEO, and others.
Suitable amendments be made to the Agmark and BIS to remove mandatory certification in
relation to Food Articles from these.
This Act will contain all necessary legal provisions regarding labeling requirements. Hence,
the provisions of such Acts as the Standards of Weights & Measures Act, 1976, the related
Packaged Commodities Rules, 1977, the Standards of Weights & Measures (Enforcement)
Act, 1985 and Infant Milk Substitutes and Feeding Bottles Act so far as they pertain to food
articles shall be specifically converged into the Food Act.
(c)
(d)
FRAI will set up systems and infrastructure, curriculum, schedules etc. for the periodic training and
development of all personnel involved in he
t Food Safety Administration (FSA) and different segments
of the food chain.
(e)
The FRAI will notify standards of Food based on the recommendation of CFS.
(f)
FRAI will notify a list of registered independent certifying agencies for food quality assurance systems
based on the recommendations of CFS.
(g)
The FRAI will notify a list of accredited laboratories based on the recommendations of CFS.
(h)
The FRAI will encourage adoption of food quality assurance systems such as GHP, GMP and HACCP
by different classes of the food industry.
(b)
The CFS to lay Mandatory Minimum Food Safety Standards and to amend, add, or delete any of the
same as may be required from time to time, based on sound scientific principles and technological
developments and to make recommendations to the FRAI.
27
(i)
(ii)
CFS to lay the Mandatory Minimum Food Safety Standards that are horizontal in nature (i.e.
not prescriptive) to facilitate innovation.
CFS may lay essential compositional standards (vertical standards) for certain selected foods,
in such cases the essential minimal parameters may be laid down.
(c)
Food Additives permitted specifically or included in a category general standard for Food Additives
(GSFA) provided under Codex to be allowed unless specifically considered undesirable on the basis
of sound scientific principles.
(d)
CFS will also be responsible for representing India in all the deliberations in the Codex.
(e)
The CFS will lay down norms for adoption of minimal food quality assurance system by different
segments of the food chain and further lay down the criteria for registration of independent certifying
agencies to certify industries that follow food quality assurance systems such as GHP, GMP &
HACCP, as may be required having regard to the nature of the food article, and recommend names of
such agencies for registration to FRAI.
To define an effective system of Food Safety Administration (FSA) to be run under the overall
supervision of the FRAI, with necessary help from the State Governments (being a subject on the
Concurrent List, field implementation to be through State Governments).
(b)
(c)
Certified Food Unit means a unit certified by any of the registered certifying agencies as being
compliant with the minimal food quality assurance system as specified.
(d)
For certified Food Unit, the independent certifying agency shall follow a standardized procedure of
regular inspections of certified units, regular feedback to the unit, and suggest improvements to
ensure compliance.
(e)
Once the unit is certified the State Food Authority shall grant a license.
(f)
For certified Food Unit the Food Officers may also conduct, in case necessary, administrative
sampling of food, regular feedback to the unit. In the event of repeated defaults in compliance, to
recommend action to the State Food Authority.
(g)
For uncertified units, the State Food Authority to follow a standardized procedure of licensing, regular
inspections of licensed units in the relevant jurisdictions, administrative sampling of food regular
feedback to the unit and suggest improvements to ensure compliance. In the event of repeated
defaults in compliance, to recommend action to the State Food Authority.
(h)
The State Food Authority will monitor compliance of this Act and the regulations made under it in
respect of food available in the market, through Food Officers appointed for designated local areas.
(i)
All samples to be collected as per standardized sampling procedures and the testing of such food
samples will b e conducted as per notified methods and by an accredited food laboratory.
(j)
Pursuant to the testing results, in case a need arises to take action, the food officer (presently Food
Inspector) will submit a report along with the test results to the State Food Authority, with a copy to the
manufacturer or vendor, within 10 days of the receipt of the test report. The State Review Panel
constituted by the State Food Authority will examine the report and, in case action is proposed to be
taken against the manufacturer take the following steps:
1)
2)
3)
4)
Call for a report from the jurisdictional licensing authority regarding the systems and
processes followed by the unit and copies of last two inspection reports. However, in the case
of certified units the said report would be requisitioned from the certifying agency or the
manufacturer/vendor.
Issue a show-cause to the manufacturer.
Afford an opportunity o being heard to the manufacturer.
Consider the action appropriate to the facts and circumstances.
(k)
The State Review Panel will be a body set up by the State Food Authority in accordance with the
norms laid down by FRAI and will consist of 5 members drawn from the State judiciary, Food Industry,
Consumers and eminent Food Technologists. The State Food Authority may set up more han
t
one
State Review Panel in case required.
(l)
To provide appropriate systems to ensure a high level of neutrality, and transparency in the
Accreditation of testing laboratories by NABL (National Accreditation Board of Laboratories of the
28
Department of Science & Technology). A Manual of Standard Testing Practice to be published and
tolerance limits of test procedures to be specified. Testing labs to give analysis and calculation sheet
along with test results.
(m)
To incorporate grading of violations in order to enhance objectivity, strengthen credibility of the system
and avoid harassment & exploitation in the field. Distinction to be laid down between labeling
deficiencies, sub-standard product, and adulteration. This will help in quick disposal of petty violations
with sufficient economic disincentives and caution, while allowing the system to focus on the serious
violations with stronger punishments.
(n)
The State Review Committee set up in each state/UT shall examine the test results and make
recommendation for appropriate compounding, recall or prosecution proceedings, depending upon
the nature & level of nonconformance found in the food sample.
(o)
This Act to lay the procedure regarding acceptance of imported foods on the basis of equivalence.
The procedure should ensure that a non compliant & expired product does not gain entry, and at the
same time allow good quality established products without hindrance.
OBJECTIVES
To provide safe and wholesome food to the consumers and to create an enabling
environment for value addition to primary agricultural produce, to bring innovation
and creativity, and rapid development of food processing industries in an integrated
manner, ensuring a high degree of objectivity and transparency.
FOOD
REGULATORY
AUTHORITY OF INDIA
(FRAI)
COUNCIL OF FOOD
STANDARDS (CFS)
FOOD SAFETY
ADMINISTRATION
(FSA)
To implement safely of
food for the consumer,
taking
food
samples,
getting the same analyzed
by an accredited food
laboratory,
to
pursue
recommendations of the
Review Panels and initiate
compounding, recall or
prosecution proceedings.
29
Introduction
The Export Inspection Council (EIC) was set up by the Government of India under Section 3 of the Export
(Quality Control and Inspection) Act, 1963 (22 of 1963), in order to ensure sound development of export trade
of India through Quality Control and Inspection and for matters connected thereof.
EIC is an advisory body to the Central Government, which is empowered under the Act to:
Notify commodities which will be subject to quality control a nd/ or inspection prior to export,
Establish standards of quality for such notified commodities, and
Specify the type of quality control and / or inspection to be applied to such commodities.
Besides its advisory role, the Export Inspection Council, also exercises technical and administrative control
over the five Export Inspection Agencies (EIAs), one each at Chennai, Delhi, Kochi, Kolkata and Mumbai
established by the Ministry of Commerce, Government of India, under Section 7 of the Act for the purpose of
implementing the various measures and policies formulated by the Export Inspection Council of India.
Export Inspection Council, either directly or through Export Inspection Agencies, its field organisation renders
services in the areas of:
Certification of quality of export commodities through installation of quality assurance systems (In-process
Quality Control and Self-Certification) in the exporting units as well as consignment wise inspection.
Certification of quality of food items for export through installation of Food safety Management System in the
food processing units.
Issue of Certificates of origin to exporters under various preferential tariff schemes for export products.
Organisation Setup
Under the Export Quality Control & Inspection Act, 1963, the Council, which is constituted by the Central
Government, is the apex body, and has powers to constitute specialist committees to assist it in discharge of
its functions. Accordingly, the Council has constituted Administrative Committee to advise it on administrative
matters and a Technical Committee to advise it on technical matters. Besides, it has created some Standing
Committees in specific technical areas as given below :
International Recognition
Under the provisions of WTO Agreements, especially the SPS Agreement, several of India's trading partners
have imposed import control systems based on international standards, particularly in food sector. These
Agreements also provide for recognition of the export certification system of member trading partners
provided it meets the requirements of their import control. EIC, as the official export certification body of India,
has initiated dialogue with several of India's trading partners seeking recognition of its certification.
Presently, EIC's certification is recognised in the following areas:
(1)
(2)
Black Pepper by United States Food & Drug Administration (USFDA) (as per which, any
consignment of black pepper from India, not accompanied by EIA's certificate, is detained on arrival in
USA)
(3)
Fish & Fishery Products by European Commission (as per which, the processing units are
specifically approved for export to European Union and the names of approved units sent to the
European Commission for formal notification, after which they can export to EU countries)
30
(4)
Fish and Fishery Products by Australian Quarantine & Inspection Service (AQIS) Australia's
official import control agency (as per which seafood consignments from India accompanied by
EIC's certificates will undergo only random verification sampling not exceeding 5% of the
consignments and health certificates issued by EIC will be accepted)
Notifications
Cashew Kernels
Notification No. 782 dated 1 st March, 1986
st
Bivalve Molluscs
Notification No. 1054 dated 1st October 2002
31
Dried Fish
Notification 1
Notification 2
Dried Fish maws
th
32
To exercise the powers under section 5 of the Environment (Protection) Act, 1986 for issuing
directions and for taking measures with respect to matters referred to in clauses (v), (vi), (vii), (viii), (ix)
and (xiii) of subsection (2) of Section 3 of the said Act.
II.
To ensure that no shrimp culture pond can be constructed (or) set up within Coastal Regulation Zone
and up to 1 000 m of Chilka lake and Pulicat Lake (including bird sanctuaries namely Yadurapattu and
Nelapattu).
III.
To ensure and give approval to the farmers who are operating traditional and improved traditional
systems of aquaculture for adopting improved technology for increased production.
IV.
To ensure that the agricultural lands, salt pan lands, mangroves, wet lands, forest lands, land for
village common purposes and the land meant for public purposes shall not be used (or) converted for
construction of shrimp culture ponds.
V.
To implement the Precautionary Principle and the Polluter Pays Principle in coastal shrimp
aquaculture activities by adopting the procedure described in the Supreme Court Order dated 11
December 1996 passed in Writ Petition(Civil) No 561 of 1994.
VI.
To regulate and give the necessary approvals/ authorisation for shrimp activities outside Coastal
Regulation Zone areas and 1000 m from the Pulic at lake and Chilkalake.
VII.
To frame scheme/schemes in consultation with expert bodies like National Environmental Engineering
Research Institute, Central Pollution Control Board, respective State Pollution Control Board for
reverting the damages caused to the ecology and environment by pollution in coastal States/ Union
Territories.
VIII.
To ensure the payment of compensation to the workmen employed in the shrimp culture industries as
per the procedure laid down in the Supreme Court Order dated 11 December 1996 passed in Writ
Petition (Civil) No 561 of 1994.
IX.
To comply with the relevant orders issued by the concerned High Courts and Supreme Court from
time to time.
X.
To deal with any other relevant environment issues pertaining to coastal areas with respect to shrimp
culture farming, including those which may be referred to it by the Central Government in the Ministry
of Environment andForests.
33
For discharging the above functions, the Aquaculture Authority has constituted State Level Committees
(SLCs) and District Level Committees (DLCs) under the chairpersonship of Secretary-in-Charge of Fisheries
and the District Collector/ Deputy Commissioner respectively. The composition of the SLCs and DLCs is as
shown in the flow chart.
The applications submitted by the shrimp farmers are received by the DLCs and after scrutiny and verification
of the information and field level inspections, wherever necessary, are forwarded to the SLCs for
consideration. The applications after recommendation of the SLC are forwarded to the Aquaculture Authority
for consideration for issue of approvals.
34
CAC/MISC 1
Page 1 of 2
to preserve the nutritional quality of the food; an intentional reduction in the nutritional
quality of a food would be justified in the circumstances dealt with in sub-paragraph (b) and
also in other circumstances where the food does not constitute a significant item in a normal
diet;
(b)
(c)
to enhance the keeping quality or stability of a food or to improve its organoleptic properties,
provided that this does not so change the nature, substance or quality of the food as to deceive
the consumer;
(d)
6.
Approval or temporary approval for the inclusion of a food additive in a advisory list or in a food
standard should;
(a)
(b)
as far as possible be limited to specific foods for specific purposes and under specific
conditions;
be at the lowest level of use necessary to achieve the desired effect;
The General Principles for the Use of Food Additives were adopted by the Ninth Session of the Codex
Alimentarius Commission as an advisory text (para 295, ALINORM 72/35).
CAC/MISC 1
(c)
Page 2 of 2
as far as possible take into account any Acceptable Daily Intake, or equivalent assessment,
established for the food additive and the probable daily intake of it from all sources. Where
the food additive is to be used in foods eaten by special groups of consumers, account should
be taken of the probable daily intake of the food additive by consumers in those groups.
Page 1
Notwithstanding the provisions of this Section of the General Standard, the lack of reference to a particular additive or to a
particular use of an additive in a food in the General Standard as currently drafted, does not imply that the additive is
unsafe or unsuitable for use in food. The Commission shall review the necessity for maintaining this footnote on a regular
basis, with a view to its deletion once the General Standard is substantially complete.
Consensus Document on the Danish Budget Method, Nordic Working Group on Food Toxicology and Risks Evaluation,
Report No. 4/90.
Codex Alimentarius, Second Edition (Revised 1995), Volume 1A (General Requirements), p. 11.
Page 2
b) Acceptable Daily Intake (ADI) is an estimate by JECFA of the amount of a food additive, expressed
on a body weight basis, that can be ingested daily over a lifetime without appreciable health risk
(standard man = 60 kg).4
c) Acceptable Daily Intake "Not Specified" (NS)5 is a term applicable to a food substance of very low
toxicity which, on the basis of the available data (chemical, biochemical, toxicological, and other), the total
dietary intake of the substance arising from its use at the levels necessary to achieve the desired effect
and from its acceptable background in food does not, in the opinion of JECFA, represent a hazard to
health. For that reason, and for reasons stated in individual JECFA evaluations, establishment of an
acceptable daily intake expressed in numerical form is not deemed necessary by JECFA. An additive
meeting this criterion must be used within the bounds of good manufacturing practice as defined in subparagraph 3.3 below.
3. GENERAL PRINCIPLES FOR THE USE OF FOOD ADDITIVES
3.1
a) Only those food additives shall be endorsed and included in this Standard which, so far as can be
judged on the evidence presently available from JECFA, present no risk to the health of the
consumer at the levels of use proposed.
b) The inclusion of a food additive in this Standard shall have taken into account any Acceptable
Daily Intake, or equivalent assessment, established for the additive and its probable daily intake 7
from all sources. Where the food additive is to be used in foods eaten by special groups of
consumers, account shall be taken of the probable daily intake of the food additive by consumers
in those groups.
3.2
The use of food additives is justified only when such use has an advantage, does not present a hazard
to health of and does not mislead the consumer, and serves one or more of the technological functions set out
by Codex and needs set out from (a) through (d) below, and only where these objectives cannot be achieved
by other means which are economically and technologically practicable:
a) to preserve the nutritional quality of the food; an intentional reduction in the nutritional quality of
a food would be justified in the circumstances dealt with in sub-paragraph (b) and also in other
circumstances where the food does not constitute a significant item in a normal diet;
Principles for the Safety Assessment of Food Additives and Contaminants in Food, World Health Organization, (WHO
Environmental Health Criteria, No. 70), P. 111 (1987).
For purposes of this Standard, the phrase acceptable daily intake (ADI) not limited (NL) has the same meaning as ADI
not specified. The phrase acceptable ADI refers to an ADI which is more appropriately limited by the level of
treatment of the food, rather than on a mg additive per kg body weight per day basis (see, Summary of Evaluations
Performed by the Joint FAO/WHO Expert Committee on Food Additives (JECFA), FAO/WHO, ILSI Press, 1994, Part 1,
p.3).
General Principles for the Use of Food Additives were originally adopted by the Ninth Session of the Codex Alimentarius
as a Codex Advisory Text (para. 295, ALINORM 72/35) and were reprinted in the Second Edition of the Codex
Alimentarius, Vol. 1A, (General Requirements) pp. 45-47 (Revised 1995). Pertinent portions of the Text have now been
incorporated as an integral part of this Standard, suitable modifications having been made as necessary with respect to the
present context.
"Guidelines for Simple Evaluation of Food Additive Intake", CAC/VOL. XIV Ed. 1, Supplement 2 (1989), gives
procedures for calculating the theoretical maximum daily intake (TMDI) and the estimated daily intake (EDI) of food
additives; other appropriate procedures may be used to calculate the TMDI and EDI.
Page 3
For additional information, see Codex Alimentarius Commission Procedural Manual, Tenth Edition (1997), p. 78.
Food additive specifications endorsed by the Codex Alimentarius Commission are included in the JECFA "Compendium of
Food Additive Specifications", Volumes 1 and 2 (1992), and in addenda thereto, published by FAO.
10
The principle relating to the carry-over of food additives into foods (the "Carry-Over Principle") addresses the presence of
additives in food as a result of the use of raw materials or other ingredients in which these additives are used. The Codex
Alimentarius Commission at its 17th Session (1987) adopted a revised statement of the principle as a Codex Advisory
Text. The Text is printed in its entirety in Codex Alimentarius, Second Edition, Vol. 1A (General Requirements), pp. 9495, 1992. The Carry-Over Principle applies to all foods covered by Codex Standards, unless otherwise specified in such
standards.
Page 4
b) the amount of the additive in the raw materials or other ingredients (including food additives)
does not exceed the maximum amount so permitted.
c) the food into which the additive is carried over does not contain the food additive in greater
quantity than would be introduced by the use of the ingredients under proper technological
conditions or manufacturing practice.
4.2 INGREDIENTS AND RAW M ATERIALS AS CARRIERS FOR ADDITIVES 11
An additive is permitted in a raw material or other ingredient if the raw material or ingredient is used
exclusively in the preparation of a food which is in conformity with the provisions of the standard.
5. FOOD CATEGORY SYSTEM 12
The food category system is a tool for the allocation of food additive uses authorized by this
Standard. The food category system applies to all foodstuffs including those in which no additives are
permitted.
The food descriptors are not to be legal product designations nor are they intended for labelling
purposes.
The food category system is based on the following principles:
a) The food category system is hierarchical, meaning that when the use of an additive is permitted
in a general category, it is automatically permitted in all its sub-categories, unless otherwise
stated. Similarly, when an additive is permitted in a sub-category, its use is also allowed in any
further sub-categories and in descriptors or individual foodstuffs mentioned in a sub-category.
b) The food category system is based on product descriptors of foodstuffs as marketed, unless
otherwise stated.
c) The food category system takes into consideration the carry-over principle. By doing so, the
food category system does not need to specifically mention compound foodstuffs, e.g., prepared
meals, because they may contain, pro rata, all the additives allowed in their components, except
when the compound foodstuff needs and additive which is not authorized in its components.
d) The food category system is used to simplify the reporting of food additive uses for assembling
and constructing this Standard.
6. FORMAT OF THE STANDARD
The food additives listed herein have been grouped into the 23 major functional classes of the Codex
International Numbering System (INS) for Food Additives.13
11
12
Each Codex Commodity Standard has been initially assigned to one of the food categories or sub-categories of the food
category based on the system developed by the Confdration des Industries Agro-Alimentaires de la CEE (CIAA). It is
expected that the food category system for the Standard (CL 1996/14-FAC) will form the basis of a new food classification
scheme that will be eventually proposed for adoption by the CAC. Codex Standard Numbers (CXSNs), together with the
corresponding names of the Codex Commodity Standards and the food categories and sub-categories to which the CXSNs
have been classified, are listed in ANNEX B.
13
Although the General Standard as currently drafted covers only antioxidants and preservatives, the complete Standard will
eventually cover the uses of food additives in all 23 INS functional classes; see Codex Alimentarius Vol. 1A, Second
Edition (Revised 1995), Section 5.2, pp. 57-92.
Page 5
Table 1 of this Standard specifies, for each food additive or food additive group (in alphabetical
order), the foods in which the additive is acceptable for use, together with the acceptable maximum use
levels. Table 1 also includes the uses of those additives with non-numerical ADIs for which a maximum use
level is specified.
Table 2 of this Standard contains the same information as Table 1, but the information is arranged by
food category number.
Table 3 of this Standard lists additives with non-numerical JECFA ADIs that are acceptable for use
in foods in general when used at quantum satis levels and in accordance with the principles of good
manufacturing practice described in Section 3.3 of this preamble. The Annex to Table 3 lists food categories
and individual food items excluded from the general conditions of Table 3. The provisions in Table 1 and 2
govern the use of additives in the food categories listed in the Annex to Table 3.
Table 1, 2 and 3 do not include reference to the uses of substances as processing aids.
Unless otherwise specified, maximum levels for food additives are set on the final product as
consumed.
7. REVIEW AND REVISION OF THE STANDARD
7.1 REVIEW OF THE STANDARD
The food additive provisions for this Standard shall be reviewed on a regular basis and revised as
necessary in light of revisions of Acceptable Daily Intakes by JECFA or of changing technological need and
justification for use.
7.2 REVISION OF THE STANDARD
The food additive provisions of this Standard shall be amended as necessary. Proposed revisions of
this Standard may be initiated by recommendations by Codex Committees, Codex member States, or the
Codex Commission. Information to support amendment of the Standard shall be provided by the proposing
body. Supporting information that shall be provided to the Codex Committee on Food Additives and
Contaminants may include, as appropriate:
Intended food category or sub-category, and use level for the food additive;
The Codex Committee for Food Additives and Contaminants shall consider all proposed amendments
to this Standard.
Page 6
Guideline 1
The levels and quantities of food additives used in the Budget Method calculations should be
expressed on the same basis as the substances on which the ADI was allocated (e.g., an acid or its salts).
For foods sold as concentrates or powders intended for reconstitution before consumption, the Budget
calculation on the food additive use levels should be performed on the ready-to-eat product.
II
Guideline 2
FOOD ADDITIVES WITH AN ADI OF NOT SPECIFIED
When an additive has been allocated an ADI "not specified"1 it could in principle, be allowed for
use in foods in general with no limitation other than in accordance with Good Manufacturing Practices
(GMP). It should, however, be born in mind that ADI not specified does not mean that unlimited intake is
acceptable. The term is used by JECFA in case where "on the basis of the available data (chemical,
biochemical, toxicological, and other) the total daily intake of the substance arising from its use at the levels
necessary to achieve the desired effect and from its acceptable background in food does not, in the opinion
of the Committee, represent a hazard to health"1
If, therefore, a substance is used in larger amounts and/or in a wider range of foods than originally
envisaged by JECFA it may be necessary to consult JECFA to ensure that the new uses fall within the
evaluation. For example a substance may have been evaluated as a humectant without including a later use
as a bulk sweetener, which could give considerable higher intake.
Guideline 3
FOOD ADDITIVES EVALUATED AS ACCEPTABLE FOR C ERTAIN P URPOSES
In some cases, JECFA has been unable to allocate an ADI but nevertheless found a specific use of a
substance acceptable. In such cases, the additive in question should only be authorized in accordance with
the conditions specified. In case of any other reported uses CCFAC should request JECFA to re-evaluate
the additive in question in light of the new information on uses.
Principles for the Safety Assessment of Food Additives and Contaminants in Food. Geneva, World Health Organization, 1987
(Environmental Health Criteria, No. 70), p.83.
III
Page 7
Guideline 4
FRACTIONS OF THE ADI TO BE USED FOR SOLID FOOD AND B EVERAGES , RESPECTIVELY
If an additive is proposed for use in both solid food and in beverages the full ADI cannot be used for
both for uses in solid food and uses in beverages. It is therefore necessary to allocate a fraction of the ADI
to each of the applications. As a first approach, it may be appropriate to assume that one-half of the ADI is
allocated to each solid and liquid foods. However, in special cases other fractions may be more appropriate
as long as the sum of the fractions does not exceed the figure for the ADI (e.g. FS=1/4 and FB=3/4 ; FS=1/6
and FB=5/6), where FS is the fraction for use in solid food and FB is the fraction for use in beverages). If
the additive is used only in solid food, then FS =1 and FB=0 and if the additive is used only in beverages,
then FS=0 and FB=1.
III(a) FOOD ADDITIVE USES IN SOLID FOOD (FS)
Guideline 5
USE LEVELS B ELOW FS X ADI
X 40
If the proposed use levels are below FS x ADI x 40, these food additive provisions could be suitable
in food in general.
Guideline 6
USE LEVELS B ELOW FS X ADI
X 80
If the proposed use levels are below FS x ADI x 80 they are acceptable provided the daily
consumption of the foods containing the additive will usually not exceed half of the assumed maximum
total solid food intake (i.e., 12.5 g/kg bw/day).
Guideline 7
USE LEVELS B ELOW FS X ADI
X 160
If the proposed use levels are below FS x ADI x 160 they are acceptable provided the daily
consumption of the foods containing the additive will usually not exceed one fourth of the assumed
maximum total solid food intake (i.e., 6.25 g/kg bw/day).
Guideline 8
USE LEVELS B ELOW FS X ADI
X 320
If the proposed use levels are below FS x ADI x 320 they could be accepted provided the daily
consumption of the foods containing the additive will usually not exceed one eighth of the assumed
maximum total food intake (i.e., 3.13 g/kg bw/day).
Page 8
Guideline 9
USE LEVELS ABOVE FS
X ADI X 320
If the proposed levels are higher than FS x ADI x 320 they should only be accepted for products
where calculation of potential intake from all proposed uses will show that exceeding the ADI is unlikely,
or if estimation of the intake of the additive based on more exact intake estimates methods show that the use
levels are acceptable (e.g., food consumption surveys)
III(b) FOOD ADDITIVE USES IN BEVERAGES (FL)
Guideline 10
USE LEVELS B ELOW FL X ADI
X 10
If the proposed levels are below FL x ADI x 10, the additive could be accepted for use in all
beverages in general.
Guideline 11
USE LEVELS B ELOW FL X ADI
X 20
If the proposed use levels are below FL x ADI x 20 they could be accepted provided the daily
consumption of beverages containing the additive will usually not exceed half of the assumed maximum
total intake of beverage (i.e., 50 ml/kg bw/day).
Guideline 12
USE LEVELS B ELOW FS X ADI
X 40
If the proposed use levels are below FL x ADI x 40 they could be accepted provided the daily
consumption of beverages containing the additive will usually not exceed a fourth of the assumed maximum
total intake of beverage (i.e., 25 ml/kg bw/day).
Guideline 13
USE LEVELS B ELOW FL X ADI
X 80
If the proposed use levels are below FL x ADI x 80 they could be accepted provided the daily
consumption of beverages containing the additive will usually not exceed an eighth of the assumed
maximum total intake of beverage (i.e., 12.5 ml/kg bw/day).
Guideline 14
USE LEVELS ABOVE FL
X ADI X 80
Levels above FL x ADI x 80 should only be accepted for products where calculation of potential
intake will show that exceeding the ADI is unlikely (e.g., strong alcoholic beverages).
Page 9
Page 10
Page 11
05.0 Confectionery
05.1 Cocoa products and chocolate products including imitations and chocolate substitutes
05.1.1 Cocoa mixes (powders) and cocoa mass/cake
05.1.2 Cocoa mixes (syrups)
05.1.3 Cocoa-based spreads, incl. fillings
05.1.4 Cocoa and chocolate products
05.1.5 Imitation chocolate, chocolate substitute products
05.2 Confectionery including hard and soft candy, nougats, etc. other than food categories 05.1,
05.3, and 05.4
05.3 Chewing gum
05.4 Decorations (e.g., for fine bakery wares), toppings (non-fruit) and sweet sauces
06.0 Cereals and cereal products, including flours and starches from roots and tubers, pulses and
legumes, excluding bakery wares of food category 07.0
06.1 Whole, broken, or flaked grain, including rice
06.2 Flours and starches
06.3 Breakfast cereals, including rolled oats
06.4 Pastas and noodles and like products (e.g. rice paper, rice vermicelli)
06.4.1 Fresh pastas and noodles and like products
06.4.2 Pre-cooked or dried pastas and noodles and like products
06.5 Cereal and starch based desserts (e.g., rice pudding, tapioca pudding)
06.6 Batters (e.g., for breading or batters for fish or poultry)
06.7 Rice cakes (Oriental type only)
06.8 Soybean products
07.0 Bakery wares
07.1 Bread and ordinary bakery wares
07.1.1 Breads and rolls
07.1.2 Crackers, excluding sweet crackers
07.1.3 Other ordinary bakery products (e.g., bagels, pita, English muffins)
07.1.4 Bread-type products, including bread stuffing and bread crumbs
07.1.5 Steamed breads and buns
07.2 Fine bakery wares (sweet, salty, savoury)
07.2.1 Cakes, cookies and pies (e.g., fruit-filled or custard types)
07.2.2 Other fine bakery products (e.g., doughnuts, sweet rolls, scones, and muffins)
07.2.3 Mixes for fine bakery wares (e.g., cakes, pancakes)
08.0 Meat and meat products, including poultry and game
08.1 Fresh meat, poultry and game
08.1.1 Fresh meat, poultry and game, whole pieces or cuts
08.1.2 Fresh meat, poultry and game, comminuted
08.2 Processed meat, poultry, and game products in whole pieces or cuts
08.2.1 Non-heat treated processed meat, poultry, and game products in whole pieces or cuts
08.2.1.1 Cured (including salted) non-heat treated processed meat, poultry, and game
products in whole pieces or cuts
08.2.1.2 Cured (including salted) and dried non-heat treated processed meat, poultry, and
game products in whole pieces or cuts
Page 12
08.2.1.3 Fermented non-heat treated processed meat, poultry, and game products in whole
pieces or cuts
08.2.2 Heat-treated processed meat, poultry, and game products in whole pieces or cuts
08.2.3 Frozen processed meat, poultry, and game products in whole pieces or cuts
08.3 Processed comminuted meat, poultry, and game products
08.3.1 Non-heat treated processed comminuted meat, poultry, and game products
08.3.1.1 Cured (including salted) non-heat treated processed comminuted meat, poultry,
and game products
08.3.1.2 Cured (including salted) and dried non-heat treated processed comminuted meat,
poultry, and game products
08.3.1.3 Fermented non-heat treated processed comminuted meat, poultry, and game
products
08.3.2 Heat-treated processed comminuted meat, poultry, and game products
08.3.3 Frozen processed comminuted meat, poultry, and game products
08.4 Edible casings (e.g., sausage casings)
09.0 Fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms
09.1 Fresh fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms
09.1.1 Fresh fish
09.1.2 Fresh mollusks, crustaceans and echinoderms
09.2 Processed fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms
09.2.1 Frozen fish, fish fillets, and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and
echinoderms
09.2.2 Frozen battered fish, fish fillets and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and
echinoderms
09.2.3 Frozen minced and creamed fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and
echinoderms
09.2.4 Cooked and/or fried fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and
echinoderms
09.2.4.1 Cooked fish and fish products
09.2.4.2 Cooked mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms
09.2.4.3 Fried fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms
09.2.5 Smoked, dried, fermented, and/or salted fish and fish products, including
mollusks,crustaceans, and echinoderms
09.3 Semi-preserved fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms
09.3.1 Fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms, marinated
and/or in jelly
09.3.2 Fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms, pickled
and/or in brine
09.3.3 Salmon substitutes, caviar, and other fish roe products
09.3.4 Semi-preserved fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans, and
echinoderms (e.g., fish paste), excluding products of food categories 09.3.1 - 09.3.3
09.4 Fully preserved, including canned or fermented fish and fish products, including mollusks,
crustaceans, and echinoderms
10.0 Eggs and egg products
10.1 Fresh eggs
10.2 Egg products
Page 13
Page 14
13.3.1 Dietetic foods for special medical purposes intended for adults
13.3.2 Dietetic foods for special medical purposes intended for infants and young children
13.4 Dietetic formulae for slimming purposes and weight reduction
13.5 Dietetic foods (e.g., supplementary foods for dietary use) excluding products of food
categories 13.1- 13.4
13.6 Food supplements
14.0 Beverages, excluding dairy products
14.1 Non-alcoholic ("soft") beverages
14.1.1 Waters
14.1.1.1 Natural mineral waters and source waters
14.1.1.2 Table waters and soda waters
14.1.2 Fruit and vegetable juices
14.1.2.1 Canned or bottled (pasteurized) fruit juice
14.1.2.2 Canned or bottled (pasteurized) vegetable juice
14.1.2.3 Concentrates (liquid or solid) for fruit juice
14.1.2.4 Concentrates (liquid or solid) for vegetable juice
14.1.3 Fruit and vegetable nectars
14.1.3.1 Canned or bottled (pasteurized) fruit nectar
14.1.3.2 Canned or bottled (pasteurized) vegetable nectar
14.1.3.3 Concentrates (liquid or solid) for fruit nectar
14.1.3.4 Concentrates (liquid or solid) for vegetable nectar
14.1.4 Water-based flavoured drinks, including "sport" or "electrolyte" drinks and particulated
drinks
14.1.4.1 Carbonated drinks
14.1.4.2 Non-carbonated drinks, including punches and ades
14.1.4.3 Concentrates (liquid or solid) for drinks
14.1.5 Coffee, coffee substitutes, tea, herbal infusions, and other hot cereal and grain
beverages, excluding cocoa
14.2 Alcoholic beverages, including alcohol-free and low-alcoholic counterparts
14.2.1 Beer and malt beverages
14.2.2 Cider and perry
14.2.3 Grape wines
14.2.3.1 Still wine
14.2.3.2 Sparkling and semi-sparkling wines
14.2.3.3 Fortified wine and liquor wine
14.2.4 Wines (other than grape)
14.2.5 Mead
14.2.6 Spirituous beverages containing more than 15% alcohol
14.2.7 Aromatized alcoholic beverages (e.g., beer, wine and spirituous cooler-type beverages,
low-alcoholic refreshers)
15.0 Ready-to-eat savouries
15.1 Snacks - potato, cereal, flour or starch based (from roots and tubers, pulses and legumes)
15.2 Processed nuts, including coated nuts and nut mixtures (with e.g., dried fruit)
15.3 Snacks - fish based
16.0 Composite foods - foods that could not be placed in categories 01 - 15.
Page 15
Cross-Reference of Codex Standardized Foods with the Food Categorization System used for the
Elaboration of the GSFA Sort by Codex Standard No. 1
Codex Standard
No.
003-1995 Rev.1
012-2001 Rev.2
013-1981
014-1981
015-1981
016-1981
017-2001 Rev. 1
018-1981
019-1999
032-1989 Rev.
033-1989 Rev.
036-1995 Rev.
037-1995 Rev.
038-1981
038-1981
038-1981
1
1
1
1
038-1981
038-1981
038-1981
038-1981
038-1981
039-1981
040-1981
041-1981
042-1987 Rev. 1
044-1981
045-1981
046-1981
047-1981
048-1981
049-1981
052-1981
053-1981
053-1981
055-1981
056-1981
057-1981
1
Uses FCS revised as of the 33rd CCFAC and Codex standardized Foods adopted as of the 24th CAC.
Food
Category No.
09.4
11.5
04.2.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.2.2.4
02.1
02.2.1.2
02.1.2
09.2.1
09.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.7
04.2.2.2
04.2.2.6
04.2.1.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2
04.2.2.3
04.2.2.2
04.2.1.1
04.2.2.1
04.1.2.4
14.1.3.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.2
04.1.2.1
13.0
12.2
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.6
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
103-1981
104-1981
105-2001 Rev. 1
108-1997 Rev. 1
(Amended 2001)
110-1981
111-1981
112-1981
Page 16
Codex Standard Title
Food
Category No.
04.2.2.5
04.2.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
04.2.2.3
04.1.2.2
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.1
09.4
13.1.1
13.2
13.2
04.1.2.1
04.1.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.5
04.1.2.5
04.2.2.4
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.1
05.1.3
05.1.4
08.3.2
08.3.2
09.4
09.2.1
09.4
09.2.1
08.2.2
08.2.2
08.3.2
04.1.2.4
14.1.3.1
04.1.2.1
04.2.2.1
05.1.1
14.1.1.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
Page 17
Codex Standard Title
Food
Category No.
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.3
04.2.2.4
12.5
09.4
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.3
14.1.3.1
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.2
04.2.1.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
14.1.3.1
02.2.2
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
04.2.2.1
05.1.1
05.1.4
04.1.1.2
04.1.1.1
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
05.1.4
14.1.3.1
14.1.3.1
12.1
Gari
Wheat Flour
Maize (Corn)
Whole Maize (Corn) Meal
Degermed Maize (Corn) Meal and Maize (Corn) Grits
Follow-Up Formula
Canned Mangoes
Mango Chutney
Fruit Nectars (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Wheat Gluten Products, Including Wheat Gluten
04.2.2.7
06.2
06.1
06.2
06.2
13.1.2
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.6
14.1.3.1
12.9
12.9
14.1.2.1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
204-1997
205-1997
207-1999
208-1999
(Amended 2001)
210-1999
(Amended 2001)
211-1999
212-2001 Rev. 1
212-2001 Rev. 1
212-2001 Rev. 1
Page 18
Codex Standard Title
Quick Frozen Blocks of Fish Fillets, Minced Fish Flesh and Mixtures
of Fillets and Minced Fish Flesh
Quick Frozen Fish Sticks (Fish Fingers), Fish Portions and Fish Fillets
Breaded and in Batter
Salted Fish and Dried Salted Fish of the Gadidae Family of Fishes
Mayonnaise
Whole and Decorticated Pearl Millet Grains
Pearl Millet Flour
Certain Pulses
Sorghum Grains
Sorghum Flour
Vegetable Protein Products
Soy Protein Products
Edible Cassava Flour
Grated Desiccated Coconut
Durum Wheat Semolina and Durum Wheat Flour
Vegetable Juices (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Formula Foods for Use in Weight Control Diets
Pineapple
Papaya
Mango
Nopal
Prickly Pear
Carambola
Baby Corn
Dried Shark Fins
Quick Frozen Fish Fillets
Quick Frozen Raw Squid
Litchi
Avocado
Rice
Wheat and Durum Wheat
Peanuts
Oats
Couscous
Formula Foods for Use in Very Low Energy Diets for Weight
Reduction
Mangosteens
Bananas
Milk Powders and Cream Powders
Cheeses in Brine
Food
Category No.
09.2.1
09.2.2
09.2.5
12.6.1
06.1
06.2
04.2.1.1
06.1
06.2
12.9
12.9
06.2
04.1.2.2
06.2
14.1.2.2
13.4
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.2.1.1
09.2.5
09.2.1
09.1.2
04.1.1.1
04.2.1.1
06.1
06.1
04.2.1.1
06.1
06.1
13.4
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
01.5.1
01.6.2.1
02.1.2
02.1.3
11.1.1
11.1.2
11.1.3
Page 19
Codex Standard Title
Food
Category No.
11.1.5
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
01.6.1
09.2.5
04.2.2.7
05.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.1.1.1
14.1.1.2
01.6.4.1
01.6.4.1
01.6.4.1
01.4
01.4.1
01.4.2
01.2.1.1
01.7
01.8
12.9
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
Page 20
Cross-Reference of Codex Standardized Foods with the Food Categorization System used for the
Elaboration of the GSFA Sort by Codex Standard Title
Codex Standard
No.
048-1981
044-1981
225-2001
197-1995
188-1993
205-1997
120-1981
227-2001
117-2001 Rev. 2
C-34-1973
C-33-1973
017-2001 Rev. 1
129-1981
056-1981
073-1981
116-1981
145-1985
088-1991 Rev. 1
090-1995 Rev. 1
119-1995 Rev. 1
078-1981
015-1981
016-1981
058-1981
068-1981
159-1987
081-1981
055-1981
144-1985
014-1981
061-2001 Rev. 1
042-1987 Rev. 1
059-1981
060-1981
003-1995 Rev.1
094-1995 Rev. 1
037-1995 Rev. 1
062-1981
018-1981
013-1981
099-1981
070-1995 Rev. 1
226-2001
187-1993
171-1995 Rev. 1
216-1999
Food
Category No.
14.1.2.1
14.1.3.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.1.1.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.1.2
12.5
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.2.2.4
13.2
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
08.3.2
09.4
09.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
09.4
09.4
09.4
04.1.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.1.2.4
09.4
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.1.1.1
Page 21
Codex Standard Title
Cheddar Cheese
Cheeses in Brine
Chocolate
Citrus Marmelade
Cocoa (Cacao) Mass (Cocoa/Chocolate Liquor) and Cocoa Cake
Cocoa Butter Confectionery
Cocoa Butters
Cocoa Powders (Cocoa) and Dry Mixtures of Cocoa and Sugar
Composite and Filled Chocolate
Concentrated Apple Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Concentrated Blackcurrant Juice (preserved exclusively by physical
means)
Concentrated Grape Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Concentrated Orange Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Concentrated Pineapple Juice (preserved exclusively by physical
means)
Concentrated Pineapple Juice with Preservatives for Manufacturing
Cooked Cured Chopped Meat
Cooked Cured Ham
Cooked Cured Pork Shoulder
Cottage Cheese, including Creamed Cottage Cheese
Coulommiers Cheese
Couscous
Crackers from Marine and Freshwater Fish, Crustaceans and
Molluscan Shellfish
Cream Cheese (Rahmfrischkase)
Cream for Direct Consumption
Cream for Direct Consumption (pasteurized, half, double)
Cream for Direct Consumption (whipping, sterilized, UHT or ultrapasteurized)
Danbo Cheese
Dates (coated)
Dates (fresh)
Degermed Maize (Corn) Meal and Maize (Corn) Grits
Dried Apricots
Dried Edible Fungi
Dried Shark Fins
Durum Wheat Semolina and Durum Wheat Flour
Edam Cheese
Edible Casein Products
Edible Cassava Flour
Edible Fungi and Fungi Products (concentrate, dried concentrate or
extract)
Edible Fungi and Fungi Products (edible fungi)
Edible Fungi and Fungi Products (fermented)
Edible Fungi and Fungi Products (fungus products)
Edible Fungi and Fungi Products (incl. freeze dried, fungus grits and
fungus powder)
Edible Fungi and Fungi Products (quick frozen)
Food
Category No.
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
05.1.4
04.1.2.5
05.1.1
05.1.4
05.1.3
05.1.1
05.1.4
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
08.3.2
08.2.2
08.2.2
01.6.1
01.6.2.1
06.1
09.2.5
01.6.1
01.4
01.4.1
01.4.2
01.6.2.1
04.1.1.2
04.1.1.1
06.2
04.1.2.2
04.2.2.2
09.2.5
06.2
01.6.2.1
12.9
06.2
04.2.2.6
04.2.1.1
04.2.2.7
04.2.2
04.2.2.2
04.2.2.1
1
1
Page 22
Codex Standard Title
Food
Category No.
04.2.2.3
04.2.2.4
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.7
13.1.2
12.1
12.2
13.0
13.4
13.4
04.2.1.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.3.1
04.2.2.7
02.1
04.2.1.1
01.6.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.2.2
14.1.3.1
04.1.1.1
01.6.2.1
11.5
13.1.1
04.1.2.5
04.2.2.7
14.1.2.1
04.1.1.1
14.1.3.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
08.3.2
06.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.2.6
04.1.1.1
02.2.1.2
12.6.1
04.1.1.1
01.5.1
02.2.2
Page 23
Codex Standard Title
Food
Category No.
02.1.3
01.6.4.1
02.1.2
14.1.1.1
14.1.3.1
14.1.3.1
04.2.1.1
06.1
02.1.2
14.1.2.1
04.1.1.1
04.2.1.1
06.2
04.2.2.3
04.1.1.1
14.1.2.1
04.2.1.1
01.6.4.1
01.6.4.1
13.2
04.2.2.6
04.2.2.5
01.6.2.1
14.1.3.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.2.1
09.2.1
04.1.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
09.2.1
09.2.2
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
09.2.1
04.1.2.1
04.2.2.1
Page 24
Codex Standard Title
Food
Category No.
04.1.2.1
09.1.2
09.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.1.2.1
04.2.2.1
09.2.1
04.1.2.2
06.1
01.6.2.1
09.2.5
01.6.2.1
06.2
06.1
12.9
11.1.3
11.1.5
11.1.2
11.1.1
14.1.2.3
04.2.2.3
05.2.1.1
01.6.2.1
14.1.2.2
01.6.1
04.2.1.1
14.1.2.2
12.9
06.1
06.2
12.9
12.9
Whey Powders
Whole and Decorticated Pearl Millet Grains
Whole Maize (Corn) Meal
Yoghurt and Sweetened Yoghurt
01.8
06.1
06.2
01.2.1.1
Page 25
Cross-Reference of Codex Standardized Foods with the Food Categorization System used for the
Elaboration of the GSFA Sort by Food Category No.
Codex Standard
No.
A-11a-1975
A-09-1976
A-09-1976
A-09-1976
207-1999
221-2001
C-16-1968
C-31-1973
208-1999
(Amended 2001)
C-01-1966
C-03-1966
C-04-1966
C-05-1966
C-06-1966
C-07-1966
C-09-1967
C-11-1968
C-13-1968
C-15-1968
C-18-1969
C-33-1973
C-34-1973
C-35-1978
A-08a-1978
A-08b-1978
A-08c-1978
A-11b-1975
A-15-1995
019-1999
033-1989 Rev. 1
210-1999
(Amended 2001)
211-1999
032-1989 Rev. 1
135-1989 Rev. 1
143-1985
182-1999
183-2001 Rev. 1
184-1993
187-1993
196-1995
204-1997
Food
Category No.
01.2.1.1
01.4
01.4.1
01.4.2
01.5.1
01.6.1
01.6.1
01.6.1
01.6.2.1
Cheddar Cheese
Danbo Cheese
Edam Cheese
Gouda Cheese
Havarti Cheese
Samsoe Cheese
Emmentaler Cheese
Tilsiter Cheese
Saint Paulin Cheese
Provolone Cheese
Coulommiers Cheese
Camembert Cheese
Brie Cheese
Extra Hard Grating Cheese
Named Variety Process(ed) Cheese and Spreadable Process(ed)
Cheese
Process(ed) Cheese and Spreadable Process(ed) Cheese
Process(ed) Cheese Preparations (Process(ed) Cheese Food and
Process(ed) Cheese Spread)
Flavoured Yoghurt and Products Heat-Treated after Fermentation
Whey Powders
General Standard for Edible Fats and Oils Not Covered by Individual
Standards
Olive Oil
Named Vegetable Oils
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.2.1
01.6.4.1
02.1.3
02.2.1.2
02.2.2
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
01.6.4.1
01.6.4.1
01.7
01.8
02.1
02.1.2
02.1.2
Page 26
Codex Standard Title
Bananas
Limes
Pumelos (citrus grandi)
Guavas
Chayotes
Mexican Limes
Grapefruits (citrus paradisi)
Longans
Cape Gooseberry
Dates (coated)
Quick Frozen Strawberries
Quick Frozen Raspberries
Quick Frozen Peaches
Quick Frozen Bilberries
Quick Frozen Blueberries
Raisins
Dried Apricots
Grated Desiccated Coconut
Canned Peaches
Canned Grapefruit
Canned Applesauce
Canned Pineapple
Canned Plums
Canned Raspberries
Canned Pears
Canned Strawberries
Canned Mandarin Oranges
Canned Fruit Cocktail
Canned Tropical Fruit Salad
Canned Apricots
Canned Mangoes
Jam (Fruit Preserves) and Jellies
Citrus Marmelade
Mango Chutney
Edible Fungi and Fungi Products (edible fungi)
Fresh Fungus Chanterelle
Unshelled Pistachio Nuts
Certain Pulses
Nopal
Prickly Pear
Baby Corn
Avocado
Peanuts
Ginger
Asparagus
Edible Fungi and Fungi Products (fungus products)
Edible Fungi and Fungi Products (quick frozen)
Quick Frozen Peas
Quick Frozen Spinach
Quick Frozen Leek
Food
Category No.
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.1
04.1.1.2
04.1.2.1
04.1.2.1
04.1.2.1
04.1.2.1
04.1.2.1
04.1.2.2
04.1.2.2
04.1.2.2
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.5
04.1.2.5
04.1.2.6
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.1.1
04.2.2
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
Page 27
Codex Standard Title
Food
Category No.
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.2
04.2.2.2
04.2.2.3
04.2.2.3
04.2.2.3
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.5
04.2.2.6
04.2.2.6
04.2.2.7
04.2.2.7
04.2.2.7
05.1.1
05.1.1
05.1.3
05.1.4
05.1.4
05.1.4
05.2.1.1
06.1
06.1
06.1
06.1
06.1
06.1
06.1
06.2
06.2
06.2
06.2
Page 28
Codex Standard Title
Sorghum Flour
Edible Cassava Flour
Durum Wheat Semolina and Durum Wheat Flour
Cooked Cured Ham
Cooked Cured Pork Shoulder
Canned Corned Beef
Luncheon Meat
Cooked Cured Chopped Meat
Quick Frozen Raw Squid
Quick-Frozen Finfish, Uneviscerated and Eviscerated
Quick Frozen Shrimps or Prawns
Quick Frozen Lobsters
Quick Frozen Blocks of Fish Fillets, Minced Fish Flesh and Mixtures
of Fillets and Minced Fish Flesh
Quick Frozen Fish Fillets
Quick Frozen Fish Sticks (Fish Fingers), Fish Portions and Fish Fillets
Breaded and in Batter
Salted Fish and Dried Salted Fish of the Gadidae Family of Fishes
Dried Shark Fins
Crackers from Marine and Freshwater Fish, Crustaceans and
Molluscan Shellfish
Canned Salmon
Canned Shrimps or Prawns
Canned Tuna and Bonito
Canned Crab Meat
Canned Sardines and Sardine-Type Products
Canned Finfish
Sugars (white sugar, dextrose anhydrous, dextrose monohydrate,
fructose)
Sugars (powdered sugar and powdered dextrose)
Sugars (glucose syrup, dried glucose, soft white sugar, brown sugar,
raw cane sugar)
Sugars (plantation or white mill sugar)
Honey
Food Grade Salt
Food
Category No.
06.2
06.2
06.2
08.2.2
08.2.2
08.3.2
08.3.2
08.3.2
09.1.2
09.2.1
09.2.1
09.2.1
09.2.1
09.2.1
09.2.2
09.2.5
09.2.5
09.2.5
09.4
09.4
09.4
09.4
09.4
09.4
11.1.1
11.1.2
11.1.3
11.1.5
11.5
12.1
12.2
12.5
12.6.1
12.9
12.9
12.9
12.9
12.9
13.0
13.1.1
Page 29
Codex Standard Title
Follow-Up Formula
Canned Baby Foods
Processed Cereal-Based Foods for Infants and Children
Formula Foods for Use in Weight Control Diets
Formula Foods for Use in Very Low Energy Diets for Weight
Reduction
Natural Mineral Waters
Bottled/Packaged Drinking Waters (other than natural mineral water)
Orange Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Grapefruit Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Lemon Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Apple Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Grape Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Pineapple Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Blackcurrant Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Fruit Juices (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Tomato Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Vegetable Juices (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Concentrated Apple Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Concentrated Orange Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Concentrated Grape Juice (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Sweetened Concentrated Labrusca Type Grape Juice (preserved
exclusively by physical means)
Concentrated Blackcurrant Juice (preserved exclusively by physical
means)
Concentrated Pineapple Juice (preserved exclusively by physical
means)
Concentrated Pineapple Juice with Preservatives for Manufacturing
Apricot, Peach and Pear Nectar (preserved exclusively by physical
means)
Non-Pulpy Blackcurrant Nectar (preserved exclusively by physical
means)
Pulpy Nectars of Certain Small Fruits (preserved exclusively by
physical means)
Nectars of Certain Citrus Fruits (preserved exclusively by physical
means)
Guava Nectar (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Liquid Pulpy Mango Products (preserved exclusively by physical
means)
Fruit Nectars (preserved exclusively by physical means)
Food
Category No.
13.1.2
13.2
13.2
13.4
13.4
14.1.1.1
14.1.1.2
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.2
14.1.2.2
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.2.3
14.1.3.1
14.1.3.1
14.1.3.1
14.1.3.1
14.1.3.1
14.1.3.1
14.1.3.1
Page 30
Additive
Acacia Gum
Acetic Acid Esters of Mono- and
Diglycerides
Aceto Glycerides
Acetylated Mono- and Diglycerides
Aero-Glucose Dehydrogenase
Agar-Agar
Algaroba
Aluminium Calcium Silicate
Ammonia Caramel
Ammonium Bicarbonate
Ammonium Citrate Tribasic
Ammonium Ferric Citrate
Ammonium Glutamate
Ammonium Iron (III) Citrate
Ammonium Iron Citrate
Ammonium Muriate
Ammonium Myristate
Ammonium Palmitate
Ammonium Stearate
Aqua Ammonia
Arabic Gum
ASCORBYL ESTERS
Azobisformamide
Baking Soda
BCD
Beetroot Red
BENZOATES
Beta-Schardinger Dextrin
Bicarbonate of Soda
Bleached Shellac
Calcium Aluminosilicate
Calcium Disodium (Ethylene-Dinitrilo)Tetraacetate
Calcium Disodium Edetate
INS
JECFA ADI
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
GUM ARABIC
ACETIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
ACETIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
ACETIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
GLUCOSE OXIDASE (Aspergillus niger,
var.)
AGAR
CAROB BEAN GUM
CALCIUM ALUMINUM SILICATE
(SYNTHETIC)
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
AMMONIUM HYDROGEN CARBONATE
TRIAMMONIUM CITRATE
FERRIC AMMONIUM CITRATE
MONOAMMONIUM GLUTAMATE, LFERRIC AMMONIUM CITRATE
FERRIC AMMONIUM CITRATE
AMMONIUM CHLORIDE
SALTS OF MYRISTIC, PALMITIC &
STEARIC ACIDS (NH4, Ca, K, Na)
SALTS OF MYRISTIC, PALMITIC &
STEARIC ACIDS (NH4, Ca, K, Na)
SALTS OF MYRISTIC, PALMITIC &
STEARIC ACIDS (NH4, Ca, K, Na)
AMMONIUM HYDROXIDE
GUM ARABIC
INS
Page 31
JECFA ADI
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
Calcium Disodium Ethylene Diamine
Tetraacetate
CALCIUM GLUCONATE
CALCIUM GLUCONATE
CALCIUM GLUTAMATE, DL-LCALCIUM GUANYLATE, 5'CALCIUM INOSINATE, 5'CALCIUM MALATE
SALTS OF MYRISTIC, PALMITIC &
STEARIC ACIDS (NH4, Ca, K, Na)
SALTS OF OLEIC ACID (Ca
SALTS OF MYRISTIC, PALMITIC &
STEARIC ACIDS (NH4, Ca, K, Na)
CALCIUM RIBONUCLEOTIDES, 5'CALCIUM ALUMINIUM SILICATE
(SYNTHETIC)
SALTS OF MYRISTIC, PALMITIC &
STEARIC ACIDS (NH4, Ca, K, Na)
CARBON DIOXIDE
CAROB BEAN GUM
PROCCESSED EUCHEUMA SEAWEED
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS I
POTASSIUM HYDROXIDE
POTASSIUM HYDROXIDE
ETHYL CELLULOSE
MICROCRYSTALLINE CELLULOSE
SODIUM CARBOXYMETHYL
CELLULOSE
HYDROXYPROPYL CELLULOSE
METHYL CELLULOSE
CALCIUM CARBONATE
CHLORINE DIOXIDE
CHLORINE DIOXIDE
CITRIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
CITRIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
TRIAMMONIUM CITRATE
CITRIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
SODIUM CARBOXYMETHYL
CELLULOSE
INSOLUBLE POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
INSOLUBLE POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
INSOLUBLE POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
GAMMA-CYCLODEXTRIN
GAMMA-CYCLODEXTRIN
CYCLODEXTRIN, BETAMAGNESIUM LACTATE, (DL-)
CALCIUM MALATE
CARRAGEENAN
ERYTHORBIC ACID
GLUCONO DELTA LACTONE
SORBITOL (INCLUDING SORBITOL
SYRUP)
SORBITOL (INCLUDING SORBITOL
INS
Page 32
JECFA ADI
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
SYRUP)
GLUCONO DELTA LACTONE
POTASSIUM GLUCONATE
Diastase
Dimethyl Pyrocarbonate
Dimethylpolysiloxane
Dimethylsilcone Fluid
Dimethylsilcone Oil
Dinitrogen Monoxide
Dipotassium Guanosine-5'Monophosphate
Disodium Dihydrogen (Ethylene-Dinitrilo) Tetraacetate
Disodium Dihydrogen
ethylenediaminetetraacetate
Disodium Edetate
Disodium EDTA
Disodium Inosine-5'-Monophosphate
D-Maltitol
D-Mannitol
D-Mannitol and Hydrogenated
Saccharides
DMDC
Dried Maltitol Syrup
Dry Ice (Solid Form)
D-Sorbitol
EDTAs
Ester Gum
Esters of Glycerol and Thermally Oxidized
Soy Bean Fatty Acids
Ethyl Citrate
Eucheuman (From Eucheuma Spp.)
FERROCYANIDES
FORMATES
Furcellaran (From Furcellaria fastigiata)
gamma-CD
GDL
Gelose
Gluconic Acid Sodium Salt
Gluconolactone
Glucose Aerodehydrogenase
Glucose Oxhydrase
Glutamic Acid
Glycerin
Glyceryl Monooleate
Glyceryl Monoplamitate
Glyceryl Monostearate
Glyceryl Triacetate
Glycogenase
GMS
Guaiac Gum
Guaiacum
Guanosine-5'-Monophosphoric Acid
Guanylic Acid
Guar Flour
Gum Cyamopsis
Gum Guaiac
Gum Karaya
Gum Sterculia
Hexacyanoferrate of Calcium
Hexacyanoferrate of Potassium
Hexacyanoferrate of Sodium
Hexamine
INS
Page 33
JECFA ADI
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
ALPHA-AMYLASE (A. oryzae, var.), or
Alpha-Amylase (B. megaterium expressed
in Bacillus subtilis)
MONO- AND DIGLYCERIDES
GUAIAC RESIN
GUAIAC RESIN
GUANYLIC ACID, 5'
GUANYLIC ACID, 5'
GUAR GUM
GUAR GUM
GUAIAC RESIN
KARAYA GUM
KARAYA GUM
Calcium Ferrocyanide
Potassium Ferrocyanide
Sodium Ferrocyanide
HEXAMETHYLENE TETRAMINE
Insoluble PVP
Iridophycan (From Iridaea Spp.)
Irish Moss Gelose
Iron (II) Lactate
Iron Ammonium Citrate
Iron Gluconate
Isinglass (Bengal, Ceylon, Chinese, or
Japanese)
Isoascorbic Acid
Isomaltitol
Japan Agar
Kadaya
Kaolin, Light or Heavy
Karaya
Katilo
Konjac
Konjac Mannen
Konnyaleu
Kullo
Kutterra
Lactic Acid Esters of Mono- and
Diglycerides
Lactit
Lactobiosit
INSOLUBLE POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
CARRAGEENAN
CARRAGEENAN
FERROUS LACTATE
FERRIC AMMONIUM CITRATE
FERROUS GLUCONATE
Lactoglycerides
AGAR
ERYTHORBIC ACID
ISOMALT
AGAR
KARAYA GUM
ALUMININUM SILICATE
KARAYA GUM
KARAYA GUM
KONJAC FLOUR
KONJAC FLOUR
KONJAC FLOUR
KARAYA GUM
KARAYA GUM
LACTIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
LACTITOL
LACTITOL
LACTIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
LACTITOL
AGAR
CALCIUM OXIDE
LIPASE (Animal Sources) LIPASE
(Aspergillus oryzae, var.)
CAROB BEAN GUM
SODIUM HYDROXIDE
LYSOZYME HYDROCHLORIDE
POLYETHYLENE GLYCOL
Monopotassium Citrate
Monosodium Citrate
Monostearin
MPG
MSG
Muriatic Acid
Na CMC
Natamycin
Nitrogen Oxide
Non-Crystallizing Sorbitol Solution
Notatin
ORTHO-PHENYLPHENOLS
PEG
Peruvian Tara
Petroleum Wax
Phosphatides
Phospholipids
INS
Page 34
JECFA ADI
INS
Page 35
JECFA ADI
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
Plain Caramel
PNG-Carragenan
Poly(Dimethylsiloxane)
Polydextrose
Polyvinylpolypyrrolidone
Pomalous Acid
Potassium 5'-Guanylate
Potassium 5'-Inosinate
Potassium Bicarbonate
Potassium Citrate
Potassium Myristate
Potassium Oleate
Potassium Palmitate
Potassium Stearate
Povidone
Propyl Gallate
Ptyalin
PVP
SAIB
Sal Ammoniac
Salts of Oleic Acid (Calcium, Potassium
and Sodium)
Semi-Refined Carrageenan
Silica
Simethicone
Slaked Lime
Soda Ash
Sodium 5'-Guanylate
Sodium 5'-Inosinate
Sodium 5'-Ribonucleotides
Sodium Acid Carbonate
Sodium Bicarbonate
Sodium Calcium Silicoaluminate
Sodium Cellulose Glycolate
Sodium Citrate
Sodium Citrate Monobasic
Sodium CMC
Sodium D-Gluconate
Sodium Glutamate
Sodium Guanylate
INS
Page 36
JECFA ADI
Sodium Myristate
Sodium Oleate
Sodium Palmitate
Sodium Ribonucleotides
Sodium Silicoaluminate
Sodium Stearate
Sodium Stearoyl Lactate
Sorbit
Starch, Acid-Treated
Starch, Alkaline Treated
Starch, Bleached
Starch, Enzyme Treated
Starch, Roasted
Sterculia
Strong Ammonia Solution
Sulphite Ammonia Caramel
Sylvine
Sylvite
Talcum
Tartaric Acid Esters of Mono- and
Diglycerides
Tartrated Mono- and Diglycerides
Group ADI 3
mg/kg bw
THIODIPROPIONATES
Tin Dichloride
TOSOM
30 mg/kg bw
Tributyrase
Triglycerine Lipase
Vitamin C
Vitamin C Palmitate
Vitamin C Stearate
Wax-Free Bleached Shellac
White and Yellow Dextrins
Yellow Prussiate of Lime
Yellow Prussiate of Potash
Yellow Prussiate of Soda
CHLOROPHYLLS
FAST GREEN FCF
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS I
Caramel Colour, Class I - Plain
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
SODIUM HYDROXIDE
DISODIUM INOSINATE, 5'
SODIUM ERYTHORBATE
SODIUM MALATE
SODIUM SESQUICARBONATE
Salts of Myristic, Palmitic & Stearic Acids
(NH4, Ca, K, Na)
SALTS OF OLEIC ACID (Ca
Salts of Myristic, Palmitic & Stearic Acids
(NH4, Ca, K, Na)
DISODIUM RIBONUCLEOTIDES, 5'
SODIUM ALUMINOSILICATE
Salts of Myristic, Palmitic & Stearic Acids
(NH4, Ca, K, Na)
Sodium Stearoyl Lactylate
SORBITOL (INCLUDING SORBITOL
SYRUP)
ACID TREATED STARCH
Alkaline Treated Starch
BLEACHED STARCH
ENZYME TREATED STARCH
DEXTRINS, WHITE AND YELLOW,
ROASTED STARCH
KARAYA GUM
AMMONIUM HYDROXIDE
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
POTASSIUM CHLORIDE
POTASSIUM CHLORIDE
TALC
TARTARIC, ACETIC & FATTY ACID
ESTERS OF GLYCEROL (MIXED)
TARTARIC, ACETIC & FATTY ACID
ESTERS OF GLYCEROL (MIXED)
140
143
150a
150a
150c
Not Limited
25 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
200 mg/kg bw
STANNOUS CHLORIDE
THERMALLY OXIDIZED SOYA BEAN
OIL WITH MONO- AND DI-GLYCERIDES
OF FATTY ACIDS (TOSOM)
Lipase (Animal Sources), Lipase
(Aspergillus oryzae, var.)
Lipase (Animal Sources), Lipase
(Aspergillus oryzae, var.)
ASCORBIC ACID
Ascorbyl Palmitate
Ascorbyl Stearate
SHELLAC
DEXTRINS, WHITE AND YELLOW,
ROASTED STARCH
Calcium Ferrocyanide
Potassium Ferrocyanide
Sodium Ferrocyanide
CHLOROPHYLLS
FAST GREEN FCF
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS I
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS I
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
Page 37
Additive
Caramel Colour, Class III - Ammonia
Process
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Caramel Colour, Class IV - Ammonia
Sulphite Process
BEET RED
CALCIUM CARBONATE
TITANIUM DIOXIDE
Benzoic Acid
Sodium Benzoate
Potassium Benzoate
Calcium Benzoate
INS
JECFA ADI
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
150c
150d
200 mg/kg bw
200 mg/kg bw
150d
162
170i
171
210
211
212
213
200 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Ortho-Phenylphenol
Sodium o-Phenylphenol
PIMARICIN
Formic Acid
HEXAMETHYLENE TETRAMINE
DIMETHYL DICARBONATE
ACETIC ACID, GLACIAL
POTASSIUM ACETATE
SODIUM ACETATE
CALCIUM ACETATE
AMMONIUM ACETATE
LACTIC ACID (L-, D- and DL-)
PROPIONIC ACID
SODIUM PROPIONATE
CALCIUM PROPIONATE
POTASSIUM PROPIONATE
CARBON DIOXIDE
MALIC ACID (DL-)
FUMARIC ACID
ASCORBIC ACID
SODIUM ASCORBATE
CALCIUM ASCORBATE
POTASSIUM ASCORBATE
Ascorbyl Palmitate
Ascorbyl Stearate
GALLATE, PROPYL
GUAIAC RESIN
231
232
235
236
239
242
260
261
262i
263
264
270
280
281
282
283
290
296
297
300
301
302
303
304
305
310
314
ORTHO-PHENYLPHENOLS
ORTHO-PHENYLPHENOLS
0.3 mg/kg bw PIMARICIN
FORMATES
0.15 mg/kg bw HEXAMETHYLENE TETRAMINE
Acceptable
DIMETHYL DICARBONATE
Not Limited
ACETIC ACID, GLACIAL
Not Specified POTASSIUM ACETATE
Not Specified SODIUM ACETATE
Not Limited
CALCIUM ACETATE
Not Specified AMMONIUM ACETATE
Not Limited
LACTIC ACID (L-, D- and DL-)
Not Limited
PROPIONIC ACID
Not Limited
SODIUM PROPIONATE
Not Limited
CALCIUM PROPIONATE
Not Limited
POTASSIUM PROPIONATE
Not Specified CARBON DIOXIDE
Not Specified MALIC ACID (DL-)
Not Specified FUMARIC ACID
Not Specified ASCORBIC ACID
Not Specified SODIUM ASCORBATE
Not Specified CALCIUM ASCORBATE
Not Specified POTASSIUM ASCORBATE
ASCORBYL ESTERS
ASCORBYL ESTERS
1.4 mg/kg bw GALLATE, PROPYL
2.5 mg/kg bw GUAIAC RESIN
ERYTHORBIC ACID
SODIUM ERYTHORBATE
LECITHIN
SODIUM LACTATE
POTASSIUM LACTATE (SOLUTION)
CALCIUM LACTATE
AMMONIUM LACTATE
MAGNESIUM LACTATE, (DL-)
CITRIC ACID
SODIUM DIHYDROGEN CITRATE
TRISOIDUM CITRATE
POTASSIUM DIHYDROGEN CITRATE
TRIPOTASSIUM CITRATE
CALCIUM CITRATE
SODIUM HYDROGEN MALATE
SODIUM MALATE
315
316
322
325
326
327
328
329
330
331i
331iii
332i
332ii
333
350i
350ii
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Specified
Specified
Limited
Limited
Limited
Limited
Limited
Limited
Limited
Limited
Specified
Limited
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
ERYTHORBIC ACID
SODIUM ERYTHORBATE
LECITHIN
SODIUM LACTATE
POTASSIUM LACTATE (SOLUTION)
CALCIUM LACTATE
AMMONIUM LACTATE
MAGNESIUM LACTATE, (DL-)
CITRIC ACID
SODIUM DIHYDROGEN CITRATE
TRISOIDUM CITRATE
POTASSIUM DIHYDROGEN CITRATE
TRIPOTASSIUM CITRATE
CALCIUM CITRATE
SODIUM HYDROGEN MALATE
SODIUM MALATE
Page 38
Additive
POTASSIUM HYDROGEN MALATE
POTASSIUM MALATE
CALCIUM MALATE
SODIUM FUMARATE
AMMONIUM CITRATE
TRIAMMONIUM CITRATE
FERRIC AMMONIUM CITRATE
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
CALCIUM DISODIUM ETHYLENE
DIAMINE TETRA ACETATE
Calcium Disodium Ethylene Diamine
Tetraacetate
DISODIUM ETHYLENE DIAMINE TETRA
ACETATE
Disodium Ethylene Diamine Tetraacetate
OXYSTEARIN
Thiodipropionic Acid
Dilauryl Thiodipropionate
ALGINIC ACID
SODIUM ALGINATE
POTASSIUM ALGINATE
AMONNIUM ALGINATE
CALCIUM ALGINATE
AGAR
CARRAGEENAN
PROCESSED EUCHEUMA SEAWEED
CAROB BEAN GUM
GUAR GUM
TRAGACANTH GUM
GUM ARABIC
XANTHAN GUM
KARAYA GUM
TARA GUM
GELLAN GUM
SORBITOL (INCLUDING SORBITOL
SYRUP)
MANNITOL
GLYCEROL
CURDLAN
KONJAC FLOUR
INS
351i
351ii
352ii
365
380
380
381
384
JECFA ADI
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
0.8 mg/kg bw
14 mg/kg bw
385
Group ADI
Pectin (Non-Amidated)
PECTINS (AMIDATED AND NONAMIDATED)
SUCROSE ACETATE ISOBUTYRATE
GLYCEROL ESTER OF WOOD ROSIN
GAMMA-CYCLODEXTRIN
CYCLODEXTRIN, BETAMICROCRYSTALLINE CELLULOSE
POWDERED CELLULOSE
METHYL CELLULOSE
ETHYL CELLULOSE
HYDROXYPROPYL CELLULOSE
HYDROXYPROPYL METHYL
CELLULOSE
METHYL ETHYL CELLULOSE
SODIUM CARBOXYMETHYL
440
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
POTASSIUM HYDROGEN MALATE
POTASSIUM MALATE
CALCIUM MALATE
SODIUM FUMARATE
AMMONIUM CITRATE
TRIAMMONIUM CITRATE
FERRIC AMMONIUM CITRATE
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
CALCIUM DISODIUM ETHYLENE
DIAMINE TETRA ACETATE
EDTAS
385
386
386
387
388
389
400
401
402
403
404
406
407
407a
410
412
413
414
415
416
417
418
25 mg/kg bw
Group ADI
Group ADI
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
420
421
422
424
425
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
440
444
445
458
459
460i
460ii
461
462
463
Not Specified
20 mg/kg bw
25 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
5 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
464
465
466
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
EDTAs
EDTAs
OXYSTEARIN
THIODIPROPIONATES
THIODIPROPIONATES
ALGINIC ACID
SODIUM ALGINATE
POTASSIUM ALGINATE
AMONNIUM ALGINATE
CALCIUM ALGINATE
AGAR
CARRAGEENAN
PROCESSED EUCHEUMA SEAWEED
CAROB BEAN GUM
GUAR GUM
TRAGACANTH GUM
GUM ARABIC
XANTHAN GUM
KARAYA GUM
TARA GUM
GELLAN GUM
SORBITOL (INCLUDING SORBITOL
SYRUP)
MANNITOL
GLYCEROL
CURDLAN
KONJAC FLOUR
PECTINS (AMIDATED AND NONAMIDATED)
PECTINS (AMIDATED AND NONAMIDATED)
SUCROSE ACETATE ISOBUTYRATE
GLYCEROL ESTER OF WOOD ROSIN
GAMMA-CYCLODEXTRIN
CYCLODEXTRIN, BETAMICROCRYSTALLINE CELLULOSE
POWDERED CELLULOSE
METHYL CELLULOSE
ETHYL CELLULOSE
HYDROXYPROPYL CELLULOSE
HYDROXYPROPYL METHYL
CELLULOSE
METHYL ETHYL CELLULOSE
SODIUM CARBOXYMETHYL
Page 39
Additive
CELLULOSE
ETHYL HYDROXYETHYL CELLULOSE
SODIUM CARBOXYMETHYL
CELLULOSE, ENZYMATICALLY
HYDROLYZED
SALTS OF MYRISTIC, PALMITIC &
STEARIC ACIDS (NH4, Ca, K, Na)
SALTS OF OLEIC ACID (Ca, K, Na)
MONO- AND DIGLYCERIDES
ACETIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
CITRIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
LACTIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
TARTARIC, ACETIC & FATTY ACID
ESTERS OF GLYCEROL (MIXED)
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
THERMALLY OXIDIZED SOYA BEAN
OIL WITH MONO- AND DI-GLYCERIDES
OF FATTY ACIDS (TOSOM)
SODIUM CARBONATE
SODIUM HYDROGEN CARBONATE
SODIUM SESQUICARBONATE
POTASSIUM CARBONATE
POTASSIUM HYDROGEN CARBONATE
AMMONIUM CARBONATE
AMMONIUM HYDROGEN CARBONATE
MAGNESIUM CARBONATE
MAGNESIUM HYDROGEN CARBONATE
HYDROCHLORIC ACID
POTASSIUM CHLORIDE
CALCIUM CHLORIDE
AMMONIUM CHLORIDE
MAGNESIUM CHLORIDE
STANNOUS CHLORIDE
SODIUM SULFATE
POTASSIUM SULFATE
CALCIUM SULFATE
INS
JECFA ADI
467
Not Specified
469
Not Specified
470
470
471
Not Specified
472a
Not Limited
472c
Not Limited
472b
Not Limited
472f
Not Limited
477
25 mg/kg bw
479
500i
500ii
500iii
501i
501ii
503i
503ii
504i
504ii
507
508
509
510
511
512
514
515
516
523
524
525
526
527
528
529
530
535
536
538
551
552
553i
553iii
554
30 mg/kg bw
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
2 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
7 mg/kg bw
(PTWI)
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Group ADI
Not Limited
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
CELLULOSE
ETHYL HYDROXYETHYL CELLULOSE
SODIUM CARBOXYMETHYL
CELLULOSE, ENZYMATICALLY
HYDROLYZED
SALTS OF MYRISTIC, PALMITIC &
STEARIC ACIDS (NH4, Ca, K, Na)
SALTS OF OLEIC ACID (Ca, K, Na)
MONO- AND DIGLYCERIDES
ACETIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
CITRIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
LACTIC AND FATTY ACID ESTERS OF
GLYCEROL
TARTARIC, ACETIC & FATTY ACID
ESTERS OF GLYCEROL (MIXED)
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
THERMALLY OXIDIZED SOYA BEAN
OIL WITH MONO- AND DI-GLYCERIDES
OF FATTY ACIDS (TOSOM)
SODIUM CARBONATE
SODIUM HYDROGEN CARBONATE
SODIUM SESQUICARBONATE
POTASSIUM CARBONATE
POTASSIUM HYDROGEN CARBONATE
AMMONIUM CARBONATE
AMMONIUM HYDROGEN CARBONATE
MAGNESIUM CARBONATE
MAGNESIUM HYDROGEN CARBONATE
HYDROCHLORIC ACID
POTASSIUM CHLORIDE
CALCIUM CHLORIDE
AMMONIUM CHLORIDE
MAGNESIUM CHLORIDE
STANNOUS CHLORIDE
SODIUM SULFATE
POTASSIUM SULFATE
CALCIUM SULFATE
ALUMINIUM AMMONIUM SULFATE
SODIUM HYDROXIDE
POTASSIUM HYDROXIDE
CALCIUM HYDROXIDE
AMMONIUM HYDROXIDE
MAGNESIUM HYDROXIDE
CALCIUM OXIDE
MAGNESIUM OXIDE
FERROCYANIDES
FERROCYANIDES
FERROCYANIDES
SILICON DIOXIDE (AMORPHOUS)
CALCIUM SILICATE
MAGNESIUM SILICATE (SYNTHETIC)
TALC
SODIUM ALUMINOSILICATE
Page 40
Additive
CALCIUM ALUMINIUM SILICATE
(SYNTHETIC)
ALUMININUM SILICATE
GLUCONO DELTA LACTONE
SODIUM GLUCONATE
POTASSIUM GLUCONATE
CALCIUM GLUCONATE
FERROUS GLUCONATE
MAGNESIUM GLUCONATE
FERROUS LACTATE
GLUTAMIC ACID (L(+)-)
MONOSODIUM GLUTAMATE, LMONOPOTASSIUM GLUTAMATE, LCALCIUM GLUTAMATE, DL-LMONOAMMONIUM GLUTAMATE, LMAGNESIUM GLUTAMATE, DL-LGUANYLIC ACID, 5'DISODIUM GUANYLATE, 5'DIPOTASSIUM GUANYLATE, 5'CALCIUM GUANYLATE, 5'INOSINIC ACID, 5'DISODIUM INOSINATE, 5'DIPOTASSIUM INOSINATE, 5'CALCIUM INOSINATE, 5'CALCIUM RIBONUCLEOTIDES, 5'DISODIUM RIBONUCLEOTIDES, 5'POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
CANDELILLA WAX
CARNAUBA WAX
SHELLAC
MICROCRYSTALLINE WAX
CHLORINE
INS
CHLORINE DIOXIDE
AZODICARBONAMIDE
926
927a
NITROGEN
NITROUS OXIDE
PROPANE
ISOMALT
THAUMATIN
POLYGLYCITOL SYRUP
MALTITOL AND MALTITOL SYRUP
LACTITOL
XYLITOL
941
942
944
953
957
964
965
966
967
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
CALCIUM ALUMINIUM SILICATE
Not Specified (SYNTHETIC)
Not Specified ALUMININUM SILICATE
Not Specified GLUCONO DELTA LACTONE
Not Specified SODIUM GLUCONATE
Not Specified POTASSIUM GLUCONATE
Not Specified CALCIUM GLUCONATE
0.8 mg/kg bw FERROUS GLUCONATE
Not Specified MAGNESIUM GLUCONATE
0.9 mg/kg bw FERROUS LACTATE
Not Specified GLUTAMIC ACID (L(+)-)
Not Specified MONOSODIUM GLUTAMATE, LNot Specified MONOPOTASSIUM GLUTAMATE, LNot Specified CALCIUM GLUTAMATE, DL-LNot Specified MONOAMMONIUM GLUTAMATE, LNot Specified MAGNESIUM GLUTAMATE, DL-LNot Specified GUANYLIC ACID, 5'Not Specified DISODIUM GUANYLATE, 5'Not Specified DIPOTASSIUM GUANYLATE, 5'Not Specified CALCIUM GUANYLATE, 5'Not Specified INOSINIC ACID, 5'Not Specified DISODIUM INOSINATE, 5'Not Specified DIPOTASSIUM INOSINATE, 5'Not Specified CALCIUM INOSINATE, 5'Not Specified CALCIUM RIBONUCLEOTIDES, 5'Not Specified DISODIUM RIBONUCLEOTIDES, 5'1.5 mg/kg bw POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Acceptable
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
Acceptable
CANDELILLA WAX
7 mg/kg bw
CARNAUBA WAX
Acceptable
SHELLAC
20 mg/kg bw
MICROCRYSTALLINE WAX
2.5 mg/kg flour CHLORINE
30 mg/kg flour
(acceptable
treatment level) CHLORINE DIOXIDE
45 mg/kg flour AZODICARBONAMIDE
No ADI
NITROGEN
necessary
Acceptable
NITROUS OXIDE
Not Specified PROPANE
Not Specified ISOMALT
Not Specified THAUMATIN
Not Specified POLYGLYCITOL SYRUP
Not Specified MALTITOL AND MALTITOL SYRUP
Not Specified LACTITOL
Not Specified XYLITOL
ERYTHRITOL
Choline Acetate
Choline Carbonate
Choline Chloride
Choline Citrate
Choline Lactate
CHOLINE SALTS
Choline Tartrate
ALPHA-AMYLASE (Aspergillus oryzae
968
1001i
1001ii
1001iii
1001iv
1001vi
1001
1001v
1100
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Limited
Acceptable
556
559
575
576
577
578
579
580
585
620
621
622
623
624
625
626
627
628
629
630
631
632
633
634
635
900a
901
902
903
904
905ci
925
JECFA ADI
ERYTHRITOL
CHOLINE SALTS
CHOLINE SALTS
CHOLINE SALTS
CHOLINE SALTS
CHOLINE SALTS
CHOLINE SALTS
CHOLINE SALTS
ALPHA-AMYLASE (A. oryzae var.)
Page 41
INS
JECFA ADI
1100
Not Specified
1100
Not Specified
1100
1100
Not Specified
Not Specified
1100
1101iii
1101ii
1101i
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Acceptable
1102
1104
1104
1105
1200
1201
1202
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Specified
Acceptable
Not Specified
50 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
1400
1401
1402
1403
1404
1405
1410
1412
1414
1420
1422
1440
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
Not
1442
Not Specified
1450
1505
1518
1521
Not Specified
20 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
10 mg/kg bw
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
MAIN TERM/Synonyms
ALPHA-AMYLASE (Bacillus megaterium
expressed in Bacillus subtilis)
ALPHA-AMYLASE (Bacillus
stearothermophilus expressed in Bacillus
subtilis)
ALPHA-AMYLASE (Bacillus
stearothermophilus)
ALPHA-AMYLASE (Bacillus subtilis)
ALPHA-AMYLASE (Carbohydrase)
(Bacillus licheniformis)
BROMELAIN
PAPAIN
PROTEASE (Asperigillus oryzae var.)
GLUCOSE OXIDASE (Aspergillus niger
var.)
LIPASE (Animal Sources)
LIPASE (Aspergillus oryzae, var.)
LYSOZYME HYDROCHLORIDE
POLYDEXTROSES A AND N
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
INSOLUBLE POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
DEXTRINS, WHITE AND YELLOW,
ROASTED STARCH
ACID TREATED STARCH
ALKALINE TREATED STARCH
BLEACHED STARCH
OXIDIZED STARCH
ENZYME TREATED STARCH
MONOSTARCH PHOSPHATE
DISTARCH PHOSPHATE
ACETYLATED DISTARCH PHOSPHATE
STARCH ACETATE
ACETYLATED DISTARCH ADIPATE
HYDROXYPROPYL STARCH
HYDROXYPROPYL DISTARCH
PHOSPHATE
STARCH SODIUM OCTENYL
SUCCINATE
TRIETHYL CITRATE
TRIACETIN
POLYETHYLENE GLYCOL
Page 42
Additive
JECFA ADI
1.25 mg/kg bw
5 mg/kg bw
2.5 mg/kg bw
0.025 mg/kg bw
3 mg/kg bw
0.2 mg/kg bw
3 mg/kg bw
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Acceptable
Not Specified
Not Specified
1990-37
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
1990-37
1990-37
1985-29
523
559
264
403
503i
510
380
503ii
527
328
300
304
ASCORBYL ESTERS
BENZOATES
EDTAs
FERROCYANIDES
FORMATES
ORTHO-PHENYLPHENOLS
THIODIPROPIONATES
Acetic Acid, Glacial
Acetic and Fatty Acid Esters of Glycerol
Acetylated Distarch Adipate
Acetylated Distarch Phosphate
Acid Treated Starch
Agar
Alginic Acid
Alkaline Treated Starch
Alpha-Amylase (Aspergillus oryzae var.)
Alpha-Amylase (Bacillus megaterium expressed
in Bacillus subtilis)
Alpha-Amylase (Bacillus stearothermophilus
expressed in Bacillus subtilis)
Alpha-Amylase (Bacillus stearothermophilus)
Alpha-Amylase (Bacillus subtilis)
Alpha-Amylase (Carbohydrase) (Bacillus
licheniformis)
Aluminium Ammonium Sulphate
Aluminium Silicate
Ammonium Acetate
Ammonium Alginate
Ammonium Carbonate
Ammonium Chloride
Ammonium Citrate
Ammonium Hydrogen Carbonate
Ammonium Hydroxide
Ammonium Lactate
Ascorbic Acid
Ascorbyl Palmitate
JECFA Review
Date (year-mtg)
1973-17
1996-46
1973-17
1974-18
1973-17
1964-08
1973-17
1973-17
1973-17
1982-26
1982-26
1982-26
1973-17
1992-39
1982-26
1987-31
1987-31
1988-33
1985-29
1982-26
1992-39
1982-26
1979-23
1979-23
1982-26
1965-09
1973-17
1981-25
1973-17
305
927a
901
162
210
1403
1101iii
263
404
556
302
213
170i
Ascorbyl Stearate
Azodicarbonamide
Beeswax, White and Yellow
Beet Red
Benzoic Acid
Bleached Starch
Bromelain
Calcium Acetate
Calcium Alginate
Calcium Aluminium Silicate (Synthetic)
Calcium Ascorbate
Calcium Benzoate
Calcium Carbonate
7 mg/kg bw (PTWI)
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
See ASCORBYL
ESTERS
ASCORBYL ESTERS
45 mg/kg flour
Acceptable
Not Specified
See BENZOATES
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
See BENZOATES
Not Specified
Group
Group
Group
Group
Group
Group
Group
260
472a
1422
1414
1401
406
400
1402
1100
1100
1100
1100
1100
1100
ADI
ADI
ADI
ADI
ADI
ADI
ADI
1973-17
1965-09
1992-39
1987-31
1996-46
1982-26
1971-15
1973-17
1992-39
1985-29
1981-25
1996-46
1965-09
Page 43
INS
Additive
JECFA ADI
509
333
385
Not Specified
Not Specified
See EDTAs
538
578
623
629
526
633
327
352ii
529
282
634
552
516
902
150a
150c
150d
290
903
410
407
925
926
Calcium Chloride
Calcium Citrate
Calcium Disodium Ethylene Diamine Tetra
Acetate
Calcium Ferrocyanide
Calcium Gluconate
Calcium Glutamate, Dl-LCalcium Guanylate, 5'Calcium Hydroxide
Calcium Inosinate, 5'Calcium Lactate
Calcium Malate
Calcium Oxide
Calcium Propionate
Calcium Ribonucleotides, 5'Calcium Silicate
Calcium Sulphate
Candelilla Wax
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS I
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Carbon Dioxide
Carnauba Wax
Carob Bean Gum
Carrageenan
Chlorine
Chlorine Dioxide
140
1001i
1001ii
1001iii
1001iv
1001vi
1001
1001v
330
472c
424
459
1400
389
Chlorophylls
Choline Acetate
Choline Carbonate
Choline Chloride
Choline Citrate
Choline Lactate
CHOLINE SALTS
Choline Tartrate
Citric Acid
Citric and Fatty Acid Esters of Glycerol
Curdlan
Cyclodextrin, Beta
Dextrins, White and Yellow Roasted Starch
Dilauryl Thiodipropionate
242
628
632
386
627
631
635
1412
1405
315
968
462
467
143
Dimethyl Dicarbonate
Dipotassium Guanylate, 5'Dipotassium Inosinate, 5'Disodium Ethylene Diamine Tetra Acetate
Disodium Guanylate, 5'Disodium Inosinate, 5'Disodium Ribonucleotides, 5'Distarch Phosphate
Enzyme Treated Starch
Erythorbic Acid
Erythritol
Ethyl Cellulose
Ethyl Hydroxyethyl Cellulose
Fast Green FCF
See FERROCYANDIES
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Acceptable
Not Specified
200 mg/kg bw
200 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
7 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
2.5 mg/kg flour
30 mg/kg flour
(acceptable treatment
level)
Not Limited
See CHOLINE SALTS
See CHOLINE SALTS
See CHOLINE SALTS
See CHOLINE SALTS
See CHOLINE SALTS
Not Limited
See CHOLINE SALTS
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
5 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
See
THIODIPROPIONATES
Acceptable
Not Specified
Not Specified
See EDTAs
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
25 mg/kg bw
JECFA Review
Date (year-mtg)
1973-17
1973-17
1973-17
1974-18
1986-30, 1998-51
1987-31
1985-29
1965-09
1985-29
1974-18
1979-23
1965-09
1973-17
1974-18
1985-29
1973-17
1992-39
1985-29
1985-291985-291985-29
1992-39
1981-25
1984-28, 2001-57
1985-29
1963-07
1969-13
1971-15
1971-15
1971-15
1971-15
1971-15
1971-15
1971-15
1973-17
1973-17
2001-57
1995-44
1982-26
1973-17
1990-37
1985-29
1985-29
1973-17
1993-41
1993-41
1974-18
1982-26
1982-26
1990-37
1999-53
1989-35
1989-35
1986-30
Page 44
INS
Additive
JECFA ADI
381
579
585
236
297
310
458
418
575
1102
620
422
445
314
626
412
414
239
507
463
1442
464
1440
630
1202
953
384
416
425
270
472b
966
322
1104
1104
1105
504i
511
580
625
504ii
528
329
530
553i
296
965
421
461
465
460i
905ci
471
624
622
621
1410
941
0.8 mg/kg bw
0.8 mg/kg bw
0.9 mg/kg bw
See FORMATES
Not Specified
1.4 mg/kg bw
JECFA Review
Date (year-mtg)
1985-29
1987-31
1989-35
1973-17
1989-35
1996-46
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
25 mg/kg bw
2.5 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
0.15 mg/kg bw
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
14 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
Acceptable
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
20 mg/kg bw
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
No ADI necessary
1990-37
1986-30, 1998-51
1971-15
1987-31
1976-20
1996-46
1973-17
1985-29
1975-19
1989-35
1973-17
1965-09
1989-35
1982-26
1989-35
1982-26
1985-29
1983-27
1985-29
1973-17
1988-33
1996-46
1973-17
1973-17
1983-27
1973-17
1971-15
1974-18
1992-39
1965-09
1979-23
1986-30, 1998-51
1987-31
1979-23
1965-09
1979-23
1965-09
1982-26
1969-13
1993-41, 1997-49
1986-30
1989-35
1989-35
1997-49
1995-44
1973-17
1987-31
1987-31
1987-31
1982-26
1980-24
Page 45
INS
Additive
JECFA ADI
942
231
Nitrous Oxide
Ortho-Phenylphenol
1404
387
1101ii
440
1413
235
1200
900a
1521
964
1201
261
402
303
212
501i
508
332i
536
577
501ii
351i
525
326
351ii
283
515
460ii
407a
944
280
477
1101i
470
Oxidized Starch
Oxystearin
Papain
Pectins (Amidated and Non-Amidated)
Phosphated Distarch Phosphate
Pimaricin
Polydextroses A and N
Polydimethylsiloxane
Polyethylene Glycol
Polyglycitol Syrup
Polyvinylpyrrolidone
Potassium Acetate
Potassium Alginate
Potassium Ascorbate
Potassium Benzoate
Potassium Carbonate
Potassium Chloride
Potassium Dihydrogen Citrate
Potassium Ferrocyanide
Potassium Gluconate
Potassium Hydrogen Carbonate
Potassium Hydrogen Malate
Potassium Hydroxide
Potassium Lactate (Solution)
Potassium Malate
Potassium Propionate
Potassium Sulphate
Powdered Cellulose
Processed Eucheuma Seaweed
Propane
Propionic Acid
Propylene Glycol Esters of Fatty Acids
Protease (Asperigillus oryzae var.)
SALTS OF MYRISTIC, PALMITIC & STEARIC
ACIDS (NH4, Ca, K, Na)
SALTS OF OLEIC ACID (Ca, K, Na)
Shellac
Silicon Dioxide (Amorphous)
Sodium Acetate
Sodium Alginate
Sodium Aluminosilicate
Sodium Ascorbate
Sodium Benzoate
Sodium Carbonate
Sodium Carboxymethyl Cellulose
Sodium Carboxymethyl, Cellulose Enzymatically
Hydrolyzed
Sodium Dihydrogen Citrate
Sodium Erythorbate
Sodium Ferrocyanide
Sodium Fumarate
Sodium Gluconate
Sodium Hydrogen Carbonate
Sodium Hydrogen Malate
Sodium Hydroxide
Acceptable
See ORTHOPHENYLPHENOL
Not Specified
25 mg/kg bw
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
0.3 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
1.5 mg/kg bw
10 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
50 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
See BENZOATES
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
See FERROCYANIDES
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
25 mg/kg bw
Acceptable
Not Specified
470
904
551
262i
401
554
301
211
500i
466
469
331i
316
535
365
576
500ii
350i
524
JECFA Review
Date (year-mtg)
1985-29
1964-08
1982-26
1973-17
1971-15
1981-25
1982-26
1976-20, 2001-57
1987-31
1979-23
1979-23
1998-51
1986-30
1973-17
1992-39
1981-25
1996-46
1965-09
1979-23
1979-23
1974-18
1986-30, 1998-51
1965-09
1982-26
1965-09
1974-18
1979-23
1973-17
1985-29
1976-20
1995-44, 2001-57
1979-23
1973-17
1973-17
1987-31
1985-29
Not Specified
Acceptable
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
See BENZOATES
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
1988-33, 1998-51
1992-39
1985-29
1973-17
1992-39
1985-29
1981-25
1996-46
1965-09
1989-35
1998-51
Not Limited
Not Specified
See FERROCYANIDES
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
1979-23
1990-37
1974-18
1989-35
1986-30, 1998-51
1965-09
1982-26
1965-09
Page 46
INS
Additive
JECFA ADI
325
350ii
232
Sodium Lactate(Solution)
Sodium Malate
Sodium o-Phenylphenol
281
500iii
514
420
512
1420
1450
444
553iii
417
472f
388
Sodium Propionate
Sodium Sesquicarbonate
Sodium Sulfate
SORBITOL (INCLUDING SORBITOL SYRUP
Stannous Chloride
Starch Acetate
Starch Sodium Octenyl Succinate
Sucrose Acetate Isobutyrate
Talc
Tara Gum
Tartaric, Acetic & Fatty Acid Esters of Glycerol
(Mixed)
Thaumatin
Thermally Oxidized Soya Bean Oil with Monoand Di-Glycerides of Fatty Acids (TOSOM)
Thiodipropionic Acid
Not Limited
Not Specified
See ORTHOPHENYLPHENOL
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
2 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
20 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
171
413
1518
380
1505
332ii
331iii
415
967
Titanium Dioxide
Tragacanth Gum
Triacetin
Triammonium Citrate
Triethyl Citrate
Tripotassium Citrate
Trisodium Citrate
Xanthan Gum
Xylitol
957
479
JECFA Review
Date (year-mtg)
1974-18
1979-23
1964-08
1973-17
1981-25
1999-53, 2001-57
1982-26
1982-26
1982-26
1982-26
1996-46
1986-30
1986-30
1973-17
Not Specified
30 mg/kg bw
1985-29
1992-39
See
THIODIPROPIONATES
Not Limited
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Limited
20 mg/kg bw
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
Not Specified
1973-17
1969-13
1985-29
1975-19
1979-23
1984-28
1973-17
1973-17
1986-30
1983-27
TABLE ONE
Additives Permitted for Use Under Specified
Conditions in Certain Food Categories or Individual
Food Items
INS: 1100
Max Level
Comments
GMP
Step
8
Year
1999
INS: 523
09.2.4
10.2
Max Level
Candied fruit
Vegetable, and nut and seed pulps and preparations (e.g.,
vegetable desserts and sauces, candied vegetables) other
than food category 04.2.2.5
Cooked and/or fried fish and fish products, including
mollusks, crustaceans, and echinoderms
Egg products
Comments
Step
Year
8
8
2001
2001
2001
30 mg/kg Note 6
2001
ASCORBYL ESTERS
Ascorbyl Palmitate
INS: 304
Ascorbyl Stearate
INS: 305
Function: Antioxidant
Beverage whiteners
Milk powder and cream powder (plain)
Milk and cream powder analogues
Total ripened cheese, includes rind
Dairy-based desserts (e.g., ice milk, pudding, fruit or
flavoured yoghurt)
Max Level
80
500
80
500
500
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
Comments
Step
Note 10
Note 10
Note 10
Notes 10 & 112
Notes 2 & 10
8
8
8
8
8
Year
2001
2001
2001
2001
2001
Page 1 of 23
ASCORBYL ESTERS
Function: Antioxidant
13.1
13.2
13.3
14.1.4
15.1
15.2
Comments
Step
Note 10
Note 10
Note 10
Notes 10 & 113
Note 10
8
8
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
2001
2001
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
80
500
200
500
8
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
8
8
2001
2001
2001
8
8
2001
2001
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
50 mg/kg Note 10
100 mg/kg Note 10
100 mg/kg Note 10
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
2001
2001
Max Level
500
400
400
500
500
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
80 mg/kg Note 10
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
Note 10
Notes 10,15&114
Note 10
Notes 2 & 10
Year
AZODICARBONAMIDE
Azodicarbonamide
INS: 927a
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
Page 2 of 23
AZODICARBONAMIDE
Max Level
Comments
45 mg/kg
Step
8
Year
1999
INS: 901
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
Comments
Step
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
4000 mg/kg
Year
GMP
GMP
GMP
Note 3
Note 3
Note 108
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
GMP
Note 3
2001
BENZOATES
Benzoic Acid
Potassium Benzoate
INS: 210
INS: 212
Sodium Benzoate
Calcium Benzoate
INS: 211
INS: 213
Function: Preservative
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
2001
2001
8
8
2001
2001
2001
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
8
8
2001
2001
2001
1000
1000
1000
2000
8
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
Note 13
Note 13
Note 13
Note 13
Page 3 of 23
BENZOATES
Function: Preservative
Step
Year
Max Level
04.2.2.5
2001
2001
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
Max Level
Comments
Step
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
04.2.2.6
04.2.2.7
04.2.2.8
12.5
Comments
CANDELILLA WAX
Candelilla Wax
INS: 902
GMP
GMP
GMP
4000 mg/kg
Year
GMP
GMP
GMP
Note 3
Note 3
Note 108
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
GMP
Note 3
2001
Comments
Step
INS: 150c
Function: Colour
01.2.1
01.2.2
01.3.2
01.4.3
01.4.4
01.5.2
01.6.1
01.6.2.2
01.6.3
01.6.4
01.6.5
Max Level
Year
150 mg/kg
1999
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
Page 4 of 23
Function: Colour
Max Level
01.7
2000 mg/kg
02.4
03.0
04.1.2.3
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.5
04.1.2.6
04.1.2.7
04.1.2.8
04.1.2.9
04.1.2.11
04.2.2.3
04.2.2.4
04.2.2.5
04.2.2.6
05.1.3
05.2
05.3
05.4
06.3
06.5
07.2
08.0
09.1
09.2
09.3.3
09.4
10.1
10.4
11.1.2
12.2
12.3
12.4
12.5
12.6
Comments
Step
Year
1999
1999
1000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
GMP
500 mg/kg
8
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
GMP
7500 mg/kg
8
8
1999
1999
1999
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
1999
GMP
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
20000 mg/kg
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
6500 mg/kg
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
7500 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
GMP
Note 3
Notes 3 & 50
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
GMP
Note 50
1999
GMP Note 50
500 mg/kg Note 50
8
8
1999
1999
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
1000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
1500 mg/kg
Notes 3 & 4
Page 5 of 23
Function: Colour
12.9
13.3.1
13.4
13.5
13.6
14.1.2.3
14.1.3.2
14.1.3.4
14.1.4
14.2.1
14.2.2
14.2.3.3
14.2.4
14.2.6
14.2.7
15.0
16.0
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
GMP
1999
GMP
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
1999
GMP
1999
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
8
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
1000 mg/kg
INS: 150d
Function: Colour
01.2.1
01.2.2
01.3.2
01.4.3
01.4.4
01.5.2
01.6.1
01.6.2.2
01.6.3
01.6.4
01.6.5
01.7
Max Level
Comments
150 mg/kg
Step
Year
1999
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
Page 6 of 23
Function: Colour
05.1.3
05.2
05.3
05.4
06.3
06.5
07.2.1
07.2.2
07.2.3
08.0
09.1
09.2
09.3.3
09.4
10.1
10.4
11.1.2
12.2
12.3
12.4
12.5.1
Max Level
Comments
GMP
Step
Year
1999
1000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
1500 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
8
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
GMP
7500 mg/kg
8
8
1999
1999
1999
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
1999
GMP
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
20000 mg/kg
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
2500 mg/kg
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
1200 mg/kg
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
GMP
7500 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
GMP
Notes 3 & 50
8
8
8
GMP
Note 50
1999
GMP Note 50
500 mg/kg Note 50
8
8
1999
1999
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
3000 mg/kg
Notes 3 & 4
Page 7 of 23
Function: Colour
Max Level
12.5.2
12.6
12.7
GMP
1500 mg/kg
GMP
12.9
13.3.1
13.4
13.5
13.6
14.1.2.3
14.1.3.2
14.1.3.4
14.1.4
14.2.1
14.2.2
14.2.3.3
14.2.4
14.2.6
14.2.7
15.0
16.0
Comments
Step
Year
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
1999
GMP
1999
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
8
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
8
8
1999
1999
GMP
1000 mg/kg
CARNAUBA WAX
Carnauba Wax
INS: 903
Function: Anticaking Agent, Adjuvant, Bulking Agent, Carrier Solvent, Glazing Agent, Release Agent
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
Comments
Step
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
4000 mg/kg
Year
GMP
GMP
GMP
Note 3
Note 3
Note 108
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
GMP
Note 3
2001
Page 8 of 23
CHLORINE
CHLORINE
Chlorine
INS: 925
Max Level
06.2
Max Level
Step
06.2
Max Level
Step
Comments
Year
2001
CHLORINE DIOXIDE
Chlorine Dioxide
INS: 926
Comments
Year
2001
INS: 459
Chewing gum
Water-based flavoured drinks, including "sport" or
"electrolyte" drinks and particulated drinks
Comments
20000 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
8
8
Year
2001
2001
DIMETHYL DICARBONATE
Dimethyl Dicarbonate
INS: 242
Function: Preservative
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
1999
1999
EDTAs
Calcium Disodium Ethylene Diamine Tetra
Acetate
INS: 385
INS: 386
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
75 mg/kg Note 21
2001
8
8
2001
2001
Page 9 of 23
EDTAs
04.2.2.7
04.2.2.8
05.1.3
06.5
08.3.2
09.2.1
09.2.2
09.3.2
09.4
10.2.3
12.2
12.4
12.6.1
12.6.2
12.7
13.6
14.1.4
14.1.5
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
8
8
2001
2001
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
8
8
2001
2001
80 mg/kg Note 21
2001
Note 21
Note 21
Note 21
Note 21
8
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
35 mg/kg Note 21
2001
75 mg/kg Note 21
2001
75 mg/kg Note 21
2001
2001
2001
8
8
2001
2001
75 mg/kg Note 21
100 mg/kg Note 21
75 mg/kg Note 21
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
8
8
2001
2001
35 mg/kg Note 21
2001
250
250
50
315
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
INS: 143
Function: Colour
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
Page 10 of 23
Function: Colour
01.7
02.1.3
03.0
04.1.2.4
04.1.2.5
04.2.2.3
04.2.2.4
05.3
07.1.1
07.2
08.1
08.2
08.4
09.2.4.1
09.2.5
09.3.3
10.1
14.1.4
14.2.6
14.2.7
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
100 mg/kg
1999
1999
GMP
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
8
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
GMP Notes 3 & 4
GMP Notes 3 & 4
8
8
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
8
8
1999
1999
100 mg/kg
1999
100 mg/kg
GMP Notes 3 & 4
100 mg/kg
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
100 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
8
8
1999
1999
100
200
400
300
200
300
100
100
INS: 381
Max Level
Salt
Concentrates (liquid or solid) for drinks
Comments
25 mg/kg Note 23
10 mg/kg Note 23
Step
8
8
Year
1999
1999
FERROCYANIDES
Sodium Ferrocyanide
Calcium Ferrocyanide
INS: 535
INS: 538
Potassium Ferrocyanide
INS: 536
Salt
Max Level
Comments
20 mg/kg Note 24
Step
8
Year
1999
Page 11 of 23
FERROCYANIDES
Max Level
Comments
20 mg/kg Note 24
Step
8
Year
1999
FERROUS GLUCONATE
Ferrous Gluconate
INS: 579
Max Level
Comments
Step
8
Year
1999
FERROUS LACTATE
Ferrous Lactate
INS: 585
Max Level
Comments
Step
8
Year
1999
FORMATES
Formic Acid
INS: 236
Function: Preservative
Max Level
Comments
Step
8
8
Year
2001
2001
GALLATE, PROPYL
Gallate, Propyl
INS: 310
Function: Antioxidant
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
8
8
2001
2001
200 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
8
8
2001
2001
100 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
8
8
2001
2001
Page 12 of 23
GALLATE, PROPYL
Function: Antioxidant
10.4
12.2
12.5.2
12.6
13.6
14.1.4
15.0
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
50 mg/kg
2001
90 mg/kg Note 2
2001
50 mg/kg Note 76
200 mg/kg Note 15
8
8
2001
2001
2001
1000 mg/kg
200 mg/kg Note 15
8
8
2001
2001
mg/kg
mg/kg Note 15
mg/kg
mg/kg Note 2
8
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
2001
200 mg/kg
2001
2001
200 mg/kg
100 mg/kg Note 15
8
8
2001
2001
90 mg/kg Note 2
200 mg/kg Note 15
8
8
2001
2001
mg/kg Note 15
mg/kg Note 15
mg/kg
mg/kg Note 15
8
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
2001
100
200
100
90
200
200
400
1000
INS: 445
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
150 mg/kg
1999
60 mg/kg
1999
GUAIAC RESIN
Guaiac Resin
INS: 314
Page 13 of 23
GUAIAC RESIN
Function: Antioxidant
Max Level
02.1
02.2.1
05.3
1000 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
1500 mg/kg
Comments
Step
8
8
8
Year
1999
1999
1999
HEXAMETHYLENE TETRAMINE
Hexamethylene Tetramine
INS: 239
Function: Preservative
Max Level
Comments
25 mg/kg Note 66
Step
8
Year
2001
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
Isopropyl Citrates
INS: 384
08.3.1.2
14.1.4
Max Level
100
100
200
200
Comments
mg/kg Note 77
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
Step
Year
8
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
100 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
200 mg/kg
2001
200 mg/kg
2001
LYSOZYME HYDROCHLORIDE
Lysozyme Hydrochloride
INS: 1105
Function: Preservative
Max Level
Ripened cheese
GMP
Comments
Step
8
Year
1999
MICROCRYSTALLINE WAX
Microcrystalline Wax
INS: 905ci
Page 14 of 23
MICROCRYSTALLINE WAX
Comments
Step
Note 3
2001
2001
Max Level
GMP
Year
ORTHO-PHENYLPHENOLS
Ortho-Phenylphenol
INS: 231
Sodium o-Phenylphenol
INS: 232
Function: Preservative
Max Level
Comments
12 mg/kg Note 49
Step
8
Year
1999
OXYSTEARIN
Oxystearin
INS: 387
Max Level
02.1
12.6.1
14.1.4
1250 mg/kg
GMP
250 mg/kg
Comments
Step
8
8
8
Year
1998
1998
1998
PIMARICIN
(syn. Natamycin)
INS: 235
Pimaricin
INS: 235
Function: Preservative
Max Level
01.6
08.2.1.2
08.3.1.2
Comments
Step
Year
2001
2001
2001
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Polydimethylsiloxane
INS: 900a
Max Level
10 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
Comments
Step
8
8
8
Year
1999
1999
1999
Page 15 of 23
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Max Level
10
10
30
10
Comments
Step
Year
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
110 mg/kg
1999
10 mg/kg Note 15
10 mg/kg
8
8
1999
1999
10 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
8
8
1999
1999
10 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
8
8
1999
1999
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
10 mg/kg
20 mg/kg
8
8
1999
1999
10 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
100
10
10
10
mg/kg
mg/kg
mg/kg Note 36
mg/kg
POLYETHYLENE GLYCOL
Polyethylene Glycol
INS: 1521
Function: Adjuvant, Antifoaming Agent, Carrier Solvent, Emulsifier, Flavour Enhancer, Glazing Agent, Release Agent, Stabilizer, Thickener
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
GMP
20000 mg/kg
10000 mg/kg
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
70000 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
8
8
2001
2001
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
Polyvinylpyrrolidone
INS: 1201
Max Level
GMP
Comments
Step
8
Year
1999
Page 16 of 23
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
Max Level
Chewing gum
Table-top sweeteners, including those containing high
intensity sweeteners
Vinegars
Food supplements
Concentrates (liquid or solid) for drinks
Beer and malt beverages
Cider and perry
Comments
10000 mg/kg
3000 mg/kg
40 mg/kg
GMP
500 mg/kg
10 mg/kg Note 36
2 mg/kg Note 36
Step
Year
8
8
1999
1999
8
8
8
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
1999
INS: 477
Max Level
01.1.2
5000 mg/kg
01.3.2
01.4.4
01.5.2
01.7
02.1
02.2.1.2
02.2.2
02.3
02.4
03.0
04.1.2.8
04.1.2.9
04.1.2.11
04.2.2.6
05.2
05.3
05.4
06.5
07.0
10.4
11.4
Comments
Step
Year
2001
8
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
10000 mg/kg
20000 mg/kg
8
8
2001
2001
20000 mg/kg
30000 mg/kg
8
8
2001
2001
10000 mg/kg
2001
5000 mg/kg
40000 mg/kg
8
8
2001
2001
40000 mg/kg
2001
40000 mg/kg
5000 mg/kg
8
8
2001
2001
5000 mg/kg
2001
20000 mg/kg
40000 mg/kg
8
8
2001
2001
40000 mg/kg
2001
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
1000
5000
100000
5000
mg/kg
mg/kg Note 86
mg/kg
mg/kg
Page 17 of 23
Year
Max Level
13.3.1
5000 mg/kg
2001
5000 mg/kg
2001
500 mg/kg
2001
13.4
14.1.4
Comments
INS: 1101i
Max Level
Comments
GMP
Step
8
Year
1999
SHELLAC
Shellac
INS: 904
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
Comments
Step
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
2001
4000 mg/kg
Year
GMP
GMP
GMP
Note 3
Note 3
Note 108
8
8
8
2001
2001
2001
GMP
Note 3
2001
Comments
Step
STANNOUS CHLORIDE
Stannous Chloride
INS: 512
Max Level
20 mg/kg Note 43
25 mg/kg Note 43
20 mg/kg Note 43
8
8
8
Year
2001
2001
2001
Page 18 of 23
STEARYL CITRATE
STEARYL CITRATE
Stearyl Citrate
INS: 484
Max Level
Comments
GMP
100 mg/kg Note 15
15000 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
Step
Year
8
8
1999
1999
8
8
1999
1999
INS: 444
Max Level
Comments
500 mg/kg
Step
8
Year
1999
THIODIPROPIONATES
Thiodipropionic Acid
INS: 388
Dilauryl Thiodipropionate
INS: 389
Function: Antioxidant
Max Level
Comments
Step
Year
8
8
1999
1999
8
8
1999
1999
1999
1999
TOSOM
Thermally Oxidized Soya Bean Oil with
Mono- and Di-Glycerides of Fatty Acids
(TOSOM)
INS: 479
Function: Emulsifier
Step
Year
Max Level
02.2.1.2
5000 mg/kg
1999
5000 mg/kg
1999
02.2.2
Comments
Page 19 of 23
TRIETHYL CITRATE
TRIETHYL CITRATE
Triethyl Citrate
INS: 1505
Max Level
10.2.1
10.2.3
14.1.4
Comments
Step
8
8
8
Year
1999
1999
1999
Page 20 of 23
Notes to the Comments for the General Standard for Food Additives - Provisions
Adopted at Step 8 (as of 24th CAC)
Notes in bold apply to the adopted provisions.
Note 1: As adipic acid
Note 2: On dry ingredient, dry weight, dry mix or concentrate basis.
Note 3: Surface treatment.
Note 4: For decoration, stamping, marking or branding the product.
Note 5: Used in raw materials for manufacture of the finished food.
Note 6: As aluminium.
Note 7: Use level not in finished food.
Note 8: As bixin.
Note 9: As total bixin or norbixin.
Note 10: As ascorbyl stearate.
Note 11: Flour basis.
Note 12: Carryover from flavouring substances.
Note 13: As benzoic acid.
Note 14: Served at greater than 5-fold dilution.
Note 15: Fat or oil basis.
Note 16: For use in glaze, coatings or decorations for fruit, vegetables, meat or fish.
Note 17: As cyclamic acid.
Note 18: Added level; residue not detected in ready-to-eat food.
Note 19: Used in cocoa fat; use level on ready-to-eat basis.
Note 20: On total amount of stabilizers, thickeners and/or gums.
Note 21: As anhydrous calcium disodium EDTA.
Note 22: For use in smoked fish products only.
Note 23: As iron.
Note 24: As anhydrous sodium ferrocyanide.
Note 25: As formic acid.
Note 26: For use in baking powder only.
Note 27: As p-hydroxy benzoic acid.
Note 28: ADI conversion: if a typical preparation contains 0.025 g/U, then the ADI of 33,000 U/kg bw
becomes:
[(33000 U/kg bw) x (0.025 g/U) x (1 mg/1000 g)] = 0.825 mg/kg bw
Note 29: Reporting basis not specified.
Note 30:As residual NO 3 ion.
Note 31: Of the mash used.
Note 32: As residual NO 2 ion.
Note 33: As phosphorus.
Note 34: Anhydrous basis.
Note 35: Except for use in special formula at 20,000 mg/kg.
Note 36: Residual level.
Note 37: As weight of nonfat milk solids.
Note 38: Level in creaming mixture.
Note 39: Only when product contains butter or other fats and oils.
Note 40: Except for use in special formula at 200 mg/kg.
Note 41: Use in breading or batter coatings only.
Note 42: As sorbic acid
Note 43: As tin.
Note 44: As residual SO 2.
Note 45: As tartaric acid.
Page 21 of 23
Page 23 of 23
01.1.2
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
FAST GREEN FCF
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
150d
8 / 1999
143
477
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
Max Level
150 mg/kg
150 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
5000 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
Max Level
150 mg/kg
150 mg/kg
Comments
Note 12
Note 12
Renneted milk
01.3.2
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Beverage whiteners
INS
304, 305
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
477
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
01.4.3
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
INS
150c
150d
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
150c
01.2.2
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
INS
01.2.1
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Max Level
80 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
1000 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Clotted cream
INS
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
01.4.4
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Cream analogues
INS
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Page 1 of 32
01.4.4
Additive
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Max Level
5000 mg/kg
Comments
Note 86
Max Level
500 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 75
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
477
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
Max Level
80 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
100000mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Max Level
40 mg/kg
Comments
Notes 3 & 80,
Temporary
Unripened cheese
INS
150c
150d
01.6.2
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Ripened cheese
INS
1105
01.6.2.1
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
HEXAMETHYLENE TETRAMINE
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
01.6.1
Additive
LYSOZYME HYDROCHLORIDE
310
900a
INS
235
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
01.6
Additive
PIMARICIN
INS
304, 305
01.5.2
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
01.5.1
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
GALLATE, PROPYL
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Cream analogues
INS
477
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
239
8 / 2001
01.6.2.2
Max Level
500 mg/kg
25 mg/kg
Comments
Notes 10 & 112
Note 66
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Page 2 of 32
01.6.3
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
150d
8 / 1999
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
Comments
Note 3
Note 3
Max Level
GMP
100 mg/kg
Comments
Cheese analogues
INS
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
01.7
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
FAST GREEN FCF
GALLATE, PROPYL
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Processed cheese
INS
150c
01.6.5
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
01.6.4
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Whey cheese
INS
150c
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
210-213
150c
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
143
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
310
477
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
Max Level
500 mg/kg
300 mg/kg
2000 mg/kg
2000 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
90 mg/kg
5000 mg/kg
Comments
Notes 2 & 10
Note 13
Note 2
Note 2
Page 3 of 32
02.1
Additive
GALLATE, PROPYL
GUAIAC RESIN
OXYSTEARIN
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
STEARYL CITRATE
THIODIPROPIONATES
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
484
8 / 1999
388, 389
8 / 1999
304, 305
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
384
8 / 2001
GMP
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 46
Max Level
500 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 77
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
384
8 / 2001
Max Level
400 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
384
8 / 2001
Max Level
400 mg/kg
GMP
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
02.2
INS
304, 305
02.2.1
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
500 mg/kg
Comments
Notes 10 & 113
02.2.1.2
Additive
BENZOATES
EDTAs
GALLATE, PROPYL
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
STEARYL CITRATE
Max Level
200 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
1250 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
10000mg/kg
02.1.3
Additive
GUAIAC RESIN
900a
477
INS
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
8 / 1999
8 / 1998
02.1.2
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
FAST GREEN FCF
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
314
387
INS
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
02.1.1
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
385, 386
8 / 2001
310
8 / 2001
384
900a
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
477
8 / 2001
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
75 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
20000mg/kg
484
8 / 1999
100 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Note 21
Note 15
Page 4 of 32
02.2.1.2
Additive
THIODIPROPIONATES
TOSOM
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
479
8 / 1999
INS
210-213
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
385, 386
310
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
384
477
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
388, 389
8 / 1999
479
8 / 1999
Comments
Note 46
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
20000mg/kg
200 mg/kg
5000 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Note 21
Note 46
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
210-213
8 / 2001
310
8 / 2001
477
8 / 2001
02.4
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
GALLATE, PROPYL
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Max Level
200 mg/kg
5000 mg/kg
02.3
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
BENZOATES
GALLATE, PROPYL
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
INS
388, 389
02.2.2
Additive
BENZOATES
EDTAs
GALLATE, PROPYL
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
THIODIPROPIONATES
TOSOM
Max Level
500 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
30000mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 13
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
210-213
8 / 2001
150c
8 / 1999
150d
310
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
477
8 / 2001
Max Level
80 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
50 mg/kg
10000mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 13
Page 5 of 32
03.0
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
FAST GREEN FCF
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
150c
150d
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
143
8 / 1999
477
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
5000 mg/kg
Comments
Notes 10 & 15
Page 6 of 32
04.1.1.2
Additive
ORTHO-PHENYLPHENOLS
POLYETHYLENE GLYCOL
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
Additive
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Max Level
12 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
Comments
Note 49
Dried fruit
04.1.2.3
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
Max Level
80 mg/kg
265 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 21
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
150c
8 / 1999
150d
900a
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
04.1.2.4
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
10 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
143
900a
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
512
8 / 2001
04.1.2.5
Additive
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
FAST GREEN FCF
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
304, 305
385, 386
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
FAST GREEN FCF
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
STANNOUS CHLORIDE
1521
1201
INS
Additive
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
04.1.2.2
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
EDTAs
Max Level
GMP
GMP
200 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
20 mg/kg
Comments
Note 43
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
150c
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
143
900a
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
GMP
1500 mg/kg
130 mg/kg
400 mg/kg
30 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Note 21
04.1.2.6
INS
210-213
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
900a
8 / 1999
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Note 21
Page 7 of 32
04.1.2.7
Additive
ALUMINIUM AMMONIUM SULPHATE
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Additive
BENZOATES
150d
8 / 1999
INS
210-213
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
150c
150d
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
477
8 / 2001
Comments
Note 6
Note 13
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
7500 mg/kg
7500 mg/kg
40000mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
210-213
150c
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
310
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
900a
477
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
Max Level
500 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
90 mg/kg
110 mg/kg
40000mg/kg
Comments
Notes 2 & 10
Note 13
Note 2
04.1.2.11
04.1.2.12
Max Level
200 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
INS
210-213
Additive
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
04.1.2.10
Additive
BENZOATES
210-213
150c
04.1.2.9
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
GALLATE, PROPYL
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
04.1.2.8
Additive
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Candied fruit
INS
523
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
477
8 / 2001
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
7500 mg/kg
7500 mg/kg
650 mg/kg
40000mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Note 21
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Page 8 of 32
04.2.2.1
04.2.2.2
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
EDTAs
GALLATE, PROPYL
INS
304, 305
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
385, 386
8 / 2001
310
8 / 2001
Max Level
10 mg/kg
Comments
Note 15
Max Level
80 mg/kg
800 mg/kg
50 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Notes 21& 64
Note 76
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
150c
150d
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
385, 386
143
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
579
585
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
900a
8 / 1999
04.2.2.4
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
FAST GREEN FCF
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
STANNOUS CHLORIDE
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
04.2.2.3
Additive
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
FAST GREEN FCF
FERROUS GLUCONATE
FERROUS LACTATE
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Additive
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Max Level
2000 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
250 mg/kg
300 mg/kg
150 mg/kg
150 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Note 21
Notes 23 & 48
Notes 23 & 48
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
385, 386
143
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
900a
512
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
04.2.2.5
Max Level
GMP
GMP
365 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
25 mg/kg
Comments
Note 21
Note 43
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
900a
8 / 1999
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
250 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Note 21
Page 9 of 32
04.2.2.6
Additive
ALUMINIUM AMMONIUM SULPHATE
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Additive
BENZOATES
EDTAs
INS
523
210-213
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
150c
150d
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
385, 386
477
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
04.2.2.7
210-213
385, 386
04.2.2.8
Max Level
200 mg/kg
3000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
80 mg/kg
5000 mg/kg
Comments
Note 6
Note 13
Note 21
Additive
BENZOATES
EDTAs
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
250 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Note 21
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
250 mg/kg
Comments
Note 13
Note 21
Page 10 of 32
05.0
05.1
05.1.3
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
INS
901
902
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
903
904
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 15
Max Level
GMP
GMP
50 mg/kg
Comments
Note 21
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
Comments
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
903
8 / 2001
900a
8 / 1999
904
8 / 2001
05.2
Additive
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
CANDELILLA WAX
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
CARNAUBA WAX
GALLATE, PROPYL
MICROCRYSTALLINE WAX
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
SHELLAC
Comments
Notes 10,15&114
05.1.5
Additive
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
CANDELILLA WAX
CARNAUBA WAX
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
SHELLAC
Max Level
500 mg/kg
05.1.4
Additive
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
CANDELILLA WAX
CARNAUBA WAX
SHELLAC
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
INS
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Additive
GALLATE, PROPYL
Confectionery
INS
304, 305
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
10 mg/kg
GMP
Comments
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
902
150c
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
903
310
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
905ci
8 / 2001
900a
8 / 1999
477
8 / 2001
904
8 / 2001
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
200 mg/kg
GMP
10 mg/kg
5000 mg/kg
GMP
Comments
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
Note 15
Note 3
Note 3
Page 11 of 32
05.2
INS
Additive
05.3
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
CYCLODEXTRIN, BETAFAST GREEN FCF
GALLATE, PROPYL
GUAIAC RESIN
MICROCRYSTALLINE WAX
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
POLYETHYLENE GLYCOL
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
STEARYL CITRATE
Comments
Comments
Chewing gum
INS
150c
150d
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
459
8 / 2001
143
310
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
314
905ci
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
900a
1521
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
1201
477
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
Max Level
20000mg/kg
20000mg/kg
20000mg/kg
300 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
1500 mg/kg
20000mg/kg
100 mg/kg
20000mg/kg
10000mg/kg
20000mg/kg
484
8 / 1999
15000mg/kg
05.4
Additive
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
CANDELILLA WAX
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
CARNAUBA WAX
GALLATE, PROPYL
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
SHELLAC
Step/Yr
Note 3
310
8 / 2001
477
8 / 2001
Max Level
4000 mg/kg
4000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
4000 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
40000mg/kg
904
8 / 2001
4000 mg/kg
901
902
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
150c
150d
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
903
8 / 2001
Comments
Note 15
Page 12 of 32
06.1
INS
310
Additive
GALLATE, PROPYL
06.2
Additive
ALPHA-AMYLASE (ASPERGILLUS
ORYZAE VAR.)
AZODICARBONAMIDE
CHLORINE
CHLORINE DIOXIDE
PROTEASE (A. ORYZAE VAR.)
Additive
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
927a
925
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
926
1101i
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
Max Level
100 mg/kg
Comments
Max Level
GMP
45 mg/kg
2500 mg/kg
2500 mg/kg
GMP
Comments
Note 87
Note 87
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
310
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
06.4.2
Max Level
200 mg/kg
6500 mg/kg
2500 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 15
06.5
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
GALLATE, PROPYL
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
INS
1100
INS
Additive
GALLATE, PROPYL
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
06.3
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
GALLATE, PROPYL
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
100 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
310
8 / 2001
477
8 / 2001
06.6
Max Level
500 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
315 mg/kg
90 mg/kg
40000mg/kg
Comments
Notes 2 & 10
Note 21
Note 2
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
10 mg/kg
Comments
Page 13 of 32
07.0
Additive
CARNAUBA WAX
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Comments
Note 3
Notes 11 & 72
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
100 mg/kg
Comments
07.2
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
100 mg/kg
Comments
Note 15
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
150c
143
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
904
8 / 2001
07.2.1
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
100 mg/kg
GMP
Comments
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
07.2.2
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
Comments
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Max Level
GMP
15000mg/kg
07.1.3
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
8 / 2001
143
Additive
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
CANDELILLA WAX
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
FAST GREEN FCF
SHELLAC
477
INS
Additive
GALLATE, PROPYL
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
07.1.1
Additive
FAST GREEN FCF
Bakery wares
INS
903
150d
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
1200 mg/kg
Comments
07.2.3
INS
150d
310
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
Max Level
GMP
200 mg/kg
Comments
Page 14 of 32
08.0
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
Comments
Notes 3 & 4
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
310
8 / 2001
08.2.1.2
Max Level
GMP
200 mg/kg
Comments
Notes 3 & 4
Note 15
Cured (including salted) and dried nonheat treated processed meat, poultry,
and game products in whole pieces or
cuts
INS
384
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
235
8 / 2001
08.3
Max Level
200 mg/kg
6 mg/kg
Comments
08.3.1.2
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
384
235
08.3.2
Comments
Note 3
08.2
Additive
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
PIMARICIN
Max Level
GMP
GMP
INS
384
Additive
GALLATE, PROPYL
8 / 1999
08.1.2
Additive
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
PIMARICIN
150d
143
Additive
FAST GREEN FCF
GALLATE, PROPYL
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
INS
Additive
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
INS
150c
08.1
Additive
FAST GREEN FCF
Max Level
200 mg/kg
20 mg/kg
Comments
Notes 3 & 81
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
35 mg/kg
Comments
Note 21
Page 15 of 32
08.3.2
INS
Additive
Max Level
Comments
08.4
INS
304, 305
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
143
8 / 1999
Max Level
5000 mg/kg
GMP
Comments
Note 10
Notes 3 & 4
Page 16 of 32
09.1
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Additive
FAST GREEN FCF
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Notes 3 & 50
Notes 3 & 50
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Note 50
Note 50
09.2.2
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
75 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 21
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
388, 389
8 / 1999
09.2.4
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
75 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 21
Notes 15 & 46
09.2.4.1
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 6
Additive
FAST GREEN FCF
8 / 1999
09.2.1
Additive
ALUMINIUM AMMONIUM SULPHATE
150d
150c
150d
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
EDTAs
THIODIPROPIONATES
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
INS
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
EDTAs
INS
150c
09.2
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
09.2.5
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
100 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
100 mg/kg
Comments
Page 17 of 32
09.2.5
INS
Additive
GALLATE, PROPYL
09.3.2
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
Max Level
100 mg/kg
Comments
Note 15
09.3.3
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
FAST GREEN FCF
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
310
Additive
EDTAs
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
250 mg/kg
Comments
Note 21
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
143
8 / 1999
09.4
Max Level
GMP
GMP
100 mg/kg
Comments
Note 50
Note 50
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
Max Level
500 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
340 mg/kg
Comments
Note 50
Note 50
Note 21
Page 18 of 32
10.1
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
FAST GREEN FCF
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
INS
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
523
Comments
Notes 3 & 4
Notes 3 & 4
Notes 3 & 4
Max Level
30 mg/kg
Comments
Note 6
10.2.3
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
2500 mg/kg
Comments
Note 47
10.4
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
GALLATE, PROPYL
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
Egg products
INS
1505
Additive
EDTAs
TRIETHYL CITRATE
150d
143
10.2.1
Additive
TRIETHYL CITRATE
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
10.2
Additive
ALUMINIUM AMMONIUM SULPHATE
Fresh eggs
INS
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
Max Level
200 mg/kg
2500 mg/kg
Comments
Notes 21 & 47
Note 47
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
310
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
477
8 / 2001
Max Level
500 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
90 mg/kg
40000mg/kg
Comments
Notes 2 & 10
Note 2
Page 19 of 32
11.1.2
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Additive
POLYETHYLENE GLYCOL
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
11.4
Additive
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
11.6
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
5000 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
1201
8 / 1999
Max Level
10000mg/kg
3000 mg/kg
Comments
Page 20 of 32
12.1
Additive
FERRIC AMMONIUM CITRATE
FERROCYANIDES
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
304, 305
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
Comments
Note 23
Note 24
Note 36
Max Level
500 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
70 mg/kg
20 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 21
Note 24
Note 15
Vinegars
150c
150d
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
1201
8 / 1999
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
GMP
40 mg/kg
Comments
Max Level
GMP
GMP
75 mg/kg
Comments
Mustards
12.4
INS
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
12.5
Note 21
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
150c
8 / 1999
900a
8 / 1999
12.5.1
Max Level
200 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
GMP
10 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 13
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Max Level
25 mg/kg
20 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
INS
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
BENZOATES
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
12.3
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
INS
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
12.2
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
FERROCYANIDES
GALLATE, PROPYL
Salt
INS
381
12.5.2
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
Max Level
3000 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
Max Level
GMP
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 15
Page 21 of 32
12.6
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
FORMATES
GALLATE, PROPYL
8 / 2001
Max Level
1500 mg/kg
1500 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 25
Note 15
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
385, 386
387
8 / 2001
8 / 1998
Max Level
500 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
GMP
Comments
Notes 10 & 15
Note 21
12.6.3
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
75 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 21
12.6.4
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
12.7
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
EDTAs
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
310
304, 305
385, 386
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
INS
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
150d
236
12.6.2
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
EDTAs
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
12.6.1
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
EDTAs
OXYSTEARIN
304, 305
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
150c
8 / 1999
150d
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
100 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Note 21
Protein products
12.9
INS
150c
150d
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Page 22 of 32
13.1
13.2
13.3
13.3.1
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
477
8 / 2001
Max Level
100 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Max Level
100 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Max Level
GMP
GMP
5000 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
477
8 / 2001
Max Level
GMP
GMP
5000 mg/kg
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Food supplements
13.6
Additive
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
CANDELILLA WAX
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
CARNAUBA WAX
EDTAs
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
INS
150c
13.5
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Comments
Note 10
13.4
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
Max Level
50 mg/kg
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
INS
901
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
902
150c
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
903
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
385, 386
8 / 2001
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
150 mg/kg
Comments
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
Note 21
Page 23 of 32
13.6
Food supplements
INS
310
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
1521
1201
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
904
8 / 2001
Max Level
400 mg/kg
70000mg/kg
GMP
GMP
Comments
Note 3
Page 24 of 32
14.1.2
14.1.2.3
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
INS
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
14.1.3.4
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
Comments
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
14.1.4
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
CYCLODEXTRIN, BETADIMETHYL DICARBONATE
EDTAs
FAST GREEN FCF
FORMATES
GALLATE, PROPYL
GLYCEROL ESTER OF WOOD ROSIN
ISOPROPYL CITRATES
OXYSTEARIN
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
POLYETHYLENE GLYCOL
PROPYLENE GLYCOL ESTERS OF
FATTY ACIDS
STANNOUS CHLORIDE
STEARYL CITRATE
SUCROSE ACETATE ISOBUTYRATE
THIODIPROPIONATES
TRIETHYL CITRATE
Max Level
10 mg/kg
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
14.1.3.2
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Additive
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
INS
304, 305
150c
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
459
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
242
8 / 1999
385, 386
143
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
236
310
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
445
384
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
387
900a
8 / 1998
8 / 1999
1521
8 / 2001
477
8 / 2001
512
8 / 2001
484
8 / 1999
444
388, 389
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
1505
8 / 1999
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
GMP
GMP
500 mg/kg
250 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
100 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
150 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
250 mg/kg
20 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
20 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
200 mg/kg
Comments
Notes 10 & 15
Note 18
Note 21
Note 25
Note 15
Note 43
Notes 15 & 46
Page 25 of 32
14.1.4.3
Additive
FERRIC AMMONIUM CITRATE
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
INS
901
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
902
903
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
242
385, 386
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
904
8 / 2001
Comments
Note 23
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
250 mg/kg
35 mg/kg
GMP
Comments
Note 108
Note 108
Note 108
Notes 2 & 18
Note 21
Note 108
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
900a
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
1201
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
10 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
Comments
Note 36
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
900a
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
1201
8 / 1999
14.2.3.3
Max Level
GMP
GMP
10 mg/kg
2 mg/kg
Comments
Note 36
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
14.2.4
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
Max Level
10 mg/kg
500 mg/kg
INS
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
8 / 1999
14.2.2
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
1201
14.2.1
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
POLYVINYLPYRROLIDONE
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
14.1.5
Additive
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
CANDELILLA WAX
CARNAUBA WAX
DIMETHYL DICARBONATE
EDTAs
SHELLAC
14.2.6
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
Comments
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
143
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
100 mg/kg
Comments
Page 26 of 32
14.2.7
Additive
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
FAST GREEN FCF
GLYCEROL ESTER OF WOOD ROSIN
POLYDIMETHYLSILOXANE
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
143
8 / 1999
445
900a
8 / 1999
8 / 1999
Max Level
GMP
GMP
100 mg/kg
60 mg/kg
10 mg/kg
Comments
Page 27 of 32
15.0
Additive
BEESWAX, WHITE AND YELLOW
CANDELILLA WAX
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS III
CARAMEL COLOUR, CLASS IV
CARNAUBA WAX
GALLATE, PROPYL
SHELLAC
THIODIPROPIONATES
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
902
150c
8 / 2001
8 / 1999
150d
903
8 / 1999
8 / 2001
310
904
8 / 2001
8 / 2001
388, 389
8 / 1999
15.1
304, 305
15.2
Max Level
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
GMP
200 mg/kg
GMP
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 3
Note 3
Note 3
Note 15
Note 3
Note 46
Additive
ASCORBYL ESTERS
Ready-to-eat savouries
INS
901
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Step/Yr
8 / 2001
Max Level
200 mg/kg
Comments
Note 10
Page 28 of 32
16.0
Step/Yr
8 / 1999
150d
8 / 1999
Max Level
1000 mg/kg
1000 mg/kg
Comments
Page 29 of 32
Notes to the Comments for the General Standard for Food Additives - Provisions
th
Adopted at Step 8 (as of 24 CAC)
Notes in bold apply to the adopted provisions.
Note 1: As adipic acid
Note 2: On dry ingredient, dry weight, dry mix or concentrate basis.
Note 3: Surface treatment.
Note 4: For decoration, stamping, marking or branding the product.
Note 5: Used in raw materials for manufacture of the finished food.
Note 6: As aluminium.
Note 7: Use level not in finished food.
Note 8: As bixin.
Note 9: As total bixin or norbixin.
Note 10: As ascorbyl stearate.
Note 11: Flour basis.
Note 12: Carryover from flavouring substances.
Note 13: As benzoic acid.
Note 14: Served at greater than 5-fold dilution.
Note 15: Fat or oil basis.
Note 16: For use in glaze, coatings or decorations for fruit, vegetables, meat or fish.
Note 17: As cyclamic acid.
Note 18: Added level; residue not detected in ready-to-eat food.
Note 19: Used in cocoa fat; use level on ready-to-eat basis.
Note 20: On total amount of stabilizers, thickeners and/or gums.
Note 21: As anhydrous calcium disodium EDTA.
Note 22: For use in smoked fish products only.
Note 23: As iron.
Note 24: As anhydrous sodium ferrocyanide.
Note 25: As formic acid.
Note 26: For use in baking powder only.
Note 27: As p-hydroxybenzoic acid.
Note 28: ADI conversion: if a typical preparation contains 0.025 g/U, then the ADI of 33,000 U/kg bw
becomes:
[(33000 U/kg bw) x (0.025 g/U) x (1 mg/1000 g)] = 0.825 mg/kg bw
Note 29: Reporting basis not specified.
Note 30:As residual NO 3 ion.
Note 31: Of the mash used.
Note 32: As residual NO 2 ion.
Note 33: As phosphorus.
Note 34: Anhydrous basis.
Note 35: Except for use in special formula at 20,000 mg/kg.
Note 36: Residual level.
Note 37: As weight of nonfat milk solids.
Note 38: Level in creaming mixture.
Note 39: Only when product contains butter or other fats and oils.
Note 40: Except for use in special formula at 200 mg/kg.
Page 30 of 32
Page 31 of 32
Page 32 of 32
Page 1 of 6
Table 3:
Additives Permitted for Use in Food in General, Unless otherwise Specified, in Accordance
with GMP
INS No.
260
472a
1422
1414
1401
406
400
1402
1100
1100
1100
1100
1100
1100
559
264
403
503i
510
380
503ii
527
328
300
162
1403
1101iii
263
404
556
302
170i
509
333
578
623
629
526
633
327
352ii
Additive
Acetic acid
Acetic and fatty acid esters of glycerol
Acetylated distarch adipate
Acetylated distarch phosphate
Acid treated starch
Agar
Alginic acid
Alkaline treated starch
Alpha-amylase (aspergillus oryzae var.)
Alpha-amylase (bacillus megaterium expressed in b. Subtilis)
Alpha-amylase (bacillus stearothermophilus expressed in b. Subtilus)
Alpha-amylase (bacillus stearothermophilus)
Alpha-amylase (bacillus subtilus)
Alpha-amylase (carbohydrase) (bacillus licheniformis)
Aluminium silicate
Ammonium acetate
Ammonium alginate
Ammonium carbonate
Ammonium chloride
Ammonium citrate
Ammonium hydrogen carbonate
Ammonium hydroxide
Ammonium lactate
Ascorbic acid
Beet red
Bleached starch
Bromelain
Calcium acetate
Calcium alginate
Calcium aluminium silicate
Calcium ascorbate
Calcium carbonate
Calcium chloride
Calcium citrate
Calcium gluconate
Calcium glutamate, Dl-LCalcium guanylate, 5'Calcium hydroxide
Calcium inosinate, 5'Calcium lactate
Calcium malate, D, L-
529
282
634
552
516
150a
290
410
407
140
1001
330
472c
424
1400
628
632
627
631
635
1412
1405
315
968
462
467
297
458
418
575
1102
620
422
626
412
414
507
463
1442
464
1440
630
1202
953
416
Calcium oxide
Calcium propionate
Calcium ribonucleotides, 5'Calcium silicate
Calcium sulphate
Caramel colour, class 1
Carbon dioxide
Carob bean gum
Carrageenan
Chlorophylls
Choline salts
Citric acid
Citric and fatty acid esters of glycerol
Curdlan
Dextrins, white and yellow, roasted starch
Dipotassium guanylate, 5'Dipotassium inosinate, 5'Disodium guanylate, 5'Disodium inosinate, 5'Disodium ribonucleotides, 5'Distarch phosphate
Enzyme treated starch
Erythorbic acid
Erythritol
Ethyl cellulose
Ethyl hydroxyethyl cellulose
Fumaric acid
Gamma cyclodextrin
Gellan gum
Glucono delta-lactone
Glucose oxidase (aspergillus niger, var.)
Glutamic acid, LGlycerol
Guanylic acid, 5'Guar gum
Gum arabic
Hydrochloric acid
Hydroxypropyl cellulose
Hydroxypropyl distarch phosphate
Hydroxypropyl methyl cellulose
Hydroxypropyl starch
Inosinic acid, 5'Insoluble polyvinylpyrrolidone
Isomalt
Karaya gum
Page 2 of 6
425
270
472b
966
322
1104
1104
504i
511
580
625
504ii
528
329
530
553i
296
965
421
461
465
460i
471
624
622
621
1410
941
942
1404
1101ii
440
1413
1200
964
261
402
303
501i
508
332i
577
501ii
351i
525
Konjac flour
Lactic acid
Lactic and fatty acid esters of glycerol
Lactitol
Lecithin
Lipase (animal sources)
Lipase (aspergillus oryzae, var.)
Magnesium carbonate
Magnesium chloride
Magnesium gluconate
Magnesium glutamate, Dl-LMagnesium hydrogen carbonate
Magnesium hydroxide
Magnesium lactate, D,LMagnesium oxide
Magnesium silicate (synthetic)
Malic acid, D,LMaltitol (including maltitol syrup)
Mannitol
Methyl cellulose
Methyl ethyl cellulose
Microcrystalline cellulose
Mono- and diglycerides
Monoammonium glutamate, LMonopotassium glutamate, LMonosodium glutamate, LMonostarch phosphate
Nitrogen
Nitrous oxide
Oxidized starch
Papain
Pectins (amidated and non-amidated)
Phosphated distarch phosphate
Polydextroses
Polyglycitol syrup
Potassium acetates
Potassium alginate
Potassium ascorbate
Potassium carbonate
Potassium chloride
Potassium dihydrogen citrate
Potassium gluconate
Potassium hydrogen carbonate
Potassium hydrogen malate, D, LPotassium hydroxide
Page 3 of 6
326
351ii
283
515
460ii
407a
944
280
1100i
470
470
551
262i
401
554
301
500i
466
469
331i
316
365
576
500ii
350i
524
325
350ii
281
500iii
514
420
1420
1450
553iii
417
472f
957
171
413
1518
380
332ii
331iii
415
967
Page 4 of 6
Page 5 of 6
ANNEX TO TABLE 3
FOOD CATEGORIES OR INDIVIDUAL FOOD ITEMS EXCLUDED FROM THE
GENERAL CONDITIONS OF TABLE THREE
The use of additives listed in Table Three in the following foods is governed by the provisions in Tables
One and Two.
CATEGORY
NUMBER
FOOD CATEGORY
01.1.1
01.2
Fermented and renneted milk products (plain) excluding food category 01.1.2
(dairy based drinks)
01.4.1
Pasteurized cream
01.4.2
02.1
02.2.1.1
04.1.1
Fresh fruit
04.1.1.2
04.1.1.3
04.2.1
Fresh vegetables
04.2.1.2
04.2.1.3
4.2.2.1
Frozen vegetables
06.1
06.2
06.4
08.1.1
08.1.2
09.1
Fresh fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans and echinoderms
09.2
Processed fish and fish products, including mollusks, crustaceans and echinoderms
10.1
Fresh eggs
10.2.1
10.2.2
11.1
White and semi-white sugar (sucrose or saccharose), fructose, glucose (dextrose), xylose;
sugar solutions and syrups, also (partially) inverted sugars, including molasses, treacle and
sugar toppings
11.2
Other sugars and syrups (e.g., brown sugar and maple syrup)
Page 6 of 6
11.3
Honey
12.1
Salt
12.2
Herbs, spices, seasoning (including salt substitutes) and condiments (Only herbs and salt
substitutes)
12.8
Yeast
13.1
13.2
14.1.1.1
Natural mineral waters and source waters (Only natural mineral waters)
14.1.2.1
14.1.2.3
14.1.3.1
14.1.3.3
14.1.5
Coffee, coffee substitutes, tea, herbal infusions, and other hot cereal beverages, excluding
cocoa
14.2.3
Wines
Page 1 of 20
PREAMBLE
1.1
SCOPE
This Standard contains the main principles and procedures which are used and recommended by the Codex
Alimentarius in dealing with contaminants and toxins in foods and feeds, and lists the maximum levels of
contaminants and natural toxicants in foods and feeds which are recommended by the CAC to be applied to
commodities moving in international trade.
1.2
DEFINITION OF TERMS
1.2.1
General
The definitions for the purpose of the Codex Alimentarius, as mentioned in Volume 1, are applicable to the
GSC and only the most important ones are repeated here. Some new definitions are introduced, where this
seems warranted to obtain optimal clarity. When reference is made to foods, this also applies to animal feed,
in those cases where this is appropriate.
1.2.2
Contaminant
1)
Contaminants having only food quality significance, but no public health significance, in the
food(s).
2)
Pesticide residues, as defined by the Codex definition that are within the terms of reference
of the CCPR. Pesticide residues arising from pesticide uses not associated with food
production may be considered for inclusion in the General Standard for Contaminants if not
dealt with by the CCPR.
3)
Residues of veterinary drugs, as defined by the Codex definition, that are within the terms of
reference of the CCRVDF.
The Preamble to the Codex General Standard for Contaminants and Toxins in Foods was adopted by the 21st
Session of the Codex Alimentarius Commission in July 1995. Annexes I-III, the introduction to Annex IV and Annex V
were adopted by the Commission at its 22nd Session, 1997. Annex IV-A and Annex IV-B concerning the Annotated List
of Contaminants and Toxins have still to be developed.
1.2.3
Page 2 of 20
4)
5)
The Codex definition of a contaminant implicitly includes naturally occurring toxicants such as are produced
as toxic metabolites of certain microfungi that are not intentionally added to food (mycotoxins).
Microbial toxins that are produced by algae and that may be accumulated in edible aquatic organisms such as
shellfish (phycotoxins) are also included in this standard. Mycotoxins and phycotoxins are both subclasses of
contaminants.
Inherent natural toxicants that are implicit constituents of foods resulting from a genus, species or strain
ordinarily producing hazardous levels of a toxic metabolite(s), i.e. phytotoxins are not generally considered
within the scope of this standard. They are, however, within the terms of reference of the CCFAC and will
be dealt with on a case by case basis.
1.2.4
The Codex maximum level (ML) for a contaminant in a food or feed commodity is the maximum
concentration of that substance recommended by the CAC to be legally permitted in that commodity.
A Codex guideline level (GL) is the maximum level of a substance in a food or feed commodity which is
recommended by the CAC to be acceptable for commodities moving in international trade. When the GL is
exceeded, governments should decide whether and under what circumstances the food should be distributed
within their territory or jurisdiction. 2
1.3
1.3.1
General
Foods and feeds can become contaminated by various causes and processes. Contamination generally has a
negative impact on the quality of the food or feed and may imply a risk to human or animal health.
Contaminant levels in foods shall be as low as reasonably achievable. The following actions may serve to
prevent or to reduce contamination of foods and feeds:
Because the CAC has decided that the preferred format of a Codex standard in food or feed is a maximum level,
the present existing or proposed guideline levels shall be reviewed for their possible conversion to a maximum level.
Page 3 of 20
To ensure that adequate action is taken to reduce contamination of food and feed a Code of Practice shall be
elaborated comprising source related measures and Good Manufacturing Practice as well as Good
Agricultural Practice in relation to the specific contamination problem.
The degree of contamination of foods and feeds and the effect of actions to reduce contamination shall be
assessed by monitoring, survey programs and more specialized research programs, where necessary.
When there are indications that health hazards may be involved with consumption of foods that are
contaminated, it is necessary that a risk assessment is made. When health concerns can be substantiated, a
risk management policy must be applied, based on a thorough evaluation of the situation. Depending on the
assessment of the problems and the possible solutions, it may be necessary to establish maximum levels or
other measures governing the contamination of foods. In special cases, it may also have to be considered to
give dietary recommendations, when other measures are not sufficiently adequate to exclude the possibility of
hazards to health.
National measures regarding food contamination should avoid the creation of unnecessary barriers to
international trade in food or feed commodities. The purpose of the Codex General Standard for
Contaminants in Food is to provide guidance about the possible approach of the contamination problem and to
promote international harmonization through recommendations which may help to avoid the creation of trade
barriers.
For all contaminants, which may be present in more than one food or feed item, a broad approach shall be
applied, taking into account all relevant information that is available, for the assessment of risks and for the
development of recommendations and measures, including the setting of maximum levels.
1.3.2
Maximum levels shall only be set for those foods in which the contaminant may be found in amounts that are
significant for the total exposure of the consumer. They shall be set in such a way that the consumer is
adequately protected. At the same time the technological possibilities to comply with maximum levels shall
be taken into account. The principles of Good Manufacturing Practice, Good Veterinary Practice and Good
Agricultural Practice shall be used. Maximum levels shall be based on sound scientific principles leading to
levels which are acceptable worldwide, so that international trade in these foods is facilitated. Maximum
levels shall be clearly defined with respect to status and intended use.
I.3.3
Specific criteria
The following criteria shall (not preventing the use of other relevant criteria) be considered when developing
recommendations and making decisions in connection with the Codex General Standard for Contaminants in
Food: (Further details about these criteria are given in Annex I).
Toxicological information
identification of the toxic substance(s)
metabolism by humans and animals, as appropriate
toxicokinetics and toxicodynamics
information about acute and long term toxicity and other relevant toxicity
integrated toxicological expert advice regarding the acceptability and safety of intake levels
of contaminants, including information on any population groups which are specially
vulnerable
Analytical data
validated qualitative and quantitative data on representative samples
Page 4 of 20
Intake data
presence in foods of dietary significance for the contaminant intake
presence in foods that are widely consumed
food intake data for average and most exposed consumer groups
results from total diet studies
calculated contaminant intake data from food consumption models
data on intake by susceptible groups
Fair trade considerations
existing or potential problems in international trade
commodities concerned moving in international trade
information about national regulations, in particular on the data and considerations on which
these regulations are based
Technological cons iderations
information about contamination processes, technological possibilities, production and
manufacturing practices and economic aspects related to contaminant level management and
control.
Risk assessment and risk management considerations
risk assessment
risk management options and considerations
consideration of possible maximum levels in foods based on the criteria mentioned above.
consideration of alternative solutions
1.4
CODEX PROCEDURE FOR ESTABLISHING STANDARDS FOR CONTAMINANTS IN
FOOD
1.4.1
General
The Procedure for the elaboration of Codex Standards, as contained in the Procedural Manual, is applicable.
Further details are mentioned here regarding the procedure to be followed and the criteria for decision
making, in order to clarify and to facilitate the process of the elaboration of Codex Standards for
contaminants.
1.4.2
Identification of the contaminant and concise information about the background of the
problem.
2)
Indications about the availability of toxicological information and analytical and intake data,
including references.
3)
Page 5 of 20
4)
5)
6)
When a delegation wishes that the Committee shall consider a request for action concerning a specific
contaminant this delegation shall, as far as possible, supply information as stated above to serve as the basis
for a preliminary review and request the Secretariat to include the matter on the agenda of the next meeting
of the Committee.
1.4.3
An evaluation by JECFA of the toxicological and of other aspects of a contaminant and subsequent
recommendations regarding the acceptable intake and regarding maximum levels in foods shall be the main
basis for decisions to be discussed by the CCFAC. In the absence of recommendations by JECFA, decisions
may be taken by CCFAC when sufficient information from other sources is available to the Committee and
the matter is considered urgent.
The CCFAC procedure for risk management decisions is further described in Annex II.
1.5
The General Standard for Contaminants in Foods contains two types of presentation for the Standards:
Schedule I in which the standards are listed per contaminant in the various food categories, and Schedule II
in which the contaminant standards are presented per food (category).
The format of the presentation is according to the provisions described in the Procedural Manual, in so far
they are applicable. In order to obtain maximal clarity, explanatory notes shall be added where appropriate.
The format contains all elements necessary for full understanding of the meaning, background, application
and scope of the standards and contains references to the relevant documents and discussion reports on
which the standard is based.
A full description of the format is given in Annex III.
The listing of the Codex Standards for the different contaminants may be according to a numbering system
for contaminants (see Annex IV). The Codex standards are summarized in a list of contents, and an
alphabetical listing of the contaminants shall be added for easy reference.
For each session of the CCFAC, a working document shall be prepared in which the complete list of Codex
Standards for contaminants in foods (both proposed and agreed) is presented in the form of Schedule I.
The list of Codex contaminant standards for individual foods or food categories shall be presented according
to an agreed food categorization system. See Annex V.
1.6
The contaminant provisions for this Standard shall be reviewed on a regular basis and revised as necessary in
the light of revisions of toxicological advice by JECFA or of changed risk management views, residue
management possibilities, scientific knowledge or other important relevant developments.
Specific attention shall be given to the review of existing Maximum Levels and Guideline Levels and to their
possible conversion to Maximum Levels.
Page 6 of 20
ANNEX I
CRITERIA FOR THE ESTABLISHMENT OF MAXIMUM LEVELS IN FOODS
Introduction
In this Annex criteria are mentioned regarding information which is considered necessary for evaluating
contaminant problems in foods and for the establishment of maximum levels. It is therefore important that
these criteria are taken into account when information is supplied to JECFA and/or to the CCFAC.
The criteria mentioned here are elaborated in more detail than in section I.3.3. of the Preamble. Only those
aspects are mentioned that need further clarification, so criteria or aspects that are not mentioned here should
not be ruled out in the evaluation process.
Toxicological information
Integrated toxicological expert advice regarding a safe/tolerable intake level of a contaminant is
essential when decisions about maximum levels in foods are considered. A recommendation from JECFA
regarding the maximum allowable or tolerable intake, based on a full evaluation of an adequate toxicological
data base, shall be the main basis for decisions by CCFAC. In urgent cases, it may be possible to rely on
less developed evaluations from JECFA or on toxicological expert advice from other international or national
bodies.
When toxicological information is presented in relation to proposals for maximum levels for contaminants in
foods, indications are desirable about the following aspects:
-
Analytical data
Validated qualitative and quantitative analytical data on representative samples should be supplied.
Information on the analytical and sampling methods used and on the validation of the results is desirable. A
statement on the representativity of the samples for the contamination of the product in general (e.g. on a
national basis) should be added. The portion of the commodity that was analyzed and to which the
contaminant content is related should be clearly stated and preferably should be equivalent to the definition of
the commodity for this purpose or to existing related residue regulation.
Appropriate sampling procedures should be applied. Special attention to this aspect is necessary in the
case of contaminants that may be unequally distributed in the product (e.g. mycotoxins in some commodities).
Intake data
It is desirable to have information about the contaminant concentrations in those foods or food groups that
(together) are responsible for at least half and preferably 80% or more of the total dietary intake of the
contaminant, both for average consumers and for high consumers.
Page 7 of 20
Information about the presence of the contaminant in foods that are widely consumed (staple foods) is
desirable in order to be able to make a satisfactory assessment of the contaminant intake and of risks
associated with food trade.
Food consumption data for average, most exposed and susceptible consumer groups are desirable for
evaluations of (potential) intake of contaminants. This problem, however, has to be addressed differently on
a national and on an international scale. It is therefore important to have information about both average and
high consumption patterns regarding a wide scale of foodstuffs, so that for every contaminant the most
exposed consumer groups may be identified. Detailed information about high consumption patterns is
desirable, both regarding group identification criteria (e.g. age or sex differences, vegetarian or regional
dietary customs, etc.) and statistical aspects.
Dietary intake of contaminants: Reference is made to the Guidelines for the study of dietary intake of
chemical contaminants (WHO). It is important to supply all relevant details, such as the type of study
(duplicate diet, total diet or market basket study, selective study), and statistical details. Calculated
contaminant intake data from food consumption models may also be useful. When results about food groups
and about effects of preparation and cooking etc. are available, these should also be supplied.
Fair trade considerations
Existing, expected or potential problems in international trade: In order to assess the urgency of a
problem to be discussed by CCFAC it is important to have information about the magnitude of existing or
expected problems, both regarding the amount and the source of the food or feed that is at stake and the
concerned parties and economic aspects involved. Potential problems should also be indicated.
Foods concerned moving in international trade: The main exporting and importing countries for
commodities which are involved in the issue should be identified and it is essential that information is available
about contaminant concentrations in the commodities originating from the main exporting countries.
Information about national regulations: It is desirable that details are made available by countries
(especially the main exporting and importing countries) about their national regulations regarding the
contaminant in question, in particular on the data and the considerations on which these regulations are based.
For a good evaluation of the problem it is essential that not only the data base is clear, but also the risk
assessment and risk management policy which is used for making decisions regarding maximum levels in
foods.
Technological considerations
Information about the source of the contaminant and the way in which the food is contaminated, possibly
including information, if it is available, about contamination being present in parts only of the product, is
essential for assessing the possibilities to control the contamination process and to be able to guarantee a
desired product quality. Where possible Source-related measures should be proposed.
Good
Manufacturing Practice (GMP) and/or Good Agricultural Practice (GAP) should also be formulated to
control a contamination problem. When this is possible, maximum levels may be based on GMP or GAP
considerations and may thus be established at a level as low as reasonably achievable. Considerations
regarding the technological possibilities to control a contamination problem, e.g. by cleaning, should also be
taken into account when a primary risk assessment model (theoretical maximum daily intake) shows possible
intakes exceeding the toxicological maximum intake recommendation. In such a case the possibilities of
lower contamination levels need further careful examination. Then a detailed study about all the aspects
involved is necessary, so that decisions about maximum limits can be based on a thorough evaluation of both
the public health arguments and the possibilities and problems to comply with the proposed standard.
Page 8 of 20
Page 9 of 20
MLs shall be set only for those contaminants that present both a significant risk to public health and a
known or expected problem in international trade.
MLs shall be set only for those foods that are significant for the total exposure of the consumer to
the contaminant
MLs shall be set as low as reasonably achievable. Providing it is acceptable from the toxicological
point of view, MLs shall be set at a level which is (slightly) higher than the normal range of variation
in levels in foods that are produced with current adequate technological methods, in order to avoid
undue disruptions of food production and trade. Where possible, MLs shall be based on GMP and/or
GAP considerations in which the health concerns have been incorporated as a guiding principle to
achieve contaminant levels as low as reasonably achievable. Foods that are evidently contaminated
by local situations or processing conditions that can be avoided by reasonably achievable means shall
be excluded in this evaluation, unless a higher ML can be shown to be acceptable from a public
health point of view and appreciable economic aspects are at stake.
Proposals for MLs in products shall be based on data from at least various countries and sources,
encompassing the main production areas/processes of those products, as far as they are engaged in
international trade. When there is evidence that contamination patterns are sufficiently understood
and will be comparable on a global scale, more limited data may be enough.
MLs may be set for product groups when sufficient information is available about the contamination
pattern for the whole group, or when there are other arguments that extrapolation is appropriate.
Numerical values for MLs shall preferably be regular figures in a geometric scale ( 0.01, 0.02, 0.05,
0.1, 0.2, 0.5, 1, 2, 5 etc.), unless this may pose problems in the acceptability of the MLs.
MLs shall apply to representative samples per lot. If necessary, appropriate methods of sampling
shall be specified.
MLs should not be lower than a level which can be analyzed with methods of analysis that can be
readily applied in normal product control laboratories, unless public health considerations necessitate
a lower detection limit which can only be controlled by means of a more elaborate method of
analysis. In all cases, however, a validated method of analysis should be available with which a ML
can be controlled.
The contaminant as it should be analyzed and to which the ML applies should be clearly defined.
The definition may include important metabolites when this is appropriate from an analytical or
toxicological point of view. It may also be aimed at indicator substances which are chosen from a
group of related contaminants.
The product as it should be analyzed and to which the ML applies, should be clearly defined. In
general, MLs are set on primary products. MLs shall in general preferably be expressed as a level
of the contaminant related to the product as it is, on a fresh weight basis. In some cases, however,
there may be valid arguments to prefer expression on a dry weight basis. Preferably the product shall
be defined as it moves in trade, with provisions where necessary for the removal of inedible parts
that might disturb the preparation of the sample and the analysis. The product definitions used by the
Page 10 of 20
CCPR and contained in the Classification of foods and feeds may serve as guidance on this subject;
other product definitions should only be used for specified reasons. For contaminant purposes,
however, analysis and consequently MLs will preferably be on the basis of the edible part of the
product.
For fat soluble contaminants which may accumulate in animal products, provisions should be applied
regarding the application of the ML to products with various fat content (comparable to the
provisions for fat soluble pesticides).
-
Guidance is desirable regarding the possible application of MLs established for primary products to
processed products and multi-ingredient products. When products are concentrated, dried or diluted,
use of the concentration or dilution factor is generally appropriate in order to be able to obtain a
primary judgement of the contaminant levels in these processed products. The maximum
contaminant concentration in a multi-ingredient food can likewise be calculated from the composition
of the food. Information regarding the behaviour of the contaminant during processing (e.g. washing,
peeling, extraction, cooking, drying etc.) is however desirable to give more adequate guidance here.
When contaminant levels are consistently different in processed products related to the primary
products from which they are derived, and sufficient information is available about the contamination
pattern, it may be appropriate to establish separate maximum levels for these processed products.
This also applies when contamination may occur during processing. In general however, maximum
levels should preferably be set for primary agricultural products and may be applied to processed,
derived and multi-ingredient foods by using appropriate factors. When these factors are sufficiently
known, they should be added to the data base about the contaminant and mentioned in connection to
the maximum level in a product.
MLs shall preferably not be set higher than is acceptable in a primary (theoretical maximum intake
and risk estimation) approach of their acceptability from a public health point of view. When this
poses problems in relation to other criteria for establishing MLs, further evaluations are necessary
regarding the possibilities to reduce the contaminant levels, e.g. by improving GAP and/or GMP
conditions. When this does not bring a satisfactory solution, further refined risk assessment and
contaminant risk management evaluations will have to be made in order to try to reach agreement
about an acceptable ML.
Page 11 of 20
For contaminants and natural toxins in food, essentially the same procedure is used. Food consumption
patterns with a higher intake of critical foods may be used in the intake calculations when this is part of an
accepted national or international health protection and risk management policy. A harmonized approach
using an appropriate intake estimation model that is as realistic as possible is recommended. Calculated data
should where possible always be compared with measured intake data. Proposals for Codex MLs should be
accompanied by intake calculations and risk assessment conclusions regarding their acceptability and use.
Statements from Governments about the (non-acceptance of (proposed) Codex MLs should refer to
specified intake calculations and risk management conclusions which support this position.
Page 12 of 20
ANNEX II
PROCEDURE FOR RISK MANAGEMENT DECISIONS
Introduction
The recommended procedure for risk management decisions in the CCFAC is presented here as a simple
decision scheme based on the main criteria, mentioned in the Preamble, I.4.2. Criterion (1), basic information
about the contaminant (problem) is not further mentioned, because it is considered a prerequisite, without
which no sensible discussion can take place, hazard identification and characterization. Criterion (5),
technological and economic aspects, is an essential tool for making recommendations about the risk
management of the contaminant problem and for developing MLs, and when this information is not adequate,
further data shall be requested. Bearing this in mind, it need not be further mentioned in the decision scheme,
which is shown below. Decisions can be based on the availability of information (- or + or ?) on the
following criteria:
(2a)
Tox
toxicological information,
(3)
PHP
(2b)
A/In
(4)
TP
The question mark ? is used in the column PHP, to indicate that only toxicological information is sufficiently
available, or only intake data, so that there is no sufficient basis to decide whether there are potential health
problems. Obviously, in practice there will be many situations which are not so clear cut as it is presented in
the scheme. Information may be considered sufficient by some, and inadequate by others. Decisions will
have to be taken on a case by case basis, considering the criteria mentioned in Annex I. Further
quantification of the criteria for the necessary data base for making decisions may become inevitable when
serious problems are encountered in practice regarding this aspect.
Risk management decision scheme for CCFAC
Case
Criterion
CCFAC Action
(2a)
(2b)
(3)
(4)
Tox
A/In
PHP
TP
1.
2.
3.
4.
No further action
5.
6.
7.
Page 13 of 20
ANNEX III
FORMAT OF THE STANDARD
Introduction
The format for Schedule I shall contain the following elements:
Codex number of the contaminant: number according to the list described in Annex IV.
ADI, TDI, PTWI or similar toxicological intake recommendation: when the situation is complex
a short statement and further references may be necessary here.
Residue definition: definition of the contaminant as it shall be analyzed and to which the maximum
level applies.
List of Codex standards for the contaminant in foods: this list shall be composed of the following
elements, in columns:
-
When appropriate, instead of a maximum level a (note referring to a) statement regarding the contaminant in
the mentioned food (category) may be inserted.
The format of Schedule II shall contain the following elements:
Page 14 of 20
ANNEX IV
ANNOTATED LIST OF CONTAMINANTS AND TOXINS
Introduction
In this Annex an annotated list is presented of the contaminants and toxins that are or have been dealt with in
the CCFAC. It does not only encompass the contaminants and toxins for which Codex standards exist or are
being developed, but also those for which further information is sought or about which a Codex decision has
been taken.
The annotated list has the purpose of providing an overview of the situation regarding Codex decisions about
this subject and to give guidance about further actions required. Therefore also relevant information and
references are added to the list. The information shall comprise at least the current situation regarding the
criteria that are important for the decision procedure of the CCFAC.
It is thus an active list, which needs to be regularly updated. In order to provide a structure for it and to
facilitate the filing and retrieval of data, a number is assigned to the contaminants and toxins in the list.
The situation regarding contaminants and toxins is very complex and many substances are or have been the
subject of scientific research and discussion regarding their occurrence in foods and their significance for
human and animal health. On a national level, there are many activities, sometimes implying legal measures
which may affect international trade in foods and feeds. It is obviously important for the CCFAC to take note
of the developments in this field and to consider the necessity of actions. In order to obtain an overview of
the situation, the CCFAC shall develop and maintain a working document in which more comprehensive
information regarding contaminants and toxins in foods is presented in summary form. The document shall
consist of an annotated comprehensive list of contaminants and toxins (Annex IV-A), and a collection of
summarized textual information to the substances on the list, with references (Annex IV-B). Annex IV-A
shall be structured according to a substance categorization system, by which code numbers can be assigned
to the substances on the list, to allow logical and easy filing and presentation of data. This more
comprehensive list shall be the basis for the code numbers which are used in Annex IV.
Page 15 of 20
ANNEX V
FOOD CATEGORIZATION SYSTEM
Introduction
The food categorization system of the Codex General Standard for Contaminants and Toxins in Foods is
constructed to perform the following functions:
It has a logical structure which enables a clear and systematic presentation of the (proposed) MLs. It
contains (references to) product definitions and definitions of the part of the product which is analyzed and to
which the ML refers. It contains codes for the food categories and the individual foods, so that data can be
stored and retrieved in a convenient way.
To achieve as much harmonization as possible, an existing agreed categorization system is used.
The GSC uses the system which is developed in the framework of the CCPR as it is also suitable for
contaminants. It is adopted for characterizing the various food and feed groups and the individual
commodities. This system is especially elaborated regarding primary agricultural commodities, but needs
further extension regarding processed products. Where necessary, new (sub)group codes or commodity
codes are therefore introduced. These are described in Annex V-A. Annex V-A will also contain product
descriptions as far as they are different from those contained in the existing system described by the CCPR.
Where appropriate and possible, the descriptive texts accompanying the food categories do or should also
contain indications about the concentration or dilution factor in the processed commodities mentioned, in
relation to the primary product(s) involved. In that way a first estimate can be made of the possible carryover of contaminants from primary products to the various processed products. It has to be borne in mind
however that the specific distribution of a contaminant in the primary product and the behaviour during
processing is a complicating factor here. Further advice may be necessary in those cases. See also the
general indications in Annex I and possible specific information mentioned in relation to the contaminant.
Description of the food categorization system of the GSC
The first part contains the categorization system as developed and maintained by the CCPR. It consists of 5
classes, covering primary food commodities of plant, resp. animal origin, primary feed commodities and
processed commodities of plant, resp. animal origin. The classes are subdivided in 19 types and 93 groups,
which are identified by code numbers and letters.
Reference is made to Vol. 2 of the Codex Alimentarius, section 2 (1993), in which this system is described,
and to CX/PR 92/6 (in which a different kind of group numbering was introduced).
Annex V-A is the other part of the food categorization system for the GSC. It is developed and maintained
by the CCFAC, and is complementary to the system described in the first part. It is mainly directed to
processed, derived and multi-ingredient foods and encompasses all those types and groups and commodity
descriptions that are necessary to assign food categorization codes to existing or planned Codex MLs for
contaminants.
Page 16 of 20
ANNEX V-A
COMPLEMENTARY FOOD CATEGORIZATION SYSTEM FOR THE GSC
Introduction
The following additions to the food categorization system described in Annex V-A will serve the need of
assigning a food code number to commodities that are not covered by Annex V-A. The commodities
involved are mainly processed, derived and multi-ingredient foods.
The system has been designed as a comprehensive list (on a general level), in order to be able to
accommodate possible future needs.
In this phase no individual product definitions and codes are given. It seems sufficient to go no further than a
type or group level in judging the acceptability of the system. The classification can be developed in further
detail as the need arises.
The system used in the GSFA for food classification has been utilized as far as it is compatible with the
existing Codex classification system described in Annex V-A.
See the annexed list of proposed new food categories. Some explanations are added, and also some existing
related food categories, for a better insight in the proposed system.
Commodity descriptions can often be derived from existing Codex Standards.
Information regarding concentration and dilution factors, in relation to contaminant carry-over from primary
products, will be added where appropriate and available.
Definitions for the part of the product that shall be analyzed and to which the ML of a contaminant will apply,
that are different from existing definitions in Annex V-A, may also be mentioned in this Annex.
Class
Type
Group
Page 17 of 20
Letter code
01
01
06
TF
01
07
TV
02
02
08
JV
02
09
SH
03
03
01
CP
03
02
CB
03
03
NF
Fruit nectars
(New proposed group; commodity codes can be derived from the
existing fruit codes)
03
04
FF
03
05
DA
03
06
FJ
03
07
SF
03
08
SV
03
09
PS
03
l0
PP
Class
Type
Group
Page 18 of 20
Letter code
01
01
03
MS
01
04
ES
01
05
WS
02
02
05
MC
02
06
ED
02
07
WD
03
03
01
LI
03
02
MT
03
03
EM
03
04
WP
04
04
01
LM
04
02
MP
04
03
EP
04
04
WI
Class
Type
Group
Page 19 of 20
Letter code
01
Beverages (multi-ingredient)
(New proposed type)
01
01
BS
01
02
BA
02
02
01
SP
02
02
PV
Vinegars (multi-ingredient)
(New proposed group; commodity codes to be developed when the
necessity arises)
02
03
PM
Mustards
(New proposed group; commodity codes to be developed when the
necessity arises)
02
04
BS
02
05
ME
02
06
BC
03
03
01
CC
Chocolate products
(New proposed group; commodity codes to be developed when the
necessity arises)
03
02
CS
03
03
CG
Chewing gum
(New proposed group; commodity codes to be developed when the
necessity arises)
04
04
01
FF
04
02
LF
Page 20 of 20
Class
Type
Group
Letter code
04
03
OF
05
05
01
BF
05
02
BS
05
03
NS
06
06
01
ID
06
02
CD
Weaning foods
(New proposed group; commodity codes to be developed when the
necessity arises)
06
03
HD
06
04
TD
06
05
SD
06
06
AD
Food supplements
(New proposed group; commodity codes to be developed when the
necessity arises)
01
01
01
DW
01
02
SW
78
4.1
RATIONALE
This subject is aimed at developing an understanding of various process technologies and
handling of equipment used in the processing and value addition of milk and milk
products in the students
DETAILED CONTENTS
1.
2.
Fluid Milk
(1 hrs)
(12 hrs)
4.
(6 hrs)
Receiving,
Filtration
and
clarification,
straining,
standardization
Homogenization and its effects, Pasteurization: and various systems of
Pasteurization; LTLT, HTST, UHT methods, Pasteurizers (Heating system,
cooling system, flow controller, regenerator, flow division valve) sterilization,
packaging of fluid milk
5.
(6 hrs)
(4 hrs)
79
7.
Condensed Milk
(4 hrs)
Types and factors affecting the quality of condensed milk, storage of condensed
milk
8.
(4 hrs)
Methods of drying milk (Drum and Spray drying), factors affecting the quality of
dry milk. Introduction to instant non-fat dry milk packaging of dry milk products
9.
Frozen Products
(3 hrs)
Manufacturing of and ice cream; factors affecting the quality of frozen products
10.
(4 hrs)
LIST OF PRACTICALS
1.
2.
Determination of SNF (Solids Not Fat), specific gravity, total solids of milk.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Preparation of Khoa
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
80
Note: Wherever the required equipments are not available students may be
demonstrated that topic the industry or other
INSTRUCTIONAL STRATEGY
This being one of the most important subject, teacher should lay emphasis on developing
basic understanding of various concepts and principles and procedures involved herein.
Suitable tutorial exercises may be designed by the teachers, which require students visit
to various industries. Students may also be exposed to various National, BIS and
international standards. Visits to the relevant industry for demonstrating various
operations involved in the dairy technology, is a must. Experts from the industry may be
invited to deliver lectures on the latest technology. Knowledge about pollution control
and devices for the same may be provided to the students. Wherever relevant, students
may be made aware about safety aspects.
RECOMMENDED BOOKS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
81
4.2
RATIONALE
This subject is aimed to develop an understanding in processing techniques and skills in
handling equipment/machines used for preservation and value addition of perishables like
fruits and vegetables
DETAILED CONTENTS
1.
Introduction
(3 hrs)
(5 hrs)
Cleaning, sorting, grading, peeling and blanching methods and their equipments
3.
4.
a)
b)
(8 hrs)
Tomato Products
(4 hrs)
Ingredients and their role, process for the manufacture of tomato ketchup, sauce,
puree and paste factors affecting the quality and quality control measures
5.
Juices
(4 hrs)
(9 hrs)
a)
82
b)
c)
(5 hrs)
8.
Freezing
(4 hrs)
Freezing process of selected fruits and vegetables: peas, beans, cauliflower,
apricot, mushroom changes during freezing and spoilage of frozen foods
9.
Food Laws and FPO standards for fruits and vegetable products
(4 hrs)
10.
By-products utilization
(4 hrs)
LIST OF PRACTICALS
1.
2.
3.
4.
Preparation of chutney
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
Freezing of peas
14.
15.
83
INSTRUCTIONAL STRATEGY
This being one of the most important subject, teacher should lay emphasis on developing
basic understanding of various concepts and principles and procedures involved herein.
Suitable tutorial exercises may be designed by the teachers, which require students visit
to various industries. Students may also be exposed to various National and international
standards. Visits to the relevant industry for demonstrating various operations involved in
fruits and vegetables processing, is a must. Experts from the industry may be invited to
deliver lectures on the latest technology. Knowledge about pollution control and devices
for the same may be provided to the students. Wherever relevant, students may be made
aware about safety aspects.
RECOMMENDED BOOKS
1.
Fruits and Vegetable Preservation by Girdhari Lal and Sidappa; ICAR (New
Delhi)
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
84
4.3
RATIONALE
This subject is included in the curriculum to impart basic knowledge and skills of various
technologies and equipment used for production of raw as well as processed meat, fish
and poultry products, in the students
DETAILED CONTENTS
1.
(1 hrs)
2.
3.
4.
(8 hrs)
(4 hrs)
(6 hrs)
(6 hrs)
Types of fish, composition and nutritive value, judging the freshness of fish, fish
grading and cooking of fish, smoking, pickling, salting and dehydration,
preservation of fish and processed fish products
8.
(4 hrs)
9.
(5 hrs)
85
LIST OF PRACTICALS
1.
2.
3.
Cutting of meat
4.
Preparation of sausages
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
INSTRUCTIONAL STRATEGY
This being one of the most important subject, teacher should lay emphasis on developing
basic understanding of various concepts and principles and procedures involved herein.
Suitable tutorial exercises may be designed by the teachers, which require students visit
86
to various industries. Students may also be exposed to various National and international
standards. Visits to the relevant industry for demonstrating various operations involved,
in the fermentation of food, is a must. Experts from the industry may be invited to deliver
lectures on the latest technology. Knowledge from pollution control and devices for the
same may be provided to the students. Wherever relevant, students may be made aware
about safety aspects.
RECOMMENDED BOOKS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Poultry, Meat and Egg Products by Parkursht and Mountney (CBS Publishers)
6.
7.
The Canning of Fish and Meat by RJ Footill and AS Lewis (Blackie Publishers)
8.
9.
10.
11.
87
4.4
RATIONALE
This subject is developed with an objective to impart knowledge and skills related to
process technologies and equipment used for the production of various fermented food
products to the students
DETAILED CONTENTS
1.
Introduction
(3 hrs)
3.
Fermentor
(6 hrs)
(12 hrs)
Production of distilled beverages, wine, beer, vinegar and sausages and brandy
bakers yeast, bread
5.
(12 hrs)
Curd, yogurt, idli, dosa, dhokla, srikhand, tempeh and miso, sauerkraut, butter
milk, lassi, sausage
6.
(6 hrs)
(3 hrs)
88
LIST OF PRACTICALS
1.
2.
Preparation of wine
3.
Preparation of beer
4.
5.
Preparation of vinegar
6.
7.
8.
9.
INSTRUCTIONAL STRATEGY
This being one of the most important subject, teacher should lay emphasis on developing
basic understanding of various concepts and principles and procedures involved herein.
Suitable tutorial exercises may be designed by the teachers, which require students visit
to various industries. Students may also be exposed to various national and international
standards. Visits to the relevant industry for demonstrating various operations involved in
the food beverage, is a must. Experts from the industry may be invited to deliver lectures
on the latest technology. Knowledge about pollution control and devices for the same
may be provided to the students. Wherever relevant, students may be made aware about
safety aspects.
RECOMMENDED BOOKS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
89
4.5
RATIONALE
Non-alcoholic industries are one of the fast growing industries in India. Therefore, this
subject is introduced with the basic objective to impart knowledge and skills of process
techniques and equipment used for the production of these beverages, to the students.
DETAILED CONTENTS
1.
Introduction
Definition, scope and status of beverage industry in India
(2 hrs)
2.
3.
4.
Carbonated Beverages
(8 hrs)
Equipment and machinery for carbonated beverages, water treatment, syrup
preparation, containers and closures. Cleaning, carbonation, filling, inspection and
quality control
5.
Non-carbonated beverages
(6 hrs)
Technology, specification, equipment and machinery for instant and normal tea
and coffee, fruit juice based beverages, synthetic beverages
6.
(6 hrs)
(4 hrs)
LIST OF PRACTICALS
1.
2.
3.
Preparation of tea
4.
5.
Preparation of squash
6.
90
7.
8.
9.
10.
INSTRUCTIONAL STRATEGY
This being one of the most important subject, teacher should lay emphasis on developing
basic understanding of various concepts and principles and procedures involved herein.
Suitable tutorial exercises may be designed by the teachers, which require students visit
to various industries. Students may also be exposed to various National and international
standards. Visits to the relevant industry for demonstrating various operations involved in
the food beverage, is a must. Experts from the industry may be invited to deliver lectures
on the latest technology. Knowledge from pollution control and devices for the same
may be provided to the students. Wherever relevant, students may be made aware about
safety aspects.
RECOMMENDED BOOKS
1.
2.
91
4.6
RATIONALE
This subject is aimed at developing an understanding of process technology and skills in
handling equipment involved for the preparation of bakery products in diploma students
of food technology
DETAILED CONTENTS
1.
(2 hrs)
2.
3.
4.
Confectionery Products
(6 hrs)
Layout out, setting up of units and hygienic conditions required in bakery plant,
operation and maintenance of bakery equipment
(8 hrs)
92
LIST OF PRACTICALS
1.
2.
3.
Study and analysis of the production charts used for different products by bakery
industries
4.
INSTRUCTIONAL STRATEGY
This being one of the most important subject, teacher should lay emphasis on developing
basic understanding of various concepts and principles and procedures involved herein.
Suitable tutorial exercises may be designed by the teachers, which require students visit
to various industries. Students may also be exposed to various National and international
standards. Visits to the relevant industry for demonstrating various operations involved in
the Bakery and Confectionery processing is a must. Experts from the industry may be
invited to deliver lectures on the latest technology. Knowledge from pollution control and
devices for the same may be provided to the students. Wherever relevant, students may
be made aware about safety aspects.
RECOMMENDED BOOKS
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Partial Revision of Specifications and Standards for Food, Food Additives, Etc.
The Ministrer of Health, Labour and Welfare has issued the Notification to Partially Revise the
Specifications and Standards for Food, Food Additives, Etc (Ministry of Health, Labour and
Welfare Notification No. 643, 2006). Based on the notification the specifications and standards
(Ministry of Health and Welfare Notification, No. 370, 1959) have been revised.
1.
Outline of revision
The Minister of Health, Labour and Welfare has established MRLs for the pesticide
cyazofamnid and metconazole, as given below, based on the provision of Paragraph 1 Article 11 of
the Food Sanitation Law. The analytical method for cyazofamnid and metconazole is announced in
Director Notice Syoku-An No.1129004.
2.
Date of enforcement
i) Cyazofamid
November 29, 2006
The revision of MRLs for the food categories below will take effect on May 29, 2007.
Taro, Egg plant, Pumpkin (including squash), Oriental pickling melon,
Strawberry, Other fruits, and Other spices (excluding Unshu orange, peel)
ii) Metconazole
November 29, 2006
This document is rearranged from the original Director Notice (Syoku-An No.1129001, November 29,
2006). This rearrangement aims to help English readers understand the notice.
3.
Other matters
Since the establishment of the MRLs for cyazofamid and metconazole has been completed,
the Ministry of Agriculture, Forestry and Fisheries will, based on the Agricultural Chemicals
Regulation Law (Law No. 82, 1948), register the food categories to which cyazofamid will be
newly permitted for application in Japan, withdraw the registration of the food categories to which
the application of cyazofamid will be prohibited, and register metconazole as an approved
pesticide.
Attachment.
Cyazofamid (Fungicide)
Cyazofamid (Continued)
Commodity
Wheat
1
Beans, dry
Potato
Taro
Japanese radish, roots (including radish)
Japanese radish, leaves (including radish)
Turnip, roots
Turnip, leaves
Chinese cabbage
Cabbage
Kale
Komatsuna , Japanese mustard spinach
Kyona
Qing-geng-cai
Broccoli
Other cruciferous vegetables2
Onion
Welsh (including leek)
3
Other liliaceous vegetables
Tomato
Pimiento (sweet pepper)
Egg plant
4
0.05
10
0.3
20
0.7
1
0.05
0.05
15
15
15
10
3
1
15
0.05
0.05
2
3
2
2
1
1
2
0.5
1
1
Metconazole (Fungicide)
Commodity
Wheat
Unshu orange, pulp
Citrus natsudaidai , whole
Lemon
Orange (including Navel)
Grapefruit
Lime
Other citrus fruits
Unshu orange, peel
Established
DOE
MRL
ppm
0.2
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.3
0.3
0.3
0.3
3
Commodity
Cucumber (including gherkin)
Pumpkin (including squash)
Oriental pickling melon (vegetable)
Water melon
Melons
Makuwauri melon
Other cucurbitaceous vegetables5
Spinach
Ginger
Unshu orange, pulp
Citrus natsudaidai , whole
Lemon
Orange (including navel orange)
Grapefruit
Lime
Other citrus fruits6
Strawberry
Grape
7
Other fruits
Unshu orange, peel
8
Other spices (excluding Unshu orange, peel)
Other herbs9
Note
1. Beans (dry) includes butter beans, cowbeans (red beans), lentil, lima beans, pegia, sultani,
sultapya, and white beans.
2. Other cruciferous vegetables refer to all cruciferous vegetables, except Japanese radish roots
and leaves (including radish), turnip roots and leaves, horseradish, watercress, Chinese
cabbage, cabbage, brussels sprouts, kale, komatsuna (Japanese mustard spinach), kyona,
qing-geng-cai, cauliflower, broccoli and herbs.
3. Other liliaceous vegetables refer to all liliaceous vegetables, except onion, welsh (including
leek), garlic, nira, asparagus, multiplying onion and herbs.
4. Other solanceous vegetables refer to all solanceous vegetables except tomato, pimiento
(sweet pepper) and egg plant.
5. Other cucurbitaceous vegetables refer to all cucurbitaceous vegetables, except cucumber
(including gherkin), pumpkin (including squash), oriental pickling melon (vegetable), water
melon, melons and makuwauri melon.
6. Other citrus fruits refer to all citrus fruits, except unshu orange (pulp), citrus natsudaidai
(pulp), citrus natsudaidai (peels), citrus natsudaidai (whole), lemon, orange (including navel
orange), grapefruit, lime and spices.
7. Other fruits refers to all fruits, expect citrus fruits, apple, Japanese pear, pear,
quince, loquat, peach, nectarine, apricot, Japanese plum(including prune), mume
plum, cherry, berries, grape, Japanese persimmon, banana, kiwifruit, papaya,
avocado, pineapple, guava, mango, passion fruit, date, and spices.
8. Other spices refer to all spices, except horseradish, wasabi (Japanese horseradish) rhizomes,
garlic, peppers chili, paprika, ginger, lemon peels, orange peels (including navel orange), yuzu
(Chinese citron) peels and sesame seeds.
9. Other herbs refer to all herbs, except watercress, nira, parsley stems and leaves, celery
stemsand leaves.
DOE:
Date of enforcement
May 29, 2007
November 29, 2006
For commidities for which revised MRLs are not given, the uniform limit (0.01 ppm) will be
applied. Revised MRLs include limits that have not modified from the current MRL
1.0
GENERAL DISCUSSION
1.1
Purpose of Procedure
Page:
1 of 7
Date:
November 2005
Number:
2-106.5
Revision:
5
This procedure delineates the process for pre-firing and acceptance testing of quartz fiber
filters. Quartz fiber filters absorb organic gases from ambient air and organic artifacts from
the manufacturing process. By pre-firing the quartz filters before sampling, these absorbed
gases and artifacts are reduced to constant, insignificant levels.
The filters are pre-fired in preparation for thermal/optical reflectance and/or transmittance
(TOR/TOT) carbon analysis, which is a thermal desorption process that subjects the filters
to temperatures between 25 C and 920 C. In preparation for this analysis, the filters are
pre-fired at 900 C to remove all possible interferences with the TOR/TOT analysis. Filters
that will be used for additional ionic analysis also undergo ionic acceptance testing to
ensure that any impurities are minimal.
1.2
Measurement Principle
(Not applicable)
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.6
Personnel Responsibilities
All technicians in the laboratory should read and understand this entire standard operating
procedure before performing pre-firing and acceptance testing preparation.
The laboratory coordinator is responsible for: 1) ensuring that the procedure is being
followed, 2) maintaining the supplies necessary to insure uninterrupted pre-firing, and 3)
ensuring that documentation is properly maintained.
The DRI quality assurance officer is responsible for revising the procedure when necessary.
1.7
Page:
2 of 7
Date:
November 2005
Number:
2-106.5
Revision:
5
Definitions
There are no terms in this procedure which require definitions.
1.8
Related Procedures
DRI SOP #2-216.1
2.0
2.1
Quartz fiber filters 2500 QAT-UP (Pall Sciences, Ann Arbor, MI),) in 25, 37, or 47
mm disks, as required by the projects in progress.
Coors Evaporating Dishes, 12 cm, #60234 (Van Waters & Rogers, #60234).
Light table
2.2
Page:
3 of 7
Date:
November 2005
Number:
2-106.5
Revision:
5
Reagents
(Not applicable)
2.3
Forms
The only paperwork required for the pre-firing process is the DRI Filter Media Acceptance
Log (Figure 2-1).
3.0
CALIBRATION PROCEDURES
(Not Applicable)
4.0
PROCEDURES
4.1
4.2
4.3
Preparation
Each DRI lot consists of 100 filters of the same manufacturer lot and size; this
generally corresponds to four boxes of 25 filters (37mm and 47mm) or one box of
100 filters (25mm). When filters are to be pre-fired, assign a DRI lot number to
each lot; refer to previous entries in the Filter Media Acceptance Log binder for the
correct lot number.
Record the DRI lot number on each box using a marker or gummed label. If more
than one box is required to make a lot of 100, use a suffix of -1, -2, etc. to
distinguish between the boxes.
Record the manufacturer, manufacturer's lot number, and filter size in the Filter
Media Acceptance Log binder.
Pre-firing of Filters
Obtain two ceramic dishes, one for a base and one for a lid. Clean with a dry
Kimwipe.
Page:
4 of 7
Date:
November 2005
Number:
2-106.5
Revision:
5
Page:
5 of 7
Date:
November 2005
Number:
2-106.5
Revision:
5
Receive
from Manufacturer
Fai
Scra
Bo
Pas
Io Acceptance
(IC, AC, AA)
Carbon Acceptance
(TOR/TOT)
Fai
Fai
Test 2
More
Discar
Pas
Fai
Test 2
More
Pas
Pas
Refrigerate
Storag
Assign to
Projects
Fai
Discar
4.4
Page:
6 of 7
Date:
November 2005
Number:
2-106.5
Revision:
5
Obtain 100 filters of the required size from the stocking shelf in the Shipping and
Receiving room, and assign the next consecutive lot number as determined from the
Filter Media Acceptance Log binder.
Wearing gloves, place one filter flat in the center of the dish. Place additional filters
in the dish in a circle, resting on the side of the dish and the center filter. The
completed dish will have the appearance of a rosette. Place 50 in each dish if prefiring 47mm or 37 mm filters or 100 filters per dish if pre-firing 25mm filters.
CAUTION: too much overlap of filters will not allow carbonaceous vapors to
escape.
Invert the second dish and place it as a cap on top of the first dish.
Repeat the previous steps until sufficient lots are prepared to fill the oven.
Place the dishes in the oven. The dishes are placed three in a stack. Close and latch
the oven door.
Turn on the oven. Set the oven temperature to 900 C by pressing the small black
push button and turning the set point adjustment knob until "900" appears in the
display. When the push button is released the display will return to the current oven
temperature.
Record the pre-fire date in the Acceptance Log binder and the acceptance data base.
Line the original boxes with aluminum foil, because the pre-fired filters are returned
to them for storage. Also, prepare 2 tubes and 2 slides for all lots that will be used
for projects requiring ion analysis (usually the 47mm and 37mm).
Turn the oven off after a minimum of 4 hours have elapsed. Allow the oven to cool
without opening the door. Generally the oven is left overnight to cool.
Acceptance Testing
When the oven has cooled, remove the dishes from the oven..
Using flat-tipped tweezers, hold each filter to the light table and inspect it for holes
or uneven texture. Place any rejects in a separate unlined box for use in test packs.
Place the accepted filters in the prepared aluminum lined boxes. NOTE: inspect the
filters carefully; for most air sampling projects the equivalent value of each filter
may reach several hundreds of dollars; make sure that only clean, unblemished
filters are accepted.
When all filters have been light checked, place two of the filters in PetriSlides for
carbon acceptance testing.
Label the PetriSlides with the code "Q"+lot
number+"A" or B (e.g., "Q160A"). For 37mm and 47mm filters, also fold and
place two filters in extraction tubes for wet chemistry acceptance testing. Store the
boxes of filters, extraction tubes, and PetriSlides in the designated freezer. Inform
Page:
7 of 7
Date:
November 2005
Number:
2-106.5
Revision:
5
the laboratory coordinator that there are pre-fired filters that will need an analysis
list for acceptance testing.
5.0
Ion acceptance testing is performed as described in SOPs #2-203.4, 2-207.5, 2206.3, or 2-208.1, as required.
Two additional filters from lots that fail acceptance testing are subjected to further
testing. The process outlined above is followed except the filters are identified with
a C and D suffix. If the filters fail again, the lot is discarded and a note is made
in the Acceptance Binder.
Boxes containing filters which pass acceptance testing are placed in zip-lock bags,
and stored in the freezer until they are assigned to a project.
QUANTIFICATION
(Not applicable)
6.0
QUALITY CONTROL
(Not applicable)
7.0
QUALITY ASSURANCE
(Not applicable)
8.0
REFERENCES
Refer to the oven's owner's manual for additional information concerning its operation.
opening meeting is to confirm the audit plan; provide a short summary of how the audit
activities will be undertaken; confirm communication channels; and to provide an
opportunity for the auditee to ask questions.
b) Conduct of Assessment - Each auditor may be accompanied by a guide who is conversant
with the activities of the department(s) the auditor is auditing. Observations recorded by the
auditors may be signed by the guide as a token of acceptance, if desired by the auditor.
The non-conformities observed by the audit team will be handed over to the firm at the end of
each day for necessary correction and corrective actions.
Time frame for the corrective action(s) will be decided by the firm.
The non-conformity reports will be signed by Management Representative or authorized
signatory as a token of acceptance.
c) Closing Meeting
All the members present in the opening meeting should preferably be present in the closing
meeting as well, when the audit team will present their findings to the firm.
The audit team leader will present the audit findings and conclusions during the closing
meeting. A report will be submitted to the firm by the audit team leader.
RESPONSIBILITIES OF APPLICANT DURING THE AUDIT
The organization is expected to provide following assistance to the audit team during the audits:
a) Arrangements of stay, local guidance and travel arrangements, etc.
b) The CEO and the Management Representative of the company must be present during the
opening and closing meetings. As far as possible, all responsible personnel of the company
whose departments are being audited should be present in these meetings.
c)
In the interest of the firm, all efforts should be made that time of the audit team is not wasted
on account of non- availability of relevant personnel, documents, records, shut down of
unit(s) being audited, etc.
d)
The firm will arrange a place/room where members of the audit team can meet to exchange
their notes and findings and discuss during the day and at the end of the day.
At the time of grant of licence to the applicant, they shall give the following undertaking:
"We shall make no claim direct or implied that the licence granted to us relates to products or
processes other than those set out in the said licence and the schedule thereof."
Grant of Licence
The licence shall be granted for a period of three years.
Grant of licence will be followed by atleast three surveillance visits in three years by the
auditor(s) nominated by BIS to verify the effective implementation and maintenance of the food
safety management system established by the firm.
During the operation of licence, when a licensee fails to observe the conditions of the Food
Safety Management Systems Certification Scheme or where there have been significant changes
in the organization of the licensee, licence of the firm is liable to be suspended and may call for
special visits for which firm is liable to pay special visit charges as set out in schedule of fees.
RENEWAL, EXPIRY, SUSPENSION AND CANCELLATION OF LICENCE
Any licence granted automatically expires at the end of the period for which it is granted. A
renewal notice will be issued to the licensee by the concerned regional office of BIS four
months before the expiry of the operative period. The licensee is required to submit the renewal
application atleast three months in advance before the expiry of the licence which will be
followed by a complete audit of Food Safety Management System of the organization.
If some discrepancies are found during the audit, the licensee will be asked to take actions
(correction and corrective actions). After the licensee has taken necessary action or a corrective
and preventive action plan is proposed by the licensee to remove discrepancies, the Food Safety
Management Systems Certification licence will be renewed for a period of three years. (For
suspension and cancellation of licence, please see Obligations of Licensee)
OBLIGATIONS OF LICENSEE
A licensee on grant of certification for Food Safety Management System will:
a) At all times comply with the requirements of the licence as set out therein and
comply with BIS (Certification) Amendment Regulations, 2002 or any
amendments thereto.
b) Only claim that he is holding a licence in respect of the capability which is the
subject of the licence and which relates to the products, processes or systems in
accordance with the licence requirements.
c) Not use the licence in any manner to which the BIS may object and shall not
make any statement concerning the authority of the licensee'
s use of the licence
which, in the opinion of the BIS, may be misleading.
d) Submit to the BIS for approval the form in which he proposes to use the licence or
proposes to make references to the licence.
APPEALS
Under the Provisions of BIS Act 1986, any decision taken in respect of granting, withholding,
renewal, suspension or cancellation of certification under the Bureau of Indian Standards Food
Safety Management Systems Certification Scheme (BIS FSMSCS) can be appealed against. For
the Procedure and Guidelines for making an appeal, contact Head (Management Systems
Certification) at BIS Headquarters, 9 Bahadur Shah Zafar Marg, New Delhi - 110 002.
SYSTEMS
CERTIFICATION
APPLICANT
SUBMISSION
OF APPLICATION
SEEK MORE
INFORMATION
SCRUTINY
BY BIS
REJECT
Accepted
ADEQUACY
AUDIT
AFTER
CORRECTIVE
ACTION
APPLICANT
CORRECTIVE
PRELIMINARY
AUDIT
AUDIT TEAM
APPOINTMENT
CERTIFICATION AUDIT
AUDIT
REPORT
Satisfactory
ACTION
RECOMMENDATIONS FOR AWARD OF
CERTIFICATE
CERTIFICATE GRANTED
SURVEILLANCE
RENEWAL
Page 1 of 35
INTRODUCTION
1.1
Scope
Hereunder are given analytical methods which can, from practical experience of the Working
Group on Methods of Analysis to the Codex Committee on Pesticide Residues, be applied to the
determination of pesticide residues for regulatory purposes. The list, given in par.2, is not exhaustive and
methods not mentioned in the list can also be applied, provided that they can be shown to be effective.
1.2
Whenever possible, the Working Group used the following criteria when selecting analytical
methods:
(i)
published in books, manuals or open literature; (For some newer compounds, few
methods might be available from these sources; in those cases, GIFAP is prepared to
supply analytical methods to regulatory authorities as a matter of routine policy and to
other scientists on a case by case basis. Requests can be directed to: GIFAP, Avenue
Albert Lancaster 79A, 1180 Brussels, Belgium);
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
(v)
Preference was given to gas chromatography or high performance liquid chromatography as the
determinative step for the methods. Under certain conditions however, methods using less sophisticated
procedures, such as thin-layer chromatography or spectrophotometry, may be applicable. This may be the
case, for example, when an exporting country wants to check whether or not a commodity produced in
that country complies with an Codex MRL. In this case, the treatment history of the commodity may be
known or assumed, so that the method used need not be as elaborate as in cases where samples of
unknown treatment history are under investigation. Also, when the MRL is high compared to the limit of
determination, simpler methodology may be applied in order to arrive at a "pass/no pass" decision or for
quick screening purposes.
1.3
Application of methods
It will always be necessary for the analyst to validate a method before it is first applied in a
practical situation. There is a further need for regular checks on the performance of the method in use at
both the MRL and at the lower limit of determination. For all new pesticide/commodity combinations the
1
Page 2 of 35
method must be validated following Good Practice in Residue Analysis, (see reference 4 ). Confirmation
of the identity of an indicated residue by an independent technique is also to be regarded as an essential
part of Good Practice in Residue Analysis, especially when the initial result suggests that an MRL is
exceeded. Mass spectrometry has become for many residues the method of choice for confimatory
purposes, but the ultimate choice of a confirmatory test depends upon the technique used in the initial
determination and upon the available instrumentation and necessary expertise.
1.4
References to literature
Other relevant Codex recommendations in the field of enforcement of Codex maximum limits for
pesticide residues are as follows:
1.
2.
Portion of a Commodities to which Codex Maximum Residue Limits apply and which should
be analysed (Ref: Codex Alimentarius Vol. 2, Section 4.1).
3.
Explanatory Notes on Codex Maximum Limits for Pesticide Residues (Ref: Codex
Alimentarius Vol. 2, Section 1).
4.
Codex Guidelines on Good Practice in Pesticide Residue Analysis. (Ref: Codex Alimentarius
Suppl 1 to vol, 2. Section 4).
After each reference given in paragraph 3.3, the compounds to which the methods involved apply
are indicated by their CCPR-number.
2.
Page 3 of 35
The numbers refer to the manuals and books listed in paragraph 3.2, the names to the (first) author of
the papers listed in paragraph 3.3.
___________________________________________________________________________________
____
CCPR
Compound
References
number
001
aldrin/dieldrin
1a, 1n, 1o, 1p, 2a, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-5, 6; S1-5, S8-10, S12, S19), 5, 7a
(5, 6), 7c (S8-10, S12, S19), 8a, 8b, 8c, 8d, 9a (M1, M12), 10
Ambrus, Abbott (2), Panel (4), Stijve (2, 3)
002
azinphos-methyl
2c, 2d, 2e, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-6; S5, S8, S19; 63, 63A), 7a (6), 7c (S8, S19),
7d(255), 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Panel (3)
003
binapacryl
004
bromophos
2a, 2c, 2d, 4 (XII-3, 6; S5, S8-10, S13, S17, S19; 210, 210A), 6d, 7a
(3, 6), 7c (S8-10, S13, S17, S19), 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Bottomley, Panel (7, 8), Stijve (7)
005
bromophos-ethyl
2a, 2c, 2d, 3, 4 (XII-3, 6; S8, S13, S17, S19; 263), 6d, 7a (3,6), 7c
(S13, S17, S19), 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus
006
captafol
2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S8, S19, S20; 266, 266A), 6d, 7a (6), 7b, 7c (S8, S19,
S20), 9a (M1, M12), 10
Ambrus, Baker, PB (1), Buettler, Gilvydis, Pomerantz
007
captan
2a, 2d, 2e, 3, 4 (XII-6; S8, S12, S19, S20; 12, 12A), 7a (6), 7b, 7c (S8,
S12, S19, S20), 9a (M1, M12), 10
Ambrus, Baker, PB (1), Buettler, Gilvydis, Pomerantz
008
carbaryl
1q, 2d, 2e, 2f, 2g, 3, 4 (XII-6; 100), 6c, 7a (6), 9a (M2, M13), 10
Brauckhoff, Chaput, Lawrence(1)
009
carbon disulphide
9a (M8)
Mestres (2)
010
carbon tetrachloride
1d, 9a (M8)
Daft, Mestres (2), Panel (5)
Page 4 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
011
carbophenothion
2a, 2c, 2d, 2e, 2f, 3, 3d, 4 (XII-5, 6; S8, S10, S13, S16, S19), 7a (5, 6),
7c (S8, S10, S13, S16, S19), 8b, 8e, 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus
012
chlordane
1a, 1o, 2a, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-5, 6; S9, S10, S12, S19), 5, 7a (5, 6), 7c
(S9, S10, S12, S19), 6c, 6d, 8a, 8b, 8c, 8d, 9a (M1, M12), 10
Panel (4), Stijve (3), Veierov
013
chlordimeform
014
chlorfenvinphos
2c, 2d, 2e, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 5, 6; S8, S13, S17, S19; 239), 5, 7a (3, 5, 6),
7c (S8, S13, S17, S19), 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Panel (7,8), Stijve (7)
015
chlormequat
6a, 9b
Sachse, Stijve (5)
016
chlorobenzilate
017
chlorpyrifos
1p, 2a, 2c, 2d, 2e, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-6; S8, S9, S13, S19), 5, 7a (6), 7c (S8,
S9, S13, S19), 8b, 8e, 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
(Ambrus, Stijve (7))
018
coumaphos
2c, 2d, 2e, 3, 4 (XII-6; S19), 7a (6), 7c (S19), 8b, 8e, 9a (M2, M5,
M12)
Ambrus, Stijve (7)
019
crufomate
020
2,4-D
021
DDT
1a, 1n, 1o, 1p, 2a, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-4, 5, 6; S1-5, S8-10, S12, S19), 5,
6c, 7a (4,5,6), 7c (S8-10, S12, S19), 8a, 8b, 8c, 9a (M1, M12), 10
Abbott (2), Ambrus, Bottomley, Panel (4), Stijve (2, 3), Veierov
022
diazinon
1a, 2a, 2c, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-5, 6; S5, S8, S10, S13, S17, S19; 35A,
35B), 6c, 7a (5, 6), 7c (S8, S10, S13, S17, S19), 8e, 9a (M2, M5,
M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Bottomley, Panel (7), Stijve (7)
Page 5 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
023
1,2-dibromoethane
024
1,2-dichloroethane
1d, 9a (M8)
Daft, Mestres (2), Panel (5)
025
dichlorvos
2c, 2d, 2e, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 6; S5, S8, S13, S17, S19; 200), 7a (3, 6), 7c
(S13, S17, S19), 8b, 8e, 9a (M2, M5), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Bottomley, Panel (1, 3, 7), Stijve (7)
026
dicofol
2a, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-6; S8, S9, S12, S19; 69, 69A), 7a (6), 7c (S8, S9,
S12, S19), 9a (M1, M12), 10
027
dimethoate
2c, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 6; S5, S8, S13, S17, S19; 42, 236), 5, 7a (3, 6),
7c (S8, S13, S17, S19), 9a (M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Panel (3, 7, 8), Stijve (7)
028
dioxathion
2c, 2d, 4 (XII-6; S8, S13, S19), 7a (6), 7c (S8, S9, S19), 8e, 9a (M2,
M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Stijve (7)
029
diphenyl
030
diphenylamine
031
diquat
2e, 4 (37), 6d
Calderbank (2), King
032
endosulfan
1b, 2a, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-5,6; S5, S8, S12, S19; 50), 5, 7a (5, 6), 7c
(S19), 5, 9a (M1, M12), 10
Abbott (2), Ambrus
033
endrin
1a, 1o, 2a, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-5, 6; S5, S9, S10, S12, S19), 5, 7a (5, 6), 7c
(S9-10, S12, S19), 8a, 8b, 8c, 8d, 9a (M1, M12), 10
Abbott (2), Ambrus, Panel (4)
034
ethion
1a, 2a, 2c, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 5, 6; S8, S9, S13, S17, S19), 7a (3, 5, 6),
7c (S8, S9, S13, S17, S19), 8e, 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Stijve (7)
Page 6 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
035
ethoxyquin
036
fenchlorphos
1a, 2a, 2c, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 5, 6; S8-10, S13, S17, S19), 7a (3, 5, 6),
7c (S8-10, S13, S17, S19), 8b, 8e, 9a (M2, M5), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Panel (7, 8), Stijve (7)
037
fenitrothion
2a, 2c, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 6; S5, S8, S13, S17, S19; 58), 6a, 8e, 9a
(M2, M5), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Bottomley, Desmarchelier, Panel (7,8), Stijve (7)
038
fensulfothion
2c, 2d, 2e, 3, 4 (XII-3, 6; S8, S13, S16, S17, S19), 6a, 7a (3, 6), 7c (S8,
S13, S16, S17, S19), 9a (M2, M5), 10
039
fenthion
2c, 2d, 2e, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 6; S5, S8, S13, S16, S17, S19), 7a (3, 6), 7c
(S8, S13, S16, S17, S19), 8e, 9a (M2, M5), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Hill
040
fentin
041
folpet
2a, 2c, 2d, 3, 4 (XII-6; S8, S12, S19, S20; 91, 91A), 7a (6), 7b, 7c (S8,
S12, S19, S20), 9a (M1, M12), 10
Ambrus, Baker, PB (1), Buettler, Gilvydis, Pomerantz
042
formothion
2d, 4 (XII-6; S5, S8, S19; 236), 6b, 7a (6), 7c (S8, S19), 9a (M2, M5,
M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus
043
heptachlor
1a, 1n, 1o, 2a, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-5, 6; S 1-4, S8-10, S12, S19), 5, 6c, 6d,
7a (5, 6), 7c (S8-10, S12, S19), 8a, 8b, 8c, 8d, 9a (M1, M12), 10
Abbott (2), Ambrus, Stijve (2, 3), Veierov
044
hexachlorobenzene
1k, 1o, 2a, 2d, 3, 4 (XII-1, 5, 6; S9, S10, S12, S19), 5, 6c, 7a (1, 5, 6),
7c (S9, S10, S12, S19), 8a, 8b, 8c, 8d, 9a (M1, M12), 10
Ambrus, Panel (4), Stijve (2, 3), Veierov, Zimmerli
045
hydrogen cyanide
2e, 4 (11), 9b
Darr
046
hydrogen phosphide
Page 7 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
047
inorganic bromide
048
lindane
1a, 1o, 2a, 2d, 3, 4 (XII-5, 6; S1-5, S8-10, S12, S19), 5, 7a (5, 6), 7c
(S8-10, S12, S19), 8a, 8b, 8c, 8d, 9a (M1, M12), 10
Abbott (2), Ambrus, Panel (4), Stijve (2,3), Veierov
049
malathion
1a, 2a, 2c, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 5, 6; S5, S8, S10, S13, S17, S19; 72), 7a
(3, 5, 6), 7c (S8, S10, S13, S17, S19), 8e, 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Bottomley, Desmarchelier, Panel (1, 3, 7, 8),
Stijve (7)
050
mancozeb
051
methidathion
2a, 2c, 2d, 2e, 3, 4 (XII-6; S5, S8, S13, S19; 232), 6b, 7a (6), 7c (S8,
S13, S19), 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Ambrus
052
methyl bromide
9a (M8)
Mestres (2), Panel (5)
053
mevinphos
2c, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 6; S5, S8, S13, S17, S19; 93), 7a (3, 6), 7c (S8,
S13, S17, S19), 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus
054
monocrotophos
1p, 2c, 2d, 2e, 2f, 4 (XII-6; S19), 7c (S19), 9a (M2, M5), 10
Ambrus
055
omethoate
1p, 2c, 2d, 4 (XII-6; S13, S17, S19; 236), 5, 7a (6), 7c (S13, S17, S19),
9a (M2, M5), 10
Abbott (1), Panel (3)
056
ortho-phenylphenol
2d, 2e, 10
Farrow, Kitada, Lord, Mestres (1), Player, Pyysalo
057
paraquat
058
parathion
1a, 2a, 2c, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 4, 5, 6; S5, S8, S10, S13, S17, S19; 87A,
87B), 7a (3, 4, 5, 6), 7c (S8, S10, S13, S17, S19), 8e, 9a (M2, M5,
M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Panel (3)
Page 8 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
059
parathion-methyl
1a, 2a, 2c, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 5, 6; S5, S8, S13, S17, S19; 88A, 88B),
7a (3, 5, 6), 7c (S8, S13, S17, S19), 8e, 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Panel (3)
060
phosalone
2a, 2c, 2d, 2e, 3, 4 (XII-5, 6; S8, S19), 5, 6a, 7a (5, 6), 7c (S8, S19), 9a
(M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Stijve (7)
061
phosphamidon
2c, 2d, 2e, 3, 4 (XII-6; S5, S13, S19), 7a (6), 7c (S13, S19), 9a (M5,
M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Bottomley
062
piperonyl butoxide
063
pyrethrins
064
quintozene
2a, 2d, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-4, 5, 6; S8, S9, S12, S19; 99), 7a (4, 5, 6), 7c (S8,
S9, S12, S19), 9a (M1, M12), 10
065
thiabendazole
2d, 2e, 2h, 4 (XII-6; 256A, 256B),7d (256A, 256B), 8g, 9a (M3), 10
Farrow, Kitada, Mestres (1, 3), Rajzman, Yamada
066
trichlorfon
2c, 2d, 2e, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-6; S5, S13, S19; 112), 5, 7a (6), 7c (S13, S19),
8e, 9a (M2, M5, M12)
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Bottomley
067
cyhexatin
068
azinphos-ethyl
2c, 2d, 4 (XII-3, 5, 6; S5, S8, S13, S17, S19; 62, 62A), 7a (3, 5, 6), 7c
(S8, S13, S17, S19), 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus
069
benomyl
070
bromopropylate
071
camphechlor
2a, 2d, 2e,4 (XII-5, 6; S9, S19), 7a (5, 6), 7c (S9, S19)
Stijve (2)
Page 9 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
072
carbendazim
2e, 2h, 4 (261, 378), 6a, 6d,7d (261, 370, 378) 9a (M3), 10
Ambrus, Farrow, Mestres (3), VanHaver
073
demeton-S-methyl
2d, 2f, 4 (XII-6; S5, S13, S16, S19), 7a (6), 7c (S13, S16, S19),9a
(M2, M5), 10
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Hill, Wagner
074
disulfoton
2a, 2c, 2d, 2e, 2f, 3, 4 (XII-3, 6; S5, S8, S13, S16, S17, S19), 7a (3, 6),
7c (S8, S13, S16, S17, S19), 8e, 9a (M2, M5)
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Panel (7)
075
propoxur
076
thiometon
1e, 2d, 2g, 4 (XII-6; S19; S25; 216), 6a, 7a (6), 7c (S19), 9a (M2,
M13), 10
Ambrus, Brauckhoff, Chaput, Lawrence (1)
2d, 4 (XII-6; S13), 6b, 7a (6), 7c (S13), 9a (M2, M5, M10, M12)
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Hill
077
thiophanate-methyl
078
vamidothion
079
amitrole
2e(4A), 7d(4A)
Galoux, Lokke (1), v.d.Poll
080
chinomethionate
081
chlorothalonil
2a, 2d, 2e, 3, 4 (XII-6; S19), 6b, 7a (6), 7c (S19), 9a (M1, M12), 10
Ambrus, Lokke (2)
082
dichlofluanid
2a, 2d, 4 (XII-6; S8, S12, S19; 203; 203A, 203 -(371)), 7a (6), 7c (S8,
S12, S19), 7d(203, 371, 203A, 371A), 9a (M1, M12), 10
Ambrus, Lokke (2), Brennecke (4)
083
dicloran
084
dodine
2e
Newsome (1)
Page 10 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
085
fenamiphos
2c, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S8; S16; S19), 7a (6), 7c (S16, S19), 9a (M5,
M12)
Hill
086
pirimiphos-methyl
2a, 2c, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S8, S19; 476), 6b, 7a (6), 7c (S8, S19), 9a
(M2, M5, M12), 10
Ambrus, Desmarchelier, Panel (7, 8), Stijve (7)
087
dinocap
088
leptophos
withdrawn
089
sec-butylamine
2e, 6b
Day, Hunter, Scudamore (1)
090
chlorpyrifos-methyl
091
092
cyanofenphos
demeton
093
bioresmethrin
094
methomyl
095
acephate
1p, 2c, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S19; 358), 6a, 7a (6), 7b, 7c (S19), 9a (M5,
M12), 10
096
carbofuran
1e, 1q, 2e, 2g, 3, 4 (XII-6; S25), 6a, 7a (6), 7d(658, 344). 9a (M13), 10
Ambrus, Brauckhoff, Chaput, Lawrence(1), Moellhoff (1) Leppert (1,
2)
097
cartap
Official Gazette
098
dialifos
2a, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S19; 281), 7a (6), 7c (S19), 9a (M2, M5, M12), 10
099
edifenphos
Page 11 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
100
methamidophos
1p, 2c, 2d, 3, 4 (XII-6; S19; 358, 365), 5, 6a, 7a (6), 7c (S19), 9a(M5),
10
101
pirimicarb
102
maleic hydrazide
1m, 4 (297)
Lane, Newsome (3)
103
phosmet
104
daminozide
2e, 6b
Allen (2), Newsome (5), Saxton, Wright, Conditt
105
dithiocarbamates
106
ethephon
2e, 9b
Cochrane
107
ethiofencarb
108
ethylene thiourea
109
fenbutatin oxide
2e, 4 (S24), 6d
Sano
110
imazalil
111
iprodione
2c, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S8, S19; 419), 6e, 7a (6), 7c (S8, S19), 9a (M1,
M12), 10
112
phorate
2a, 2c, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-3, 6; S8, S13, S16, S17, S19), 7a (3, 6), 7c (S8,
S13, S16, S17, S19), 9a (M2, M5)
Abbott (1), Ambrus, Hill
113
propargite
114
guazatine
Kobayashi
Page 12 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
115
tecnazene
116
triforine
2a, 2d, 2e, 3, 4 (XII-6; S8, S12, S19; 108), 7a (6), 7c (S8, S12, S19),
9a (M1), 10
2e, 4 (338), 6d, 9b
Bourke, Newsome (4)
117
aldicarb
118
cypermethrin
119
fenvalerate
2a, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S19, S23), 6g, 7a (6), 7c (S19), 9a (M11), 10
Ambrus, Baker, PG (2), Bottomley
120
permethrin
2a, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S19, S23), 6g, 7a (6), 7c (S19), 9a (M11), 10
Ambrus, Baker, PG (2), Bottomley
121
2,4,5-T
122
amitraz
123
etrimfos
2a, 2c, 2d, 4 (XII-6; S8, S19), 7a (6), 7c (S19), 6e, 9a (M2, M5)
Ambrus, Bottomley, Panel (8)
124
mecarbam
125
methacrifos
4 (XII-6), 7a (6)
Ambrus, Desmarchelier, Panel (7, 8)
126
oxamyl
127
phenothrin
4 (XII-6), 7a (6), 9
Baker, PG (2), Bottomley
128
phenthoate
Page 13 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
129
azocyclotin
4 (S24)
Moellhoff (2)
130
diflubenzuron
131
isofenphos
132
methiocarb
133
triadimefon
2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S8, S19; 425-(605)), 7a (6), 7c (S8, S19), 7d (613,
425, 605) 10
Ambrus, Brennecke (2), Ragab
134
aminocarb
2d, 10
Brauckhoff
135
deltamethrin
136
procymidone
137
bendiocarb
138
metalaxyl
2c, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S8, S19; 517), 7a (6), 7b, 7c (S19),9a (M4), 10
Ambrus
139
butocarboxim
2g, 9a (M13)
Aharonson, Brauckhoff, Li, Muszkat
140
nitrofen
1a, 2a, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S19; 340), 6d, 7a (6), 7b, 7c (S19)
Adler, Ambrus, Yu
141
phoxim
142
prochloraz
2d
Maclaine Pont, Somerville
Page 14 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
143
triazophos
2c, 2d, 4 (XII-4,6; S8, S19; 401), 6d, 7a (6), 7c (S19), 9a(M2, M5,
M12), 10
Ambrus
144
bitertanol
2d, 4 (XII-6; S19; 613; 613A), 7a (6), 7c (S19), 7d (613A, 426, 605),
9a (M12)
Brennecke (1,3)
145
carbosulfan
146
cyhalothrin
2d, 6g
147
methoprene
2e, 6d
148
propamocarb
Gentile
149
ethoprofos
2c, 2d, 2e, 4 (XII-6; S8, S19), 7a (6), 7b, 7c (S19), 9a (M2, M5)
Ambrus
150
propylene thiourea
Lembo, Nitz
151
dimethipin
2e
152
flucythrinate
2d, 2e
153
pyrazophos
2d, 4 (XII-4,6; S8, S19; 328), 6d, 7a (6), 7b, 7c (S19), 9a (M2, M5,
M12), 10
154
thiodicarb
2g
155
benalaxyl
156
clofentezine
Bichi, Snowdon
157
cyfluthrin
158
glyphosate
159
vinclozolin
Page 15 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
160
propiconazole
161
paclobutrazol
2d
Reed
162
tolylfluanid
163
anilazine
164
demeton-S-methylsulphone
165
flusilazole
166
oxydemeton-methyl
167
terbufos
168
triadimenol
169
cyromazine
2e
Cabras, Bardalaye
170
hexaconazole
2d, 11
171
profenofos
2c, 2d, 2e
Andersson
172
bentazone
2e
Cessna, Hogendoorn
173
buprofezin
174
cadusafos
2d
Page 16 of 35
CCPR
number
Compound
References
175
glufosinateammonium
4 (651), 7d (651)
176
hexathiazox
2e
177
abamectin
2e
Prabhu, Vuik
178
bifentrin
2a,2e
179
cycloxydim
180
dithianon
Baker, Kadenczki
181
myclobutanil
2e
182
penconazole
2d
183
propham
184
ethofenprox
185
fenpropathrin
2, 7d (S23)
Nakamura
186
metiram
187
clethodim
188
fenpropimorph
189
tebuconazole
7c(S19)
Brennecke (6), Allmendinger, Maasfeld
190
teflubenzuron
191
tolclofos-methyl
3.
REFERENCES TO LITERATURE
3.1.
General articles
Page 17 of 35
The following papers or books deal with general problems in pesticide residue analysis (cf also
the manuals referred to in par. 3.2):
Ambrus, A. & Thier, H.-P., Application of multi-residue procedures in pesticides residues analysis, Pure
Appl. Chem., 58, 1035-1062 (1986).
Beck, H., Untersuchungsmethoden zur Bestimmung der Rckstnde von ChlorkohlenwasserstoffPestiziden in oder auf Lebensmitteln, Bundesgesundheitsblatt, 17, 269-274 (1974).
Becker, G. et al., Dnnschichtchromatographie in der Rckstandsanalytik von Pflanzenschutzmitteln und
deren Metaboliten, Verlag Chemie VCH, Weinheim, FRG (1987).
Burke, J.A., The interlaboratory study in pesticide residue analyses, in: Advances in Pesticide Science, H.
Geissbuehler (edit.), Pergamon Press, Oxford, UK, 633-642 (1979).
Carl, M., Internal laboratory quality control in the routine determination of chlorinated pesticides, in:
Advances in Pesticide Science, H. Geissbuehler (edit.), Pergamon Press, Oxford, UK, 660-663 (1979).
Cochrane, W.P., Chemical derivatization in pesticide analysis, Plenum Press, New York, N.Y., USA,
(1981).
Egli, H., Storage stability of pesticide residues, J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 30, 861-866 (1982)
Frehse, H. & Timme, G., Quantitative residue analytical reliability: beatitude through the application of
latitude, Res. Revs., 73, 27-47 (1980).
Gunther, F.A., Interpreting pesticide residue data at the analytical level, Res. Revs., 76, 155-171 (1980).
Horwitz, W., The role of the analyst in analytical chemistry, FDA Bylines, 4, 169-178 (1979).
Horwitz, W., The inevitability of variability in pesticide residue analysis, in: Advances in Pesticide
Science, H. Geissbuehler (edit.), Pergamon Press, Oxford, UK, 649-655 (1979).
Horwitz, W. et al., Quality assurance in the analysis of foods for trace constituents, JAOAC, 63,
1344-1354 (1980).
Horwitz, W., Evaluation of analytical methods used for regulation of foods and drugs, Anal. Chem., 54,
67A-76A (1982).
ISO Document ISO 5725, 2nd edit. (1986), Precision of test methods: determination of repeatability and
reproducibility IUPAC Reports on Pesticides (13), Development and evaluation of simplified approaches
to residues analysis, Pure Appl. Chem., 53, 1039-1049 (1981).
Page 18 of 35
Moye, H.A. (edit.), Analysis of pesticide residues, Vol. 58 of: Chemical Analysis, John Wiley and Sons,
New York, N.Y., USA (1981).
Pesticide Residue Analysis, Health Aspects of Chemical Safety, Interim Document 14, WHO, Regional
Office for Europe, Copenhagen, Denmark (1984).
Safe, S. & Hutzinger, O., Mass spectrometry of pesticides and pollutants, CFC Press Inc., Boca Raton,
Florida, USA (1979).
Smart, N., Samples used for interlaboratory studies of methods for pesticide residues analysis in
foodstuffs, Res. Revs., 96, 1-12 (1985).
Steiner, E.H., Planning and analysis of results of collaborative tests, in: Statistical Manual of the AOAC,
Washington, D.C., USA (1974).
The Agrochemical Handbook, The Royal Society of Chemistry, The University, Nottingham, UK, (1983).
Thier, H.-P. & Frehse, H., Rckstandsanalytik von Pflanzenschutzmitteln, Georg Thieme Verlag,
Stuttgart - New York (1986).
Youden, W.J., Statistical techniques for collaborative tests, in: Statistical Manual of the AOAC,
Washington, D.C., USA (1974).
Zweig, G. (edit.), Analytical methods for pesticides, plant growth regulators and food additives Academic
Press, New York - San Francisco - London, Vol. XIV and XV (1986).
3.2.
(1)
Manuals
Official Methods of AOAC INTERNATIONAL, 16th edition (1995)
(a)
(b)
(d)
(e)
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
(o)
(p)
(q)
(2)
970.52
976.23
977.18
975.40
978.16
977.19
960.43
963.24
983.21
984.21
985.22
985.23
Pesticide Analytical Manual, Food and Drug Administration, Washington, D.C., USA
(a)
Vol. I,
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Vol. I,
Vol. I,
Vol. I,
Vol. II,
(f)
Vol. I,
(g)
(h)
Vol. I,
Vol. I,
Page 19 of 35
2nd edition
3rd edition
(3)
Manual on Analytical Methods for Pesticide Residues in Foods, Health Protection Branch, Health
and Welfare Canada, Ottawa, Ont., Canada (1985) (available in English and French)
(4)
(5)
Laboratory Manual for Pesticide Residues Analysis in Agricultural Products, compiled by R.B.
Maybury, Pesticide Laboratory, Food Production and Inspection Branch, Agriculture Canada,
Ottawa, Ont., Canada (1984) (available in English and French).
(6)
Zweig, G. (edit.), Analytical Methods for Pesticides, Plant Growth Regulators , Academic Press,
New York - San Francisco - London
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
(7)
Vol. VII
Vol. VIII
Vol. IX
Vol. X
Vol. XI
Vol. XII
Vol. XIII
Vol. XVI
(1974)
(1976)
(1977)
(1978)
(1980)
(1982) (Lawrence J.F. Editor)
(1984) (Zweig, G. and Sherma, J. Editors)
(1988) (Sherma, J. Editor)
Manual of Pesticide Residue Analysis, Deutsche Forschungsgemeinschaft, VCH Verlagsgesellschaft, Weinheim, FRG (1987) (English translation of ref. 4)
(a) Vol. I,
(b) Vol. I,
(c) Vol. I,
Page 20 of 35
Chemistry Laboratory Guidebook, United States Department of Agriculture, Food Safety and
Inspection Service, Science Program, Washington, D.C., USA
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(9)
Section 5.001
Section 5.002
Section 5.003
Section 5.004
Section 5.006
Section 5.005
Section 5.050
Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides in Foodstuffs, P.A. Greve (edit.), 5th edition,
Government Publishing Office, The Hague, Netherlands (1988)
(a)
(b)
Part I:
(10) Materials and Methods Used for Pesticide Residues Monitoring in Sweden, Vr Fda, 38, Suppl.2,
79-136 (1986)
(11) Comprehensive Analytical Profiles of Important Pesticides (Modern methods for pesticides
analysis) e.d. J. Sherma & T Cairns 1992.
3.3.
Individual papers
The numbers in italics after the references refer to the compounds, indicated by their CCPRnumber, to which the methods involved apply.
Abbott (1), D.C. et al., Pest. Sci., 1, 10-13 (1970)
Pesticide residues in the total diet in England and Wales, 1966-1967; Part III: Organophosphorus
pesticide residues in the total diet
2, 4, 5, 11, 14, 22, 25, 27, 28, 34, 36, 37, 39, 42, 49, 53, 55, 58, 59, 60, 66, 68, 73, 74, 76, 92, 112, 124
Abbott (2), D.C. et al., J. Chromatog., 16, 481-487 (1964)
Some observations on the thin-layer chromatography of organochlorine pesticides
1, 21, 32, 33, 43, 48
Adachi, K. et al., JAOAC, 67, 798-800 (1984)
Simple analytical method for organophosphorus pesticide determination in unpolished rice, using removal
of fats by zinc acetate
22, 27, 37, 49, 58, 128
Adler, I.L. & Wargo Jr, J.P., JAOAC, 58, 551-553 (1975)
Page 21 of 35
Page 22 of 35
Fungicide residues; Part III: The determination of binapacryl in selected fruits by gas chromatography
3
Baker, P.G. (1) et al., Analyst, 105, 282-285 (1980)
Fungicide residues; Part VII: Determination of residues of fentin in vegetables and cocoa products by
spectrofluorimetry
40
Baker, P.G. (2) & Bottomley, P., Analyst, 107, 206-212 (1982)
Determination of residues of synthetic pyrethroids in fruit and vegetables by gas-liquid and
high-performance liquid chromatography
93, 118, 119, 120, 127, 135
Baker, P.G. & Clarke, P.G., Analyst 109, 81-83 (1984)
Determination of residues of dithianon in apples by HPLC
Bardalaye, C, Wheeler, W.B. & Meister C.W. JAOAC 70, 455-457 (1987)
Gas chromatographic determination of cyromazine and its degradation product melamine in chinese
cabbage.
169
Becker, G., Schug, P., Deutsche Lebensm. Rundschau 86, 239-242 (1990)
Eine miniaturmethode zur schnellen Bestimmung von Pestizidrckstnden in pflanzlichen Lebensmitteln.
191
Bichi, C. et al. Pestic. Sci. 30, 13-19 (1990)
Simultaneous determination of clofentezine, fenoxycarb and hexthiazox by HPLC on apples, pears and
their pulps
156
Bottomley, P. & Baker, P.G., Analyst, 109, 85-90 (1984)
Multi-residue determination of organochlorine, organophosphorus and synthetic pyrethroid pesticides in
grain by gas-liquid and high-performance liquid chromatography
1, 4, 21, 22, 25, 37, 44, 49, 61, 66, 86, 90, 93, 118, 119, 120, 123, 127, 135
Bourke, J.B. et al., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 25, 36-39 (1977)
Residues and disappearance of triforine from various crops
116
Brauckhoff, S. & Thier, H.-P., Z. Lebensm. Unters. Forsch., 184, 91-95 (1987)
Analysenmethode fr Rckstnde von Methylcarbamat-Insecticiden in pflanzlichen Lebensmitteln
8, 75, 94, 96, 101, 107, 117, 132, 134, 137, 139
Brennecke (1), R., Pflanzensch. Nachr. Bayer, (Engl. edit.)38, 33-54 (1985)
Method for gas-chromatographic determination of residues of Baycor fungicide in plant material, soil and
Page 23 of 35
Page 24 of 35
Page 25 of 35
Page 26 of 35
Page 27 of 35
Lafuente (2) M.T. et al, Fres. J. Anal. Chem. 328, 105-107 (1987)
GLC multiresidue analysis of postharvest fungicides in citrus fruit
188
Lane (1), J.R., JAOAC, 46, 261-268 (1963)
Collaborative study of maleic hydrazide residue analysis
102
Lane (2), J.R., JAOAC, 48, 744-748 (1965)
Collaborative study of maleic hydrazide residue analysis
102
Lawrence(1), J.F., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 25, 211-212 (1977)
Direct analysis of some carbamate pesticides in foods by high-pressure liquid chromatography
8, 75, 96
Lawrence (2), J.F. & Panopio, L.G. JAOAC 63, 1300-1303 (1980)
Comparison of gas and liquid chromatography for determination of anilazine in potatoes and tomatoes.
163
Lembo, S. et al., J. Chromatog., 267, 427-430 (1983)
Gas-liquid chromatographic method for determining propylenethiourea in rat tissues and fluids
150
Leppert (1), B.C. et al., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 31, 220-223 (1983)
Determination of carbosulfan and carbofuran residues in plants, soil, and water by gas chromatography
145
Leppert (2), B.C. et al., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 32, 1441 (1984)
Comment on recovery of carbosulfan residues from acidic crops
145
Li Yu-Chang et al., Fres. Z. Anal. Chem., 316, 290-292 (1983)
Methode zur Bestimmung von Rckstnden an Butocarboxim in Pflanzen und Boden mit Hilfe der HPLC
139
Lokke (1), H., J. Chromatog., 200, 234-237 (1980)
Determination of amitrole by ion-pair high-performance liquid chromatography
79
Lokke (2), H., J. Chromatog., 179, 259-270 (1979)
Investigation on loss of chlorothalonil, dichlofluanid, tolylfluanid and vinclozolin by column
chromatography clean-up on silver-loaded alumina in a gas chromatographic multiresidue procedure
81, 82
Page 28 of 35
Lokke (3), H. & Odgaard, P., Pest. Sci., 12, 375-384 (1981)
Residues in blackcurrants, fodder peas, spinach and potatoes treated with sublethal doses of 2,4,5-T to
simulate wind drift damage
121
Lord, E. et al., J. Assoc. Publ. Anal., 16, 25-32 (1978)
The determination of biphenyl and 2-hydroxybiphenyl in citrus fruit
29, 56
Lott, P.F. et al., J. Chromat. Sci., 16, 390-395 (1978)
The determination of paraquat
57
Love, J.L. & Patterson, J.E., JAOAC, 61, 627-628 (1978)
Atomic absorption spectrometric determination of cyhexatin
67
Lubkowitz, J.A. et al., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 21, 143-144 (1973)
Residue studies of O,S-dimethyl phosphoroamidothioate on tomatoes
100
Luke, B.G. & Cossens, S.A., Bull. Envir. Cont. Tox., 24, 746-751 (1980)
Determination of diphenylamine residues in apples
30
Maasfeld, Pflanzenschutz Nachr. Bayer 40, 29-48 (1987) German Ed.
Method for GC determination of residues of the fungicide Folicur in plant material
189
Maclaine Pont, M.A. et al., Meded. Fac. Landbouww. Rijksuniv. Gent, 45, 835-840 (1980)
The residue analysis of prochloraz in combination with dicloran
142
Mendes, M.C.S. J. Agric. Fd. Chem. 38 174-178 (1990)
Evaluation and confirmation of acetylation gas liquid chromatographic method for the determination of
triadimenol in foods.
168
Mestres (1), R. et al., Trav. Soc. Pharm. Montpellier, 35, 87-100 (1975)
Mthode rapide de controle et de dosage des rsidus d'ortho-phnyl phnol et de biphnyle dans les
agrumes
29, 56, 72, 77
Mestres (2), R. et al., Ann. Fals. Exp. Chim., 73, 407-420 (1980)
Page 29 of 35
Mthode de recherche et de dosage des rsidus de pesticides dans les produits craliers; 2o: Fumigants
9, 10, 23, 24, 52
Mestres (3), R. et al., Proc. Int. Soc. Citricult., 3, 1103-1106 (1977)
Thiophanate-methyl postharvest residues in oranges
65, 72, 77
Moellhoff (1), E., Pflanzensch. Nachr. Bayer (Engl. edit.), 28, 370-381 (1975)
Method for gas-chromatographic determination of Curaterr residues in plants and soil samples with
consideration to metabolites
96
Moellhoff (2), E., Pflanzensch. Nachr. Bayer (Engl. edit.), 30, 249-263 (1977)
Method for gas-chromatographic determination of Peropal acaricide and its metabolites in plants, soil,
water and laboratory animal chow
67, 129
Muszkat, L. & Aharonson, N., J. Chromat. Sci., 21, 411-414 (1983)
GC/CI/MS analysis of aldicarb, butocarboxime, and their metabolites
117, 139
Nakamura et al., J. AOAC 76, 1348-1361 (1993)
Determination of pyrethroid residues in vegetables, fruits, grains, beans and green tea.
185
Newsome (1), W.H., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 24, 997-999 (1976)
A gas-liquid chromatographic method for the determination of dodine residues in foods
84
Newsome (2), W.H., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 22, 887-889 (1974)
A method for determining ethylenebis(dithiocarbamate) residues on food crops as bis(trifluoroacetamido)ethane
105
Newsome (3), W.H., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 28, 270-272 (1980)
A method for the determination of maleic hydrazide and its b-D-glucoside in foods by high-pressure
anion-exchange liquid chromatography
102
Newsome (4), W.H., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 30, 778-779 (1982)
Determination of triforine in fruit crops as N,N'-bis(pentafluorobenzoyl)piperazine
116
Newsome (5), W.H., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 28, 319-321 (1980)
Determination of daminozide residues on foods and its degradation to 1,1-
Page 30 of 35
dimethylhydrazine by cooking
104
Nishizawa, H., et al, JAOAC accepted for publication
Simple clean-up procedure for residue analysis of buprofezin and its metabolites in crops by GC
Nitz, S. et al., J. Agr. Fd. Chem., 30, 593-596 (1982)
A capillary gas-liquid chromatographic method for determination of ethylenethiourea and propylene
thiourea in hops, beer, and grapes
108, 150
Official Gazette, no. 4 of the Notification issued on March 20, 1979, by the Japan Environment Agency
Residue analysis of cartap hydrochloride
97
Ott, D.E. & Gunther, F.A., JAOAC, 909-912 (1982)
Field screening method for above-tolerance residues of dithiocarbamate fungicides
105
Otto, S. et al., J. Envir. Sci. Health, Part B, 12, 179-191 (1977)
A new gas chromatographic determination of ethylene thiourea residues without derivatization
108
Panel (1) of the Committee for Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides and Veterinary Products in
Foodstuffs of the Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food, Analyst, 98, 19-24 (1973)
The determination of malathion and dichlorvos residues in grain
25, 49
Panel (2) of the Committee for Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides and Veterinary Products in
Foodstuffs of the Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food, Analyst, 101, 386-390 (1976)
Determination of residues of inorganic bromide in grain
4
Panel (3) of the Committee for Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides and Veterinary Products in
Foodstuffs of the Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food, Analyst, 102, 858-868 (1977)
Determination of residues of organophosphorus pesticides in fruits and vegetables
2, 27, 49, 55, 58
Panel (4) of the Committee for Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides and Veterinary Products in
Foodstuffs of the Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food, Analyst, 104, 425-433 (1979)
Determination of organochlorine pesticides in animal fats and eggs
1, 21, 33, 44, 48
Panel (5) of the Committee for Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides and Veterinary Products in
Foodstuffs of the Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food, Analyst, 99, 570-576 (1974)
The determination of residues of volatile fumigants in grain
Page 31 of 35
10, 23
Panel (6) of the Committee for Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides and Veterinary Products in
Foodstuffs of the Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food, Analyst, 106, 782-787 (1981)
Determination of residues of dithiocarbamate pesticides in foodstuffs by a headspace method
105
Panel (7) of the Committee for Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides and Veterinary Products in
Foodstuffs of the Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food, Analyst, 105, 515-517 (1980)
Determination of a range of organophosphorus pesticide residues in grain
4, 22, 27, 37, 49, 74, 86, 112
Panel (8) of the Committee for Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides and Veterinary Products in
Foodstuffs of the Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food, Analyst, 110, 765-768 (1985)
Determination of a range of organophosphorus pesticide residues in grain
4, 27, 37, 49, 86, 90, 123, 125
Panel (9) of the Committee for Analytical Methods for Residues of Pesticides and Veterinary Products in
Foodstuffs of the Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food, Analyst, 112, 1559-1563 (1987)
Determination of ethylenethiourea in canned fruits and vegetables
108
Phillips, A.J.L., Phytophylactica 24 289-292 (1992). Bioassay of tolclofos-methyl in bean seed.
191
Player, R.B. & Wood, R., J. Assoc. Publ. Anal., 18, 109-117 (1980)
Methods of analysis - collaborative studies; Part III: Determination of biphenyl and 2-hydroxy- biphenyl in
citrus fruit
29, 56
van der Poll, J.M., Vink, M. and Quirijns, J.K. Chromatographia, 30, 155-158, 1990.
Determination of amitrole in plant tissues and sandy soils by capillary gaschromatography with alkali
flame ionization detection.
79
Pomerantz, I.H. & Ross, R., JAOAC, 51, 1058-1062 (1968)
Captan and structurally related compounds: thin layer and gas-liquid chromatography
6, 7, 41
Prabhu, S.V., Varsolona, R.J., Welmer. T.A. , Egan, R.S. and Tway, P.C. J. Agr. Fd. Chem. 40,622-625
(1992)
Rapid and sensitive high performance liquid chromatographic method for the quantificxation of
abamectine and its delta 8,9 isomer.
177
Pyysalo, H. et al., J. Chromatog., 168, 512-516 (1979)
Page 32 of 35
Extraction and determination of o-phenylphenol and biphenyl in citrus fruits and apples
29, 56
Ragab, M.T.H. Anderson, M.G. & Johnston, H.W. Bull Envir. Contam. Toxicol. 44, 100-105 (1990)
Residue analysis of triadimefon, triadimenol and the BAY KWG1342 diol and BAY KWG1323
hydroxylated matabolites in winterweed.
133, 168
Rains, D.M. & Holder, J.W., JAOAC, 64, 1252-1254 (1981)
Ethylene dibromide residues in biscuits and commercial flour
23
Rajzman, A., Analyst, 99, 120-127 (1974)
Determination of thiabendazole in citrus fruits by ultraviolet spectrophotometry
65
Reed, A.N., J. Chromatogr. 438, 393-400 (1988)
Quantification of triazole and pyrimidine plant growth retardants
161
Rosenberg, C. & Siltanen, H., Bull. Envir. Cont. Tox., 22, 475-478 (1979)
Residues of mancozeb and ethylenethiourea in grain samples
108
Roughan, J.A. et al., Analyst, 108, 742-747 (1983)
Modified gas-liquid chromatographic method for determining bromide/total bromine in foodstuffs and
soils
47
Sachse, J., Z. Lebensm. Unters. Forsch., 163, 274-277 (1977)
ber die Bestimmung von Chlorcholinchlorid (CCC) in Getreide
15
Sano, M. et al., JAOAC, 62, 764-768 (1979)
Flameless atomic absorption spectrophotometric determination of Vendex, an organic tin miticide, in
apples, oranges, and tea leaves
109
Saxton W.L et al. J. Agric. Food Chem., 37, 570-573 (1989)
Results of a survey for the presence of daminozide and unsymmetrical dimethylhydrazine in food.
104
Scudamore (1), K.A., Analyst, 105, 1171-1175 (1980)
Determination of 2-aminobutane in potatoes using high-performance liquid chromatography
89
Page 33 of 35
Scudamore (2), K.A. & Goodship, G., Pest. Sci., 17, 385-395 (1986)
Determination of phosphine residues in fumigated cereals and other foodstuffs
46
Snowdon, P.G., et al, Fresenius J. Anal. Chem. 339, 444-447 (1991)
The hydrolysis of clofentazine and related tetrazines as the basis of determination of residues in bovine
tissues.
Somerville, L., Meded. Fac. Landbouww. Rijksuniv. Gent, 45, 841-848 (1980)
The analysis of prochloraz residues in cereals
142
Specht (1), W. & Tillkes, M., Fres. Z. Anal. Chem., 307, 257-264 (1981)
Gas-chromatographische Bestimmung von Rckstnden von Pflanzenbehandlungsmitteln nach Clean-up
ber
Gel-Chromatographie
und
Mini-Kieselgel-Sulen-Chromatographie;
4.
Mitteilung:
Gas-chromatographische Bestimmung von 11 herbiciden Phenoxyalkancarbonsuren und ihren Estern in
Pflanzenmaterial
20, 121
Specht (2), W and Tilkes, M, Fres. Z. Anal. Chem., 322, 443-455 (1985)
Gas-chromatographische Bestimmung von Rckstanden von Pflanzenbehandlungsmitteln nach Clean-up
ber Gel-Chromatographie und Mini-Kieselgel-Sulen-Chromatographie, V. Methode zur aufarbeitung
von Lebensmitteln und Futtermitteln plantzlicher und tierischer Herkunft fr
die bestimmung lipoid und wasserlslicher Pflanzenbehandlungsmittel.
162
Stan, H.J., Heil, S., Fresenius J. Anal, Chem. 339, 34-39 (1991)
Two dimensional capillary gaschromatography with three selective detectors as a valuable tool in residue
analysis - State of the art
191
Stijve (1), T., Deutsche Lebensm. Rundsch., 77, 99-101 (1981)
Gas chromatographic determination of inorganic bromide residues - a simplified procedure
47
Stijve (2), T., IUPAC Pesticide Chemistry, Human Welfare and the Environment, J. Miyamoto (edit.),
Pergamon Press, Oxford, UK, 95-100 (1983)
Miniaturised methods for monitoring organochlorine pesticide residues in milk
1, 21, 43, 44, 48, 71
Stijve (3), T. & Brand, E., Deutsche Lebensm. Rundsch., 73, 41-43 (1977)
A rapid, low cost, small-scale clean-up method for the determination of organochlorine pesticide residues
in fats and oils
1, 12, 21, 43, 44, 48
Page 34 of 35
Page 35 of 35
fr
Van Zoonen, P., E.A. Hogendoorn, D.C. van Harten, Meded. Fac. Landbouwwetenschappen
Rijksuniversiteit Gent, 55 (3b), 1285-1290 (1990)
Determination of fenpropimorph residues in grains by LC followed by confirmation by GC-MPD.
188
Department of Health
PERISHABLE FOODS
2
PERISHABLE FOODS
2.1
GENERAL
(i)
Perishable foods shall be delivered at the places and at the times indicated by the
ordering officer.
2.2
(ii)
Any article not expressly referred to herein shall be of a quality that corresponds to
the expression "the best of its kind in accordance with normal trade practice.
(iii)
(iv)
(v)
All foods delivered in terms of a contract shall be subject to inspection and approval
by inspectors of the Directorate of Plant and Quality Control of the Department of
Agriculture or any assignee designated in terms of section 2(3) (a) of the
Agricultural Product Standards Act, 1990 (Act No.119 of 1990), or medical health
officers, where and when available, at the dispatching or delivery points.
(vi)
Whenever tenders are submitted for any article to which the Foodstuffs, Cosmetics
and Disinfectants Act, 1973 (Act No.54 of 1973), and/or the Agricultural Product
Standards Act, 1990 (Act NO. 119 of 1990), and any regulations made in terms
thereof apply. This means that, if a contract has been entered into for any article, all
such articles shall be delivered strictly in terms of the provisions of the said Acts.
(vii)
The procedure concerning the taking and testing of samples of delivered products,
as set out in these Acts, shall be complied with.
(viii)
The Department reserves the right to conduct inspections of the production process,
the product, and the premises of the supplier without prior notification at any
working time during the contract period or prior to entering into a contract. In the
event of a deviation being observed, the whole consignment shall be rejected.
BAKERS' PRODUCTS
2.2.1 BREAD
The following specifications for bread shall be read with Government Notice R.577,
published in Regulation Gazette of 15 March 1991, and any subsequent amendments made
in terms of the Marketing Act, 1968 (Act No.59 of 1968):
Only white, brown and whole-wheat bread, as defined in the above regulations, shall
be required.
Department of Health
2001
2.3
All bread shall be fresh, well made, properly baked, clean and free from any ropiness,
grit and other foreign matter and may, in addition to meal flour. Contain only such
ingredients as are normally used to bake bread of the highest quality of a particular
type.
Bread shall be delivered daily at times mutually agreed upon and the bread, shall be of
the required form and mass. The receiving officer may require that the bread not be
delivered before the lapse of a number of hours, but not more than 48 hours, after it
has been baked.
EGGS
2.4
All products delivered shall comply with at least the grading, quality. packing and
marking requirements for Grade A slaughter poultry as set out in the regulations made
in terms of section 15 of the Agricultural Product Standards Act, 1990 (Annexure B).
DAIRY PRODUCTS
2.6
All products delivered shall comply with at least the quality, packing and marking
requirements for Grade 1 eggs, as set out in the regulations made in terms of section
15 of the Agricultural Product Standards Act, 1990 (Annexure A).
POULTRY
2.5
Department of Health
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for dairy products
and imitation dairy products as set out in Government Notice R.2581 of 20
November1987, as amended.
Whenever milk or milk products are delivered the milk products must be labelled and
the expiry date stamped.
Milk and milk products shall be delivered daily or twice a day, as required by the
receiving officer and on the hour or hours determined by him/ her (Annexure C).
VEGETABLES
All vegetables shall be fresh, cut correctly and be without leaves or waste.
When ordering, ordering officers shall state the quantity/mass of each type of
vegetable required, and the contractor shall be obliged to deliver the required
quantity/mass, providing that the vegetables are in season.
In all cases in which vegetables are to be dispatched by rail, such vegetables shall be
packed as they are usually packed in the trade. The cost of all containers shall be borne
by the suppliers, and containers shall be kept or returned by rail (pay railage) only at
the request of the contractors.
2.6.1 Potatoes
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for Class I potatoes
as set out in Government Notice R.2119 of 1 October 1982, as amended (Annexure D).
Department of Health
2001
Department of Health
2.6.2 General
The following products shall, when delivered, comply with at least the specifications for
Export Grade as set out in Government Notice R.263 of 20 February 1970, as amended:
o Beetroot
o Lettuce
o Cauliflower
o Carrots and parsnips
o Green beans
o Green peas
o Cucumbers
o Cabbages
o Pumpkins
o Sweet potatoes
o Turnips
o Celery and Spinach (Annexure E).
2.6.3 Other products
o Brinjals o Hubbard squash o Gem squash o Marrow o Parsley o Leek o Rhubarb o Green mealies -
see
see
see
see
see
see
see
see
Celery
Pumpkins
Pumpkins
Pumpkins
Celery and Spinach
Celery and Spinach
Celery and Spinach
Annexure F
2.6.4 Tomatoes
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for Class 1 and 2
tomatoes as set out in Government Notice R.1978 of 7 September 1984, as amended
(Annexure G).
2.6.5 Onions
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for Class II onions as
set out in Government Notice R. 1268 of 19 June 1981,as amended (Annexure H).
2.7
FRESH FRUIT
Ordering officers shall, on ordering, mention the quantity/mass of each type of fruit
required and the contractor shall be obliged to deliver the required quantity/mass, providing
that the fruit is in season.
"Mature/maturity" means that the fruit has reached a stage of development that will
ensure ripening and a good eating quality.
Clean" means free from dirt, spray residues or other foreign matter.
Department of Health
2001
Department of Health
"Overripe" means a soft, moist condition in which the fruit is not firm and can no
longer withstand normal handling.
"Woolly" means that the flesh of the fruit is partly or completely spongy, dry and
possibly floury with a bad taste or a taste not characteristic of the fruit in question.
Diameter means the greatest distance through the middle of the fruit, measured at
a right angle to a line running from the stem end to the apex.
2.7.2 Apples
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for Class 2 apples as
set out in Government Notice R.2208 of 10 November 1978, as amended (Annexure I).
2.7.3 Avocados
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for Class1 avocados
as set out in Government Notice R.537 of 1 April 1976, as amended (Annexure J).
2.7.4 Deciduous fruit
The following products shall, when delivered, comply with the specifications for Class 2
(Annexure K) as set out in the under-mentioned Government Notices, as amended:
o Grapes shall comply only with the requirements for Class 3 - R.2176 of 3
November 1978.
o Nectarines - R.2119 of 27 October 1978.
o Peaches R.2119 of 27 October 1978.
o Pears R.2177 of 3 November 1978.
o Plums R.2120 of 27 October 1978.
o Prunes R.2120 of 27 October 1978.
2.7.5 Other fruit
All products of the following types delivered shall comply with the specifications as set
out (Annexure L):
o Apricots
o Guavas
o Mangoes
o Pawpaws
2.7.6 Citrus fruit
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for Choice Grade
citrus fruit as set out in Government Notice R.1137 of 13 June 1975, as amended.
(Draft amendments of the said regulation shall be applicable in practice until further
notice.) (Annexure M).
Department of Health
2001
Department of Health
2.7.7 Pineapples
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for Choice Grade
(Class 1) pineapples as set out in Government Notice R.295 of 26 February 1971, as
amended (Annexure N).
2.7.8 Bananas
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for Grade 1 bananas,
as set out in Government Notice R.126 of 17 January 1975, as amended (Annexure O).
2.7.9 Melons and watermelons
All products delivered shall comply with at least the specifications for Class 1 melons
and watermelons, as set out in Government Notice R .701 of 3 April 1981, as amended
(Annexure P).
2.8
MEAT
All products delivered shall comply with the specifications for the various grades of
meat, as set out in Government Notice R.2120 of 20 September 1985, as amended
(Annexure Q).
Department of Health
2001
Department of Health
PERISHABLE FOODS
ANNEXURE A
EGGS
1
1.1
Extra large
Large
Medium
The eggs shall be clean and have sound shells and a regular and strong form.
(ii)
Yolks may be slightly visible, yet not spotted, of a good colour and not flat or
enlarged.
(iii)
(iv)
The shell membrane may be slightly quivery, shall not move more than 6 mm and
shall not include swimmers.
(v)
Eggs shall be free from blood, blood spots, meat spots, blood rings, absorbed
odours, any signs of embryo development, mould, mustiness or foreign flavours.
Department of Health
10
2001
Department of Health
ANNEXURE B
POULTRY
1
POULTRY
1.1
FRESH, REFRIGERATED
Poultry shall be killed by a method that causes external bleeding and be well bled.
o The carcass temperature shall not exceed 7C during storage and transportation.
1.2
FROZEN
Frozen slaughtered poultry carcasses shall comply with the requirements for fresh
slaughtered poultry. The carcass temperature shall not exceed -12C during storage
and transportation.
Department of Health
11
2001
Department of Health
ANNEXURE C
DIARY PRODUCTS
1
MILK
1.1
RAW MATERIALS:
1.2
Milk should be from a certified dairy and milk must not be diluted.
Milk shall be produced only in a dairy or another building that has been built in
accordance with specifications and that is properly maintained in accordance with the
regulations of the local authorities. The strictest hygienic measures shall be applied in
the production, handling and delivery of milk, and the dairy shall be inspected at any
time before and also during the contract period.
1.3
Milk delivered shall comply with the requirements of the local health authority in the
said area in question.
The milk shall be the mixed milk obtained from a herd of dairy cows during the
normal lactation period, and on no account shall the milk of one single cow be
delivered. The milk of individual cows of the herd shall be mixed effectively and be
refrigerated effectively immediately. The temperature of the milk may, after
refrigeration and until delivered, not at all rise above 6C. No preservative or any
other additive may be added to the milk. No colostrum may be present. Raw milk
must be free from antibiotics and must be of a pH 6.55-6.7. The raw milk is to be
pasteurised.
The product shall remain fresh until at least the expiry date printed on the container,
if kept below 7C. The product shall have the typical fresh, slightly sweet taste of
normal milk. No flavours and/or foreign matter may be present in the product.
MICROBIOLOGICAL REQUIREMENTS
<300 000/ ml
Absent in 1 ml
Absent
6.55 6.7
The product shall be packed into suitable containers as specified by the institution to
be free from any leakage. Secondary packaging (where applicable) is to be clean and
Department of Health
12
2001
1.5
2.1
The product shall be transported at a temperature of 0-7C, i.e. the delivery truck
must be cooled and not only insulated. A truck with a canopy is therefore unsuitable.
The product shall be delivered at temperatures not exceeding 7C.
has to protect the content. The company, product and production date, as well as a
best before date shall be visible on the packaging for storage and rotation purposes.
TRANSPORTATION
1.6
Department of Health
Department of Health
13
2001
Compliance Guide
Table of Contents
Introduction .........................................3
Format ...............................................4
Introduction
On October 20, 1999, the Food Safety Inspection Service (FSIS)
published a final rulemaking in the Federal Register that
establishes regulatory sanitation performance standards
applicable to all official meat and poultry establishments.
(FSIS Docket 96-037F; 64 FR 56400) Performance standards
set forth requirements in terms of an objective to be
achieved, but do not prescribe the means to achieve that
objective. Therefore, to meet the sanitation performance
standards, establishments may develop and employ sanitation
or processing procedures customized to the nature and
volume of their production.
In this document, FSIS presents or references methods
sanitation procedures.
Format
Guidance for each performance standard is set forth as
follows:
' 416.2(b)
(1)
Construction.
Comments
In a recent FSIS Directive to its inspectors
Additional information concerning the performance standard
Food Code
6-201.11
http://vm.cfsan.fda.gov/~dms/foodcode.html
http://www.ntis.gov/index.html
or by mail from:
Other Codes
In this guide, FSIS cites construction, plumbing, and
RDAD, OPPDE
Washington, DC 20250-3700
address:
Matthew.Michael@usda.gov
' 416.1
General rules.
adulterated.
Comments
Proper sanitation is a fundamental requirement under both
Food Code
-Other Sources of Guidance
--
Comments
Grounds
operations it conducts.
establishment.
Pest Control
6-202.19
Drain.
drain.
6-202.13
10
7-202.12
Conditions of Use.
establishment,
I - Classification of Pesticides.
7-206.13
11
12
'' 416.2(b)
Construction.
adulteration of product.
mice.
conditions.
Comments
Here are some examples of noncompliance with these
standards commonly reported by inspectors. They are not
all inclusive; they represent noncompliance only with the
performance standards in ' 416.2(b), provisions (1) through
(3).
Doors not closing tightly allowing the entrance of
vermin, dirt, or dust;
Holes in ceilings or windows allowing the entrance of
vermin, dirt, or dust;
Scaling rust or scaling paint in edible areas on
ceilings or walls;
13
6-201.14
14
method; and
the carpet and the wall and with the edges of the carpet
6-201.15
easily cleanable.
6-201.16
6-201.17
kept clean.
6-201.18
15
6-202.15
limiting condition.
6-202.16
6-501.11
Repairing.
6-501.12
16
6-501.13
cleaning.
Inc.
5795 USA.
Email: codes@bocai.org
and:
Email: info@sbcci.org
17
'416.2(c)
Light.
Comments
Establishments should keep in mind that their lighting
Intensity.
consumption;
18
19
' 416.2(d)
Ventilation.
Comments
In regard to condensation, keep in mind that some forms are
REQUIRED
follow:
of freezing operations.
20
1.
chutes.
ACTION
carcasses.
exposed product.
packaging.
Food Code
4-301.14
21
6-202.12
Vents.
6-304.11
Mechanical.
provided.
22
' 416.2(e)
Plumbing.
Comments
-Food Code
5-201.11
Approved.
according to law.
5-202.13
An air gap between the water supply inlet and the flood
23
5-202.14
5-202.15
Officials
Walnut CA 91789-2825
ASME International
Phone: 1-800-843-2763
24
Fax: 1-973-882-1717
Email: infocentral@asme.org.
401 M Street, SW
Washington, DC 20460-0003
Phone: 202-260-5543
http://www.epa.gov/safewater/about.html#fax
25
Comments
-Food Code
4-204.17
5-402.10
5-402.11
Backflow Prevention.
5-402.12
Grease Trap.
26
5-402.13
Conveying Sewage.
5-402.15
servicing operation.
5-403.11
is:
law.
5-403.12
27
least semi-annually.
product may be reused for the same purpose provided that measures
product.
28
establishment.
Comments
-Food Code
5-101.11
Approved System.
that is:
5-101.12
5-102.11
Standards.
5-102.12
Nondrinking Water.
29
5-102.13
Sampling.
regulations.
5-102.14
Sample Report.
30
' 416.2(h)
toilets.
handled.
product.
Comments
-Food Code
5-202.12
Flow.
5-501.10
5-501.13
Receptacles.
31
(B) Plastic bags and wet strength paper bags may be used to
line receptacles for storage inside the food establishment,
1910.141 (c)(1)(i)
Except as otherwise indicated in this paragraph (c)(1)(i),
rooms for each sex need not be provided. Where such single-
TABLE J-1
Number of employees
|
1 to 15 ...............|
16 to 35 ..............|
36 to 55 ..............|
56 to 80 ..............|
81 to 110 .............|
32
(2)
Footnote(2)
40 employees.
33
cleaning and to ensure that their use will not cause the
Comments
-Food Code
Multiuse
4-101.11
Characteristics.
shall be:
(A) Safe;
(B) Durable, corrosion-resistant, and nonabsorbent;
(C) Sufficient in weight and thickness to withstand
repeated warewashing;
4-101.16
34
4-101.18
4-101.19
food-contact surface.
Characteristics.
use articles:
35
4-201.12
Cleanability
4-202.11
Food-Contact Surfaces.
following methods:
4-202.12
constructed so that:
and
cleaned.
36
4-202.16
Nonfood-Contact Surfaces.
maintenance.
4-202.18
Functionality
4-204.11
use articles.
4-204.12
of an inch).
the equipment.
and
37
4-204.15
4-204.18
Acceptability
4-205.10
Location
4-401.11 Equipment, Clothes Washers and Dryers, and
Storage Cabinets, Contamination Prevention.
(A) Except as specified in (B) of this section,
equipment, a cabinet used for the storage of food, or a
38
thirty-second inch; or
10 centimeters (4 inches).
(E) The clearance space between the table and tablemounted equipment may be:
for cleaning; or
39
for cleaning.
Equipment
4-501.11
4-501.12
Cutting Surfaces.
40
product.
establishments.
Comments
In regard to the use of cleaners, sanitizers, and
document.
Food Code
Objective
4-601.11 Equipment, Food-Contact Surfaces, Nonfood-Contact
Surfaces, and Utensils.*
(A) Equipment food-contact surfaces and utensils shall
be clean to sight and touch.
41
Frequency
4-602.11
temperature:
Temperature
Cleaning Frequency
5.0C (41F)
24 hours
42
or less
>5.0C - 7.2C
(>41F - 45F)
20 hours
>7.2C - 10.0C
(>45F - 50F)
16 hours
>10.0C - 12.8C
(>50F - 55F)
10 hours
and
(b) The cleaning frequency based on the ambient
temperature of the refrigerated room or area is documented
Chapter 3;
disease.
;or,
43
shall be cleaned:
4-602.12
602.11(D)(6).
4-602.13
Nonfood-Contact Surfaces.
residues.
Methods
4-603.11
Dry Cleaning.
are soiled with dry food residues that are not potentially
hazardous.
(B) Cleaning equipment used in dry cleaning foodcontact surfaces may not be used for
4-603.12
Precleaning.
abrasives.
4-603.14
Wet Cleaning.
44
ultrasonic devices.
4-701.10
sanitized.
4-702.11
4-703.11
providing:
in Subparagraph 1-201.10(B)(70).
45
Drying
4-901.11
4-901.12
Food-Contact Surfaces.
food-contact surfaces.
4-902.12
Equipment.
Storing
4-903.11 Equipment, Utensils, Linens, and Single-Service
and Single-Use Articles.
(A) Except as specified in (D) of this section,
cleaned equipment and utensils, laundered linens, and
46
until used.
4-903.12
Prohibitions.
be stored:
--
47
product.
Comments
-Food Code
2-301.11
Clean Condition.
2-301.12
Cleaning Procedure.
fingers.
48
2-301.14
When to Wash.
2-301.15
Where to Wash.
2-301.16
Hand Sanitizers.
(ii)
49
and
shall be:
Fingernails
2-302.11
Maintenance.
Jewelry
2-303.11
Prohibition.
50
Outer Clothing
2-304.11
Clean Condition.
contamination of:
articles.
2-401.12
single-use articles.
Hair Restraints
2-402.11
Effectiveness.
51
52
Comments
-Food Code
-Other Sources of Guidance
--
53
Appendix 1:
performance standards.
54
SUBJECT
PERFORMANCE
STANDARDS
PAST REGULATION(S)
General sanitation
' 416.1
' 416.2(a)
Establishment
Construction
' 416.2(b)
Light
' 416.2(c)
Ventilation
' 416.2(d)
Plumbing
' 416.2(e)
Sewage disposal
' 416.2(f)
' 416.2(g)
Dressing rooms,
lavatories, and toilets
' 416.2(h)
' 416.3
Food-contact surface
cleaning and sanitation
' 416.4(a)
Non-food-contact surface
cleaning and sanitation
' 416.4(b)
' 416.4(c)
' 381.60.
Operational sanitation
' 416.4(d)
Employee hygiene
' 416.5(a)
Employee clothing
' 416.5(b)
Employee disease
' 416.5(c)
Tagging insanitary
equipment, rooms, or
compartments
' 416.6
55
PART 308--SANITATION
advance of construction.
requirements.
compartments.
(EST)equipment.
Sec. 308.1
Examination and specifications for equipment
Sec. 308.2
Drawings and specifications to be furnished in
advance of construction.
56
Sec. 308.3
Establishments; sanitary condition;
requirements.
57
provided:
specific cases.
thorough cleanup.
holding areas.
58
livestock pens.
Sec. 308.4
Sanitary facilities and accommodations;
specific requirements.
A list of approved pest control substances is available upon request to the Scientific
Services, Meat and Poultry Inspection, Food Safety and Inspection Service, U.S.
59
Sec. 308.5
Equipment and utensils to be easily cleaned;
to identify them as only for such use and shall not be used
60
subchapter.
Sec. 308.6
clean.
Sec. 308.7
sanitary.
61
handled.
Sec. 308.8
Operations, procedures, rooms, clothing,
contamination of product.
preparation of product.
charge.
Meat and Poultry Inspection, Food Safety and Inspection Service, U.S. Department of
62
product.
Sec. 308.9
establishments.
Sec. 308.10
Slack barrels and similar containers and
product.
sanitary condition.
does not tear during use but remains intact when moistened
Sec. 308.11
wrapping for meat deposits lint on the meat and does not
63
Sec. 308.12
containers.
Sec. 308.13
Inedible operating and storage rooms; outer
and areas where cars and vehicles are loaded, and the
or on its premises.
Sec. 308.14
64
microbiological contaminants.
Sec. 308.15
Tagging insanitary equipment, utensils, rooms
or compartments.
stimulating (EST)equipment.
Equipment and Sanitation Division, Technical Services, Food Safety and Inspection
65
66
Subpart H--Sanitation
Sec. 381.46
Buildings.
Sec. 381.47
resistant.
67
locking.
or less.
sanitary.
or stored.
building.
Sec. 381.48
68
Sec. 381.49
and vents. The sewer system shall have adequate slope and
suitable covers.
69
of this paragraph.
Sec. 381.50
Water supply.
purposes.
the rooms.
70
containers, provided:
Sec. 381.51
facilities.
shall be provided.
conducted.
other wastes.
71
contact element after each use. Both hot and cold running
deg.F.
Number of persons
Minimum number
of same sex:
of facilities
--------------------------------------------------------l to
9 ......................
l.
l0 to 24 ......................
2.
25 to 49 ......................
3.
50 to 74 ......................
4.
75 to l00 ......................
5.
Over l00
.....................
(1 for each additional
30 persons)
Sec. 381.52
72
condensation.
Sec. 381.53
identify them as only for such use and shall not be used
73
in this subchapter.
74
official establishment.
carried off.
inspection.
noncorrosive metal.
completely removed.
75
Sec. 381.54
Accessibility of equipment.
operations.
feathers.
Sec. 381.55
utensils.
Sec. 381.56
Maintenance of sanitary conditions and
containing equipment.
76
establishment.
Sec. 381.57
Sec. 381.58
establishment daily.
sanitary condition.
77
Sec. 381.59
Vermin.
Sec. 381.60
Use of compounds.
following procedure:
by this subparagraph.
78
Sec. 381.61
Cleanliness and hygiene of official
establishment personnel.
microbiological contaminants.
79
engaged.
80
Appendix 2:
Chemical Use
General Standards
1. Establishments are responsible for ensuring the safety
substances.
81
Cleaners
Cleaners are used frequently throughout the plant both in
processing and non-processing areas. They are needed to
maintain sanitary conditions to assure an environment
conducive to the production of safe, wholesome,
unadulterated food product. Examples of cleaners and their
previous numerical designations from the discontinued List
of Proprietary Substances and Nonfood Compounds follow.
Examples
Formerly A1 Compounds for use as general cleaning agents
Formerly
departments.
temperatures.
Formerly
A6 Scouring cleaners.
surfaces.
in nonprocessing areas.
Standards
1. Cleaners should be formulated to be safe and appropriate
82
83
Laundry compounds
Formerly
E2
Formerly
E3
Formerly
E4
Standards
1. Hand care products formulated with chlorhexidene
(FFDCA).
These products are subject to registration by
84
potable water, or
D1
Formerly D2
Sanitizers for all surfaces not always
requiring a rinse.
Standards
1. Chemical sanitizers and other chemical antimicrobials
regulations.
85
inspection personnel.
conditions of use.
86
Minimum Temperature
Minimum
Concentration
MG/L(mg/L)
pH of 10 or less
C(F)
25
50
100
49(120)
38(100)
13(55)
pH of 8 or less
C(F)
49(120)
24(75)
13(55)
F1
Nonresidual pesticides.
Formerly
F2
Residual pesticides.
Formerly
F3
Formerly
F4
Formerly
F5
Standards
These products are toxic by design, in varying degrees, and
establishments.
87
(e)).
resistant stations.
color is necessary.
single-use articles.
88
Water Treatments:
Examples
Formerly
G1
Formerly G2
compounds.
Formerly G3
compounds.
Formerly G4
compounds.
Formerly G5
compounds.
Formerly G6
Compounds for treating boilers, steam
lines, where the steam produced may contact edible products
Formerly G7
Compounds for treating boilers, steam
Standards
1. Boiler water treatments where the steam may contact food
173.310.
173.340(a)(2).
must be GRAS.
89
exceed 5ppm.
these additives.
Lubricants
Examples
Formerly
H1
Formerly
H2
Formerly
H3
Soluble oils.
Standards
1. Lubricants intended for incidental food contact must
90
Anti-Slip Compounds:
Examples
Formerly J1
Absorbents or antislip agents for spot
application to floors.
Standards
Anti-slip compounds are intended for spot application to
floors and are limited to the floor area where the hazard
pests
Letters of Guaranty
91
3. The letter shall state that the material will be safe and
92
chp-17.qxd
10/18/05
12:53 PM
Page 187
17
CHAPTER
Legal Requirements
GENERAL LEGALITIES
Factories Act, 1948
This is applicable to enterprises where the number of employees is:
z
The enterprises covered under the Act are required to keep certain records:
z
Muster Roll
Workers Register
Overtime Register
Advance Register
Register of Wages
chp-17.qxd
10/18/05
12:53 PM
Page 188
There is another Act known as Shops & Establishment Act which is applicable to shops and business undertakings employing 5 or more persons.
Chapter Seventeen
chp-17.qxd
10/18/05
12:53 PM
Page 189
Sales Tax
Sales tax is tax levied by state and centre. Tax charged by state is called LST
or Local Sales Tax and tax charged by Centre is known as CST or Central
Sales Tax. The latter is charged when goods move out of a state.
189
chp-17.qxd
10/18/05
12:53 PM
Page 190
is relatively stringent while cottage and household level units sometimes tend
to compromise on such stipulations. These laws include:
a. Prevention of Food Adulteration Act (1954): which is the basic statute
to protect consumers against supply of adulterated food. The Central
Committee for Food Standards under the Directorate General &
Health Services Ministry of Health and Family Welfare has specified
the standards.
b. Milk and Milk Products Order (MMPO): regulates milk and milk
products production in the country. The order requires no permission
for units handling less than 10,000 litres of liquid milk per day or milk
solids upto 500 tpa.
c. Fruit Products Order (1955): regulates manufacture and distribution of
all fruit and vegetable products, sweetened aerated waters, vinegar and
synthetic syrups. The license is issued by Regional Director of MoFPI
located at Mumbai, Delhi, Kolkatta, Chennai and Guwahati based on
the satisfaction of the concerned officer with regard to quality of production, sanitation and hygiene, machinery and equipment and work
area standards.
d. Standard of Weights and Measures (Packaged Commodities) Rules,
1977: lay down certain obligations for all commodities in packed
form with respect to their quality declaration. The Directorate of
Weights and Measures under the Ministry of Food and Civil Supplies
operates these rules.
e. Export (Quality Control and Inspection) Act, 1963: is operated by the
Export Inspection Council and under this act many exportable commodities have been notified for compulsory pre-shipment inspection
unless specifically requested by the importer not to do so.
f. Voluntary Standards: are regulated by organisations involved with
voluntary standardisation and certificates systems concerning quality
parameters in food. They are the Bureau of Indian Standards (BIS)
and Directorate of Marketing and Inspection (DMI). The food processing industries sector as a whole involves other legislations.
g. Oils, Deoiled Meal and Edible Flour Control Order 1967 and
Vegetables Products Control Order, 1976: control the production and
distribution of solvent extracted oils, deoiled meals, edible oil seed
flours and hydrogenated vegetable oils (vanaspati).
h. Meat Food Products Control Order, 1973: regulates manufacture,
quality, and sale of all meat products and is operated by the
Directorate of Marketing and Inspection.
190
Chapter Seventeen